Transaction Hash:
Block:
16351602 at Jan-07-2023 01:23:59 AM +UTC
Transaction Fee:
0.002913896340950314 ETH
$5.73
Gas Used:
176,207 Gas / 16.536779702 Gwei
Emitted Events:
| 221 |
Bueno721Drop.Transfer( from=0xce515c45438aabe2b98334ad76d8e10a9e81ffe3, to=[Sender] 0x3752d4719bb59857bafa9cd81132e223ef27b803, tokenId=899 )
|
| 222 |
TransparentUpgradeableProxy.0xe2c49856b032c255ae7e325d18109bc4e22a2804e2e49a017ec0f59f19cd447b( 0xe2c49856b032c255ae7e325d18109bc4e22a2804e2e49a017ec0f59f19cd447b, 4fc29e676261ccb89ebca08ab532ea83f6d87a5a8b240afc9e7532136621d568, 0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000, 000000000000000000000000ce515c45438aabe2b98334ad76d8e10a9e81ffe3, 000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000003c181a56603000 )
|
| 223 |
TransparentUpgradeableProxy.0x3cbb63f144840e5b1b0a38a7c19211d2e89de4d7c5faf8b2d3c1776c302d1d33( 0x3cbb63f144840e5b1b0a38a7c19211d2e89de4d7c5faf8b2d3c1776c302d1d33, 0x4fc29e676261ccb89ebca08ab532ea83f6d87a5a8b240afc9e7532136621d568, 000000000000000000000000ce515c45438aabe2b98334ad76d8e10a9e81ffe3, 0000000000000000000000003752d4719bb59857bafa9cd81132e223ef27b803, 0000000000000000000000000000000066b17237ebdbc8f0e58f29042ff02681, 000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000383699191a565, 0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000001, 0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000001, 0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000063b90e8e, 0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000, 0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000160, 0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000180, 0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000260, 0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000, 000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000003c6568f12e8000, 0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000040, 0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000080, 0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000020, 0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000001, 00000000000000000000000014e645e2bb0e15c87230c6206e2c85b494c4a116, 0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000383, 0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000001, 0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000, 0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000, 000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000003c6568f12e8000, 4fc29e676261ccb89ebca08ab532ea83f6d87a5a8b240afc9e7532136621d568, 000000000000000000000000f849de01b080adc3a814fabe1e2087475cf2e354, 0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000160, 0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000, 0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000, 0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000, 0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000180, 0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000, 0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000001, 0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000001388, 000000000000000000000000d823c605807cc5e6bd6fc0d7e4eea50d3e2d66cd )
|
Account State Difference:
| Address | Before | After | State Difference | ||
|---|---|---|---|---|---|
| 0x14E645E2...494c4A116 | |||||
| 0x3752d471...3eF27b803 |
2.517283936879556837 Eth
Nonce: 488
|
2.497370040538606523 Eth
Nonce: 489
| 0.019913896340950314 | ||
| 0x74312363...65a67EeD3 | (X2Y2: Exchange) | ||||
|
0x95222290...5CC4BAfe5
Miner
| (beaverbuild) | 207.121135588915335096 Eth | 207.121399899415335096 Eth | 0.0002643105 | |
| 0xCe515c45...a9E81fFe3 | 0.020150347955071719 Eth | 0.037065347955071719 Eth | 0.016915 | ||
| 0xD823C605...d3e2d66cd | (X2Y2: Fee Management) | 14.742853566653838943 Eth | 14.742938566653838943 Eth | 0.000085 |
Execution Trace
ETH 0.017
TransparentUpgradeableProxy.357a150b( )
ETH 0.017
X2Y2_r1.run( input=[{name:orders, type:tuple[], order:1, indexed:false}, {name:details, type:tuple[], order:2, indexed:false}, {name:shared, type:tuple, order:3, indexed:false, value:[{name:salt, type:uint256, order:1, indexed:false, value:988914367178085, valueString:988914367178085}, {name:deadline, type:uint256, order:2, indexed:false, value:1673065424, valueString:1673065424}, {name:amountToEth, type:uint256, order:3, indexed:false, value:0, valueString:0}, {name:amountToWeth, type:uint256, order:4, indexed:false, value:0, valueString:0}, {name:user, type:address, order:5, indexed:false, value:0x3752d4719bB59857bAfa9Cd81132E223eF27b803, valueString:0x3752d4719bB59857bAfa9Cd81132E223eF27b803}, {name:canFail, type:bool, order:6, indexed:false, value:false, valueString:False}], valueString:[{name:salt, type:uint256, order:1, indexed:false, value:988914367178085, valueString:988914367178085}, {name:deadline, type:uint256, order:2, indexed:false, value:1673065424, valueString:1673065424}, {name:amountToEth, type:uint256, order:3, indexed:false, value:0, valueString:0}, {name:amountToWeth, type:uint256, order:4, indexed:false, value:0, valueString:0}, {name:user, type:address, order:5, indexed:false, value:0x3752d4719bB59857bAfa9Cd81132E223eF27b803, valueString:0x3752d4719bB59857bAfa9Cd81132E223eF27b803}, {name:canFail, type:bool, order:6, indexed:false, value:false, valueString:False}]}, {name:r, type:bytes32, order:4, indexed:false, value:75C78A113B374CBB952C6FB9C26212CA4D07B2E9257749D9CE049E08F7446116, valueString:75C78A113B374CBB952C6FB9C26212CA4D07B2E9257749D9CE049E08F7446116}, {name:s, type:bytes32, order:5, indexed:false, value:76548826735C0A014B3B8F239B9E2A200D94B7FC3C21549E0597740922FA3023, valueString:76548826735C0A014B3B8F239B9E2A200D94B7FC3C21549E0597740922FA3023}, {name:v, type:uint8, order:6, indexed:false, value:27, valueString:27}] )-
Null: 0x000...001.1c46687e( ) -
Null: 0x000...001.2d7ff57b( ) -
ERC721Delegate.STATICCALL( ) ERC721Delegate.executeSell( seller=0xCe515c45438aABe2b98334aD76D8E10a9E81fFe3, buyer=0x3752d4719bB59857bAfa9Cd81132E223eF27b803, data=0x0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000020000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000100000000000000000000000014E645E2BB0E15C87230C6206E2C85B494C4A1160000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000383 ) => ( True )
Bueno721Drop.safeTransferFrom( from=0xCe515c45438aABe2b98334aD76D8E10a9E81fFe3, to=0x3752d4719bB59857bAfa9Cd81132E223eF27b803, tokenId=899 )
Bueno721Drop.safeTransferFrom( from=0xCe515c45438aABe2b98334aD76D8E10a9E81fFe3, to=0x3752d4719bB59857bAfa9Cd81132E223eF27b803, tokenId=899 )-
OperatorFilterRegistry.isOperatorAllowed( registrant=0x14E645E2Bb0e15c87230C6206E2C85B494c4A116, operator=0xF849de01B080aDC3A814FaBE1E2087475cF2E354 ) => ( True ) -
OperatorFilterRegistry.isOperatorAllowed( registrant=0x14E645E2Bb0e15c87230C6206E2C85B494c4A116, operator=0xF849de01B080aDC3A814FaBE1E2087475cF2E354 ) => ( True ) -
OperatorFilterRegistry.isOperatorAllowed( registrant=0x14E645E2Bb0e15c87230C6206E2C85B494c4A116, operator=0xF849de01B080aDC3A814FaBE1E2087475cF2E354 ) => ( True )
-
- ETH 0.000085
FeeManagement.CALL( ) - ETH 0.016915
0xce515c45438aabe2b98334ad76d8e10a9e81ffe3.CALL( )
-
File 1 of 7: TransparentUpgradeableProxy
File 2 of 7: Bueno721Drop
File 3 of 7: X2Y2_r1
File 4 of 7: ERC721Delegate
File 5 of 7: Bueno721Drop
File 6 of 7: OperatorFilterRegistry
File 7 of 7: FeeManagement
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "@openzeppelin/contracts/proxy/ERC1967/ERC1967Proxy.sol";
import "@openzeppelin/contracts/proxy/transparent/TransparentUpgradeableProxy.sol";
import "@openzeppelin/contracts/proxy/transparent/ProxyAdmin.sol";
// Kept for backwards compatibility with older versions of Hardhat and Truffle plugins.
contract AdminUpgradeabilityProxy is TransparentUpgradeableProxy {
constructor(address logic, address admin, bytes memory data) payable TransparentUpgradeableProxy(logic, admin, data) {}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "../Proxy.sol";
import "./ERC1967Upgrade.sol";
/**
* @dev This contract implements an upgradeable proxy. It is upgradeable because calls are delegated to an
* implementation address that can be changed. This address is stored in storage in the location specified by
* https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1967[EIP1967], so that it doesn't conflict with the storage layout of the
* implementation behind the proxy.
*/
contract ERC1967Proxy is Proxy, ERC1967Upgrade {
/**
* @dev Initializes the upgradeable proxy with an initial implementation specified by `_logic`.
*
* If `_data` is nonempty, it's used as data in a delegate call to `_logic`. This will typically be an encoded
* function call, and allows initializating the storage of the proxy like a Solidity constructor.
*/
constructor(address _logic, bytes memory _data) payable {
assert(_IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT == bytes32(uint256(keccak256("eip1967.proxy.implementation")) - 1));
_upgradeToAndCall(_logic, _data, false);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the current implementation address.
*/
function _implementation() internal view virtual override returns (address impl) {
return ERC1967Upgrade._getImplementation();
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "../ERC1967/ERC1967Proxy.sol";
/**
* @dev This contract implements a proxy that is upgradeable by an admin.
*
* To avoid https://medium.com/nomic-labs-blog/malicious-backdoors-in-ethereum-proxies-62629adf3357[proxy selector
* clashing], which can potentially be used in an attack, this contract uses the
* https://blog.openzeppelin.com/the-transparent-proxy-pattern/[transparent proxy pattern]. This pattern implies two
* things that go hand in hand:
*
* 1. If any account other than the admin calls the proxy, the call will be forwarded to the implementation, even if
* that call matches one of the admin functions exposed by the proxy itself.
* 2. If the admin calls the proxy, it can access the admin functions, but its calls will never be forwarded to the
* implementation. If the admin tries to call a function on the implementation it will fail with an error that says
* "admin cannot fallback to proxy target".
*
* These properties mean that the admin account can only be used for admin actions like upgrading the proxy or changing
* the admin, so it's best if it's a dedicated account that is not used for anything else. This will avoid headaches due
* to sudden errors when trying to call a function from the proxy implementation.
*
* Our recommendation is for the dedicated account to be an instance of the {ProxyAdmin} contract. If set up this way,
* you should think of the `ProxyAdmin` instance as the real administrative interface of your proxy.
*/
contract TransparentUpgradeableProxy is ERC1967Proxy {
/**
* @dev Initializes an upgradeable proxy managed by `_admin`, backed by the implementation at `_logic`, and
* optionally initialized with `_data` as explained in {ERC1967Proxy-constructor}.
*/
constructor(address _logic, address admin_, bytes memory _data) payable ERC1967Proxy(_logic, _data) {
assert(_ADMIN_SLOT == bytes32(uint256(keccak256("eip1967.proxy.admin")) - 1));
_changeAdmin(admin_);
}
/**
* @dev Modifier used internally that will delegate the call to the implementation unless the sender is the admin.
*/
modifier ifAdmin() {
if (msg.sender == _getAdmin()) {
_;
} else {
_fallback();
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns the current admin.
*
* NOTE: Only the admin can call this function. See {ProxyAdmin-getProxyAdmin}.
*
* TIP: To get this value clients can read directly from the storage slot shown below (specified by EIP1967) using the
* https://eth.wiki/json-rpc/API#eth_getstorageat[`eth_getStorageAt`] RPC call.
* `0xb53127684a568b3173ae13b9f8a6016e243e63b6e8ee1178d6a717850b5d6103`
*/
function admin() external ifAdmin returns (address admin_) {
admin_ = _getAdmin();
}
/**
* @dev Returns the current implementation.
*
* NOTE: Only the admin can call this function. See {ProxyAdmin-getProxyImplementation}.
*
* TIP: To get this value clients can read directly from the storage slot shown below (specified by EIP1967) using the
* https://eth.wiki/json-rpc/API#eth_getstorageat[`eth_getStorageAt`] RPC call.
* `0x360894a13ba1a3210667c828492db98dca3e2076cc3735a920a3ca505d382bbc`
*/
function implementation() external ifAdmin returns (address implementation_) {
implementation_ = _implementation();
}
/**
* @dev Changes the admin of the proxy.
*
* Emits an {AdminChanged} event.
*
* NOTE: Only the admin can call this function. See {ProxyAdmin-changeProxyAdmin}.
*/
function changeAdmin(address newAdmin) external virtual ifAdmin {
_changeAdmin(newAdmin);
}
/**
* @dev Upgrade the implementation of the proxy.
*
* NOTE: Only the admin can call this function. See {ProxyAdmin-upgrade}.
*/
function upgradeTo(address newImplementation) external ifAdmin {
_upgradeToAndCall(newImplementation, bytes(""), false);
}
/**
* @dev Upgrade the implementation of the proxy, and then call a function from the new implementation as specified
* by `data`, which should be an encoded function call. This is useful to initialize new storage variables in the
* proxied contract.
*
* NOTE: Only the admin can call this function. See {ProxyAdmin-upgradeAndCall}.
*/
function upgradeToAndCall(address newImplementation, bytes calldata data) external payable ifAdmin {
_upgradeToAndCall(newImplementation, data, true);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the current admin.
*/
function _admin() internal view virtual returns (address) {
return _getAdmin();
}
/**
* @dev Makes sure the admin cannot access the fallback function. See {Proxy-_beforeFallback}.
*/
function _beforeFallback() internal virtual override {
require(msg.sender != _getAdmin(), "TransparentUpgradeableProxy: admin cannot fallback to proxy target");
super._beforeFallback();
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "./TransparentUpgradeableProxy.sol";
import "../../access/Ownable.sol";
/**
* @dev This is an auxiliary contract meant to be assigned as the admin of a {TransparentUpgradeableProxy}. For an
* explanation of why you would want to use this see the documentation for {TransparentUpgradeableProxy}.
*/
contract ProxyAdmin is Ownable {
/**
* @dev Returns the current implementation of `proxy`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - This contract must be the admin of `proxy`.
*/
function getProxyImplementation(TransparentUpgradeableProxy proxy) public view virtual returns (address) {
// We need to manually run the static call since the getter cannot be flagged as view
// bytes4(keccak256("implementation()")) == 0x5c60da1b
(bool success, bytes memory returndata) = address(proxy).staticcall(hex"5c60da1b");
require(success);
return abi.decode(returndata, (address));
}
/**
* @dev Returns the current admin of `proxy`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - This contract must be the admin of `proxy`.
*/
function getProxyAdmin(TransparentUpgradeableProxy proxy) public view virtual returns (address) {
// We need to manually run the static call since the getter cannot be flagged as view
// bytes4(keccak256("admin()")) == 0xf851a440
(bool success, bytes memory returndata) = address(proxy).staticcall(hex"f851a440");
require(success);
return abi.decode(returndata, (address));
}
/**
* @dev Changes the admin of `proxy` to `newAdmin`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - This contract must be the current admin of `proxy`.
*/
function changeProxyAdmin(TransparentUpgradeableProxy proxy, address newAdmin) public virtual onlyOwner {
proxy.changeAdmin(newAdmin);
}
/**
* @dev Upgrades `proxy` to `implementation`. See {TransparentUpgradeableProxy-upgradeTo}.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - This contract must be the admin of `proxy`.
*/
function upgrade(TransparentUpgradeableProxy proxy, address implementation) public virtual onlyOwner {
proxy.upgradeTo(implementation);
}
/**
* @dev Upgrades `proxy` to `implementation` and calls a function on the new implementation. See
* {TransparentUpgradeableProxy-upgradeToAndCall}.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - This contract must be the admin of `proxy`.
*/
function upgradeAndCall(TransparentUpgradeableProxy proxy, address implementation, bytes memory data) public payable virtual onlyOwner {
proxy.upgradeToAndCall{value: msg.value}(implementation, data);
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev This abstract contract provides a fallback function that delegates all calls to another contract using the EVM
* instruction `delegatecall`. We refer to the second contract as the _implementation_ behind the proxy, and it has to
* be specified by overriding the virtual {_implementation} function.
*
* Additionally, delegation to the implementation can be triggered manually through the {_fallback} function, or to a
* different contract through the {_delegate} function.
*
* The success and return data of the delegated call will be returned back to the caller of the proxy.
*/
abstract contract Proxy {
/**
* @dev Delegates the current call to `implementation`.
*
* This function does not return to its internall call site, it will return directly to the external caller.
*/
function _delegate(address implementation) internal virtual {
// solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly
assembly {
// Copy msg.data. We take full control of memory in this inline assembly
// block because it will not return to Solidity code. We overwrite the
// Solidity scratch pad at memory position 0.
calldatacopy(0, 0, calldatasize())
// Call the implementation.
// out and outsize are 0 because we don't know the size yet.
let result := delegatecall(gas(), implementation, 0, calldatasize(), 0, 0)
// Copy the returned data.
returndatacopy(0, 0, returndatasize())
switch result
// delegatecall returns 0 on error.
case 0 { revert(0, returndatasize()) }
default { return(0, returndatasize()) }
}
}
/**
* @dev This is a virtual function that should be overriden so it returns the address to which the fallback function
* and {_fallback} should delegate.
*/
function _implementation() internal view virtual returns (address);
/**
* @dev Delegates the current call to the address returned by `_implementation()`.
*
* This function does not return to its internall call site, it will return directly to the external caller.
*/
function _fallback() internal virtual {
_beforeFallback();
_delegate(_implementation());
}
/**
* @dev Fallback function that delegates calls to the address returned by `_implementation()`. Will run if no other
* function in the contract matches the call data.
*/
fallback () external payable virtual {
_fallback();
}
/**
* @dev Fallback function that delegates calls to the address returned by `_implementation()`. Will run if call data
* is empty.
*/
receive () external payable virtual {
_fallback();
}
/**
* @dev Hook that is called before falling back to the implementation. Can happen as part of a manual `_fallback`
* call, or as part of the Solidity `fallback` or `receive` functions.
*
* If overriden should call `super._beforeFallback()`.
*/
function _beforeFallback() internal virtual {
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.2;
import "../beacon/IBeacon.sol";
import "../../utils/Address.sol";
import "../../utils/StorageSlot.sol";
/**
* @dev This abstract contract provides getters and event emitting update functions for
* https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1967[EIP1967] slots.
*
* _Available since v4.1._
*
* @custom:oz-upgrades-unsafe-allow delegatecall
*/
abstract contract ERC1967Upgrade {
// This is the keccak-256 hash of "eip1967.proxy.rollback" subtracted by 1
bytes32 private constant _ROLLBACK_SLOT = 0x4910fdfa16fed3260ed0e7147f7cc6da11a60208b5b9406d12a635614ffd9143;
/**
* @dev Storage slot with the address of the current implementation.
* This is the keccak-256 hash of "eip1967.proxy.implementation" subtracted by 1, and is
* validated in the constructor.
*/
bytes32 internal constant _IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT = 0x360894a13ba1a3210667c828492db98dca3e2076cc3735a920a3ca505d382bbc;
/**
* @dev Emitted when the implementation is upgraded.
*/
event Upgraded(address indexed implementation);
/**
* @dev Returns the current implementation address.
*/
function _getImplementation() internal view returns (address) {
return StorageSlot.getAddressSlot(_IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT).value;
}
/**
* @dev Stores a new address in the EIP1967 implementation slot.
*/
function _setImplementation(address newImplementation) private {
require(Address.isContract(newImplementation), "ERC1967: new implementation is not a contract");
StorageSlot.getAddressSlot(_IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT).value = newImplementation;
}
/**
* @dev Perform implementation upgrade
*
* Emits an {Upgraded} event.
*/
function _upgradeTo(address newImplementation) internal {
_setImplementation(newImplementation);
emit Upgraded(newImplementation);
}
/**
* @dev Perform implementation upgrade with additional setup call.
*
* Emits an {Upgraded} event.
*/
function _upgradeToAndCall(address newImplementation, bytes memory data, bool forceCall) internal {
_setImplementation(newImplementation);
emit Upgraded(newImplementation);
if (data.length > 0 || forceCall) {
Address.functionDelegateCall(newImplementation, data);
}
}
/**
* @dev Perform implementation upgrade with security checks for UUPS proxies, and additional setup call.
*
* Emits an {Upgraded} event.
*/
function _upgradeToAndCallSecure(address newImplementation, bytes memory data, bool forceCall) internal {
address oldImplementation = _getImplementation();
// Initial upgrade and setup call
_setImplementation(newImplementation);
if (data.length > 0 || forceCall) {
Address.functionDelegateCall(newImplementation, data);
}
// Perform rollback test if not already in progress
StorageSlot.BooleanSlot storage rollbackTesting = StorageSlot.getBooleanSlot(_ROLLBACK_SLOT);
if (!rollbackTesting.value) {
// Trigger rollback using upgradeTo from the new implementation
rollbackTesting.value = true;
Address.functionDelegateCall(
newImplementation,
abi.encodeWithSignature(
"upgradeTo(address)",
oldImplementation
)
);
rollbackTesting.value = false;
// Check rollback was effective
require(oldImplementation == _getImplementation(), "ERC1967Upgrade: upgrade breaks further upgrades");
// Finally reset to the new implementation and log the upgrade
_setImplementation(newImplementation);
emit Upgraded(newImplementation);
}
}
/**
* @dev Perform beacon upgrade with additional setup call. Note: This upgrades the address of the beacon, it does
* not upgrade the implementation contained in the beacon (see {UpgradeableBeacon-_setImplementation} for that).
*
* Emits a {BeaconUpgraded} event.
*/
function _upgradeBeaconToAndCall(address newBeacon, bytes memory data, bool forceCall) internal {
_setBeacon(newBeacon);
emit BeaconUpgraded(newBeacon);
if (data.length > 0 || forceCall) {
Address.functionDelegateCall(IBeacon(newBeacon).implementation(), data);
}
}
/**
* @dev Storage slot with the admin of the contract.
* This is the keccak-256 hash of "eip1967.proxy.admin" subtracted by 1, and is
* validated in the constructor.
*/
bytes32 internal constant _ADMIN_SLOT = 0xb53127684a568b3173ae13b9f8a6016e243e63b6e8ee1178d6a717850b5d6103;
/**
* @dev Emitted when the admin account has changed.
*/
event AdminChanged(address previousAdmin, address newAdmin);
/**
* @dev Returns the current admin.
*/
function _getAdmin() internal view returns (address) {
return StorageSlot.getAddressSlot(_ADMIN_SLOT).value;
}
/**
* @dev Stores a new address in the EIP1967 admin slot.
*/
function _setAdmin(address newAdmin) private {
require(newAdmin != address(0), "ERC1967: new admin is the zero address");
StorageSlot.getAddressSlot(_ADMIN_SLOT).value = newAdmin;
}
/**
* @dev Changes the admin of the proxy.
*
* Emits an {AdminChanged} event.
*/
function _changeAdmin(address newAdmin) internal {
emit AdminChanged(_getAdmin(), newAdmin);
_setAdmin(newAdmin);
}
/**
* @dev The storage slot of the UpgradeableBeacon contract which defines the implementation for this proxy.
* This is bytes32(uint256(keccak256('eip1967.proxy.beacon')) - 1)) and is validated in the constructor.
*/
bytes32 internal constant _BEACON_SLOT = 0xa3f0ad74e5423aebfd80d3ef4346578335a9a72aeaee59ff6cb3582b35133d50;
/**
* @dev Emitted when the beacon is upgraded.
*/
event BeaconUpgraded(address indexed beacon);
/**
* @dev Returns the current beacon.
*/
function _getBeacon() internal view returns (address) {
return StorageSlot.getAddressSlot(_BEACON_SLOT).value;
}
/**
* @dev Stores a new beacon in the EIP1967 beacon slot.
*/
function _setBeacon(address newBeacon) private {
require(
Address.isContract(newBeacon),
"ERC1967: new beacon is not a contract"
);
require(
Address.isContract(IBeacon(newBeacon).implementation()),
"ERC1967: beacon implementation is not a contract"
);
StorageSlot.getAddressSlot(_BEACON_SLOT).value = newBeacon;
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev This is the interface that {BeaconProxy} expects of its beacon.
*/
interface IBeacon {
/**
* @dev Must return an address that can be used as a delegate call target.
*
* {BeaconProxy} will check that this address is a contract.
*/
function implementation() external view returns (address);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev Collection of functions related to the address type
*/
library Address {
/**
* @dev Returns true if `account` is a contract.
*
* [IMPORTANT]
* ====
* It is unsafe to assume that an address for which this function returns
* false is an externally-owned account (EOA) and not a contract.
*
* Among others, `isContract` will return false for the following
* types of addresses:
*
* - an externally-owned account
* - a contract in construction
* - an address where a contract will be created
* - an address where a contract lived, but was destroyed
* ====
*/
function isContract(address account) internal view returns (bool) {
// This method relies on extcodesize, which returns 0 for contracts in
// construction, since the code is only stored at the end of the
// constructor execution.
uint256 size;
// solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly
assembly { size := extcodesize(account) }
return size > 0;
}
/**
* @dev Replacement for Solidity's `transfer`: sends `amount` wei to
* `recipient`, forwarding all available gas and reverting on errors.
*
* https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1884[EIP1884] increases the gas cost
* of certain opcodes, possibly making contracts go over the 2300 gas limit
* imposed by `transfer`, making them unable to receive funds via
* `transfer`. {sendValue} removes this limitation.
*
* https://diligence.consensys.net/posts/2019/09/stop-using-soliditys-transfer-now/[Learn more].
*
* IMPORTANT: because control is transferred to `recipient`, care must be
* taken to not create reentrancy vulnerabilities. Consider using
* {ReentrancyGuard} or the
* https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/v0.5.11/security-considerations.html#use-the-checks-effects-interactions-pattern[checks-effects-interactions pattern].
*/
function sendValue(address payable recipient, uint256 amount) internal {
require(address(this).balance >= amount, "Address: insufficient balance");
// solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls, avoid-call-value
(bool success, ) = recipient.call{ value: amount }("");
require(success, "Address: unable to send value, recipient may have reverted");
}
/**
* @dev Performs a Solidity function call using a low level `call`. A
* plain`call` is an unsafe replacement for a function call: use this
* function instead.
*
* If `target` reverts with a revert reason, it is bubbled up by this
* function (like regular Solidity function calls).
*
* Returns the raw returned data. To convert to the expected return value,
* use https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/latest/units-and-global-variables.html?highlight=abi.decode#abi-encoding-and-decoding-functions[`abi.decode`].
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `target` must be a contract.
* - calling `target` with `data` must not revert.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) {
return functionCall(target, data, "Address: low-level call failed");
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], but with
* `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCall(address target, bytes memory data, string memory errorMessage) internal returns (bytes memory) {
return functionCallWithValue(target, data, 0, errorMessage);
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
* but also transferring `value` wei to `target`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - the calling contract must have an ETH balance of at least `value`.
* - the called Solidity function must be `payable`.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCallWithValue(address target, bytes memory data, uint256 value) internal returns (bytes memory) {
return functionCallWithValue(target, data, value, "Address: low-level call with value failed");
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCallWithValue-address-bytes-uint256-}[`functionCallWithValue`], but
* with `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCallWithValue(address target, bytes memory data, uint256 value, string memory errorMessage) internal returns (bytes memory) {
require(address(this).balance >= value, "Address: insufficient balance for call");
require(isContract(target), "Address: call to non-contract");
// solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls
(bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.call{ value: value }(data);
return _verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage);
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
* but performing a static call.
*
* _Available since v3.3._
*/
function functionStaticCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
return functionStaticCall(target, data, "Address: low-level static call failed");
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`],
* but performing a static call.
*
* _Available since v3.3._
*/
function functionStaticCall(address target, bytes memory data, string memory errorMessage) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
require(isContract(target), "Address: static call to non-contract");
// solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls
(bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.staticcall(data);
return _verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage);
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
* but performing a delegate call.
*
* _Available since v3.4._
*/
function functionDelegateCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) {
return functionDelegateCall(target, data, "Address: low-level delegate call failed");
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`],
* but performing a delegate call.
*
* _Available since v3.4._
*/
function functionDelegateCall(address target, bytes memory data, string memory errorMessage) internal returns (bytes memory) {
require(isContract(target), "Address: delegate call to non-contract");
// solhint-disable-next-line avoid-low-level-calls
(bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.delegatecall(data);
return _verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage);
}
function _verifyCallResult(bool success, bytes memory returndata, string memory errorMessage) private pure returns(bytes memory) {
if (success) {
return returndata;
} else {
// Look for revert reason and bubble it up if present
if (returndata.length > 0) {
// The easiest way to bubble the revert reason is using memory via assembly
// solhint-disable-next-line no-inline-assembly
assembly {
let returndata_size := mload(returndata)
revert(add(32, returndata), returndata_size)
}
} else {
revert(errorMessage);
}
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev Library for reading and writing primitive types to specific storage slots.
*
* Storage slots are often used to avoid storage conflict when dealing with upgradeable contracts.
* This library helps with reading and writing to such slots without the need for inline assembly.
*
* The functions in this library return Slot structs that contain a `value` member that can be used to read or write.
*
* Example usage to set ERC1967 implementation slot:
* ```
* contract ERC1967 {
* bytes32 internal constant _IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT = 0x360894a13ba1a3210667c828492db98dca3e2076cc3735a920a3ca505d382bbc;
*
* function _getImplementation() internal view returns (address) {
* return StorageSlot.getAddressSlot(_IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT).value;
* }
*
* function _setImplementation(address newImplementation) internal {
* require(Address.isContract(newImplementation), "ERC1967: new implementation is not a contract");
* StorageSlot.getAddressSlot(_IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT).value = newImplementation;
* }
* }
* ```
*
* _Available since v4.1 for `address`, `bool`, `bytes32`, and `uint256`._
*/
library StorageSlot {
struct AddressSlot {
address value;
}
struct BooleanSlot {
bool value;
}
struct Bytes32Slot {
bytes32 value;
}
struct Uint256Slot {
uint256 value;
}
/**
* @dev Returns an `AddressSlot` with member `value` located at `slot`.
*/
function getAddressSlot(bytes32 slot) internal pure returns (AddressSlot storage r) {
assembly {
r.slot := slot
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns an `BooleanSlot` with member `value` located at `slot`.
*/
function getBooleanSlot(bytes32 slot) internal pure returns (BooleanSlot storage r) {
assembly {
r.slot := slot
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns an `Bytes32Slot` with member `value` located at `slot`.
*/
function getBytes32Slot(bytes32 slot) internal pure returns (Bytes32Slot storage r) {
assembly {
r.slot := slot
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns an `Uint256Slot` with member `value` located at `slot`.
*/
function getUint256Slot(bytes32 slot) internal pure returns (Uint256Slot storage r) {
assembly {
r.slot := slot
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "../utils/Context.sol";
/**
* @dev Contract module which provides a basic access control mechanism, where
* there is an account (an owner) that can be granted exclusive access to
* specific functions.
*
* By default, the owner account will be the one that deploys the contract. This
* can later be changed with {transferOwnership}.
*
* This module is used through inheritance. It will make available the modifier
* `onlyOwner`, which can be applied to your functions to restrict their use to
* the owner.
*/
abstract contract Ownable is Context {
address private _owner;
event OwnershipTransferred(address indexed previousOwner, address indexed newOwner);
/**
* @dev Initializes the contract setting the deployer as the initial owner.
*/
constructor () {
address msgSender = _msgSender();
_owner = msgSender;
emit OwnershipTransferred(address(0), msgSender);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the address of the current owner.
*/
function owner() public view virtual returns (address) {
return _owner;
}
/**
* @dev Throws if called by any account other than the owner.
*/
modifier onlyOwner() {
require(owner() == _msgSender(), "Ownable: caller is not the owner");
_;
}
/**
* @dev Leaves the contract without owner. It will not be possible to call
* `onlyOwner` functions anymore. Can only be called by the current owner.
*
* NOTE: Renouncing ownership will leave the contract without an owner,
* thereby removing any functionality that is only available to the owner.
*/
function renounceOwnership() public virtual onlyOwner {
emit OwnershipTransferred(_owner, address(0));
_owner = address(0);
}
/**
* @dev Transfers ownership of the contract to a new account (`newOwner`).
* Can only be called by the current owner.
*/
function transferOwnership(address newOwner) public virtual onlyOwner {
require(newOwner != address(0), "Ownable: new owner is the zero address");
emit OwnershipTransferred(_owner, newOwner);
_owner = newOwner;
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/*
* @dev Provides information about the current execution context, including the
* sender of the transaction and its data. While these are generally available
* via msg.sender and msg.data, they should not be accessed in such a direct
* manner, since when dealing with meta-transactions the account sending and
* paying for execution may not be the actual sender (as far as an application
* is concerned).
*
* This contract is only required for intermediate, library-like contracts.
*/
abstract contract Context {
function _msgSender() internal view virtual returns (address) {
return msg.sender;
}
function _msgData() internal view virtual returns (bytes calldata) {
this; // silence state mutability warning without generating bytecode - see https://github.com/ethereum/solidity/issues/2691
return msg.data;
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "../ERC1967/ERC1967Upgrade.sol";
/**
* @dev Base contract for building openzeppelin-upgrades compatible implementations for the {ERC1967Proxy}. It includes
* publicly available upgrade functions that are called by the plugin and by the secure upgrade mechanism to verify
* continuation of the upgradability.
*
* The {_authorizeUpgrade} function MUST be overridden to include access restriction to the upgrade mechanism.
*
* _Available since v4.1._
*/
abstract contract UUPSUpgradeable is ERC1967Upgrade {
function upgradeTo(address newImplementation) external virtual {
_authorizeUpgrade(newImplementation);
_upgradeToAndCallSecure(newImplementation, bytes(""), false);
}
function upgradeToAndCall(address newImplementation, bytes memory data) external payable virtual {
_authorizeUpgrade(newImplementation);
_upgradeToAndCallSecure(newImplementation, data, true);
}
function _authorizeUpgrade(address newImplementation) internal virtual;
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.2;
import "@openzeppelin/contracts/proxy/utils/UUPSUpgradeable.sol";
abstract contract Proxiable is UUPSUpgradeable {
function _authorizeUpgrade(address newImplementation) internal override {
_beforeUpgrade(newImplementation);
}
function _beforeUpgrade(address newImplementation) internal virtual;
}
contract ChildOfProxiable is Proxiable {
function _beforeUpgrade(address newImplementation) internal virtual override {}
}
File 2 of 7: Bueno721Drop
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (access/Ownable.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "../utils/ContextUpgradeable.sol";
import "../proxy/utils/Initializable.sol";
/**
* @dev Contract module which provides a basic access control mechanism, where
* there is an account (an owner) that can be granted exclusive access to
* specific functions.
*
* By default, the owner account will be the one that deploys the contract. This
* can later be changed with {transferOwnership}.
*
* This module is used through inheritance. It will make available the modifier
* `onlyOwner`, which can be applied to your functions to restrict their use to
* the owner.
*/
abstract contract OwnableUpgradeable is Initializable, ContextUpgradeable {
address private _owner;
event OwnershipTransferred(address indexed previousOwner, address indexed newOwner);
/**
* @dev Initializes the contract setting the deployer as the initial owner.
*/
function __Ownable_init() internal onlyInitializing {
__Ownable_init_unchained();
}
function __Ownable_init_unchained() internal onlyInitializing {
_transferOwnership(_msgSender());
}
/**
* @dev Throws if called by any account other than the owner.
*/
modifier onlyOwner() {
_checkOwner();
_;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the address of the current owner.
*/
function owner() public view virtual returns (address) {
return _owner;
}
/**
* @dev Throws if the sender is not the owner.
*/
function _checkOwner() internal view virtual {
require(owner() == _msgSender(), "Ownable: caller is not the owner");
}
/**
* @dev Leaves the contract without owner. It will not be possible to call
* `onlyOwner` functions anymore. Can only be called by the current owner.
*
* NOTE: Renouncing ownership will leave the contract without an owner,
* thereby removing any functionality that is only available to the owner.
*/
function renounceOwnership() public virtual onlyOwner {
_transferOwnership(address(0));
}
/**
* @dev Transfers ownership of the contract to a new account (`newOwner`).
* Can only be called by the current owner.
*/
function transferOwnership(address newOwner) public virtual onlyOwner {
require(newOwner != address(0), "Ownable: new owner is the zero address");
_transferOwnership(newOwner);
}
/**
* @dev Transfers ownership of the contract to a new account (`newOwner`).
* Internal function without access restriction.
*/
function _transferOwnership(address newOwner) internal virtual {
address oldOwner = _owner;
_owner = newOwner;
emit OwnershipTransferred(oldOwner, newOwner);
}
/**
* @dev This empty reserved space is put in place to allow future versions to add new
* variables without shifting down storage in the inheritance chain.
* See https://docs.openzeppelin.com/contracts/4.x/upgradeable#storage_gaps
*/
uint256[49] private __gap;
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.8.0) (finance/PaymentSplitter.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "../token/ERC20/utils/SafeERC20Upgradeable.sol";
import "../utils/AddressUpgradeable.sol";
import "../utils/ContextUpgradeable.sol";
import "../proxy/utils/Initializable.sol";
/**
* @title PaymentSplitter
* @dev This contract allows to split Ether payments among a group of accounts. The sender does not need to be aware
* that the Ether will be split in this way, since it is handled transparently by the contract.
*
* The split can be in equal parts or in any other arbitrary proportion. The way this is specified is by assigning each
* account to a number of shares. Of all the Ether that this contract receives, each account will then be able to claim
* an amount proportional to the percentage of total shares they were assigned. The distribution of shares is set at the
* time of contract deployment and can't be updated thereafter.
*
* `PaymentSplitter` follows a _pull payment_ model. This means that payments are not automatically forwarded to the
* accounts but kept in this contract, and the actual transfer is triggered as a separate step by calling the {release}
* function.
*
* NOTE: This contract assumes that ERC20 tokens will behave similarly to native tokens (Ether). Rebasing tokens, and
* tokens that apply fees during transfers, are likely to not be supported as expected. If in doubt, we encourage you
* to run tests before sending real value to this contract.
*/
contract PaymentSplitterUpgradeable is Initializable, ContextUpgradeable {
event PayeeAdded(address account, uint256 shares);
event PaymentReleased(address to, uint256 amount);
event ERC20PaymentReleased(IERC20Upgradeable indexed token, address to, uint256 amount);
event PaymentReceived(address from, uint256 amount);
uint256 private _totalShares;
uint256 private _totalReleased;
mapping(address => uint256) private _shares;
mapping(address => uint256) private _released;
address[] private _payees;
mapping(IERC20Upgradeable => uint256) private _erc20TotalReleased;
mapping(IERC20Upgradeable => mapping(address => uint256)) private _erc20Released;
/**
* @dev Creates an instance of `PaymentSplitter` where each account in `payees` is assigned the number of shares at
* the matching position in the `shares` array.
*
* All addresses in `payees` must be non-zero. Both arrays must have the same non-zero length, and there must be no
* duplicates in `payees`.
*/
function __PaymentSplitter_init(address[] memory payees, uint256[] memory shares_) internal onlyInitializing {
__PaymentSplitter_init_unchained(payees, shares_);
}
function __PaymentSplitter_init_unchained(address[] memory payees, uint256[] memory shares_) internal onlyInitializing {
require(payees.length == shares_.length, "PaymentSplitter: payees and shares length mismatch");
require(payees.length > 0, "PaymentSplitter: no payees");
for (uint256 i = 0; i < payees.length; i++) {
_addPayee(payees[i], shares_[i]);
}
}
/**
* @dev The Ether received will be logged with {PaymentReceived} events. Note that these events are not fully
* reliable: it's possible for a contract to receive Ether without triggering this function. This only affects the
* reliability of the events, and not the actual splitting of Ether.
*
* To learn more about this see the Solidity documentation for
* https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/latest/contracts.html#fallback-function[fallback
* functions].
*/
receive() external payable virtual {
emit PaymentReceived(_msgSender(), msg.value);
}
/**
* @dev Getter for the total shares held by payees.
*/
function totalShares() public view returns (uint256) {
return _totalShares;
}
/**
* @dev Getter for the total amount of Ether already released.
*/
function totalReleased() public view returns (uint256) {
return _totalReleased;
}
/**
* @dev Getter for the total amount of `token` already released. `token` should be the address of an IERC20
* contract.
*/
function totalReleased(IERC20Upgradeable token) public view returns (uint256) {
return _erc20TotalReleased[token];
}
/**
* @dev Getter for the amount of shares held by an account.
*/
function shares(address account) public view returns (uint256) {
return _shares[account];
}
/**
* @dev Getter for the amount of Ether already released to a payee.
*/
function released(address account) public view returns (uint256) {
return _released[account];
}
/**
* @dev Getter for the amount of `token` tokens already released to a payee. `token` should be the address of an
* IERC20 contract.
*/
function released(IERC20Upgradeable token, address account) public view returns (uint256) {
return _erc20Released[token][account];
}
/**
* @dev Getter for the address of the payee number `index`.
*/
function payee(uint256 index) public view returns (address) {
return _payees[index];
}
/**
* @dev Getter for the amount of payee's releasable Ether.
*/
function releasable(address account) public view returns (uint256) {
uint256 totalReceived = address(this).balance + totalReleased();
return _pendingPayment(account, totalReceived, released(account));
}
/**
* @dev Getter for the amount of payee's releasable `token` tokens. `token` should be the address of an
* IERC20 contract.
*/
function releasable(IERC20Upgradeable token, address account) public view returns (uint256) {
uint256 totalReceived = token.balanceOf(address(this)) + totalReleased(token);
return _pendingPayment(account, totalReceived, released(token, account));
}
/**
* @dev Triggers a transfer to `account` of the amount of Ether they are owed, according to their percentage of the
* total shares and their previous withdrawals.
*/
function release(address payable account) public virtual {
require(_shares[account] > 0, "PaymentSplitter: account has no shares");
uint256 payment = releasable(account);
require(payment != 0, "PaymentSplitter: account is not due payment");
// _totalReleased is the sum of all values in _released.
// If "_totalReleased += payment" does not overflow, then "_released[account] += payment" cannot overflow.
_totalReleased += payment;
unchecked {
_released[account] += payment;
}
AddressUpgradeable.sendValue(account, payment);
emit PaymentReleased(account, payment);
}
/**
* @dev Triggers a transfer to `account` of the amount of `token` tokens they are owed, according to their
* percentage of the total shares and their previous withdrawals. `token` must be the address of an IERC20
* contract.
*/
function release(IERC20Upgradeable token, address account) public virtual {
require(_shares[account] > 0, "PaymentSplitter: account has no shares");
uint256 payment = releasable(token, account);
require(payment != 0, "PaymentSplitter: account is not due payment");
// _erc20TotalReleased[token] is the sum of all values in _erc20Released[token].
// If "_erc20TotalReleased[token] += payment" does not overflow, then "_erc20Released[token][account] += payment"
// cannot overflow.
_erc20TotalReleased[token] += payment;
unchecked {
_erc20Released[token][account] += payment;
}
SafeERC20Upgradeable.safeTransfer(token, account, payment);
emit ERC20PaymentReleased(token, account, payment);
}
/**
* @dev internal logic for computing the pending payment of an `account` given the token historical balances and
* already released amounts.
*/
function _pendingPayment(
address account,
uint256 totalReceived,
uint256 alreadyReleased
) private view returns (uint256) {
return (totalReceived * _shares[account]) / _totalShares - alreadyReleased;
}
/**
* @dev Add a new payee to the contract.
* @param account The address of the payee to add.
* @param shares_ The number of shares owned by the payee.
*/
function _addPayee(address account, uint256 shares_) private {
require(account != address(0), "PaymentSplitter: account is the zero address");
require(shares_ > 0, "PaymentSplitter: shares are 0");
require(_shares[account] == 0, "PaymentSplitter: account already has shares");
_payees.push(account);
_shares[account] = shares_;
_totalShares = _totalShares + shares_;
emit PayeeAdded(account, shares_);
}
/**
* @dev This empty reserved space is put in place to allow future versions to add new
* variables without shifting down storage in the inheritance chain.
* See https://docs.openzeppelin.com/contracts/4.x/upgradeable#storage_gaps
*/
uint256[43] private __gap;
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.6.0) (interfaces/IERC2981.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "../utils/introspection/IERC165Upgradeable.sol";
/**
* @dev Interface for the NFT Royalty Standard.
*
* A standardized way to retrieve royalty payment information for non-fungible tokens (NFTs) to enable universal
* support for royalty payments across all NFT marketplaces and ecosystem participants.
*
* _Available since v4.5._
*/
interface IERC2981Upgradeable is IERC165Upgradeable {
/**
* @dev Returns how much royalty is owed and to whom, based on a sale price that may be denominated in any unit of
* exchange. The royalty amount is denominated and should be paid in that same unit of exchange.
*/
function royaltyInfo(uint256 tokenId, uint256 salePrice)
external
view
returns (address receiver, uint256 royaltyAmount);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.8.0) (proxy/utils/Initializable.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.2;
import "../../utils/AddressUpgradeable.sol";
/**
* @dev This is a base contract to aid in writing upgradeable contracts, or any kind of contract that will be deployed
* behind a proxy. Since proxied contracts do not make use of a constructor, it's common to move constructor logic to an
* external initializer function, usually called `initialize`. It then becomes necessary to protect this initializer
* function so it can only be called once. The {initializer} modifier provided by this contract will have this effect.
*
* The initialization functions use a version number. Once a version number is used, it is consumed and cannot be
* reused. This mechanism prevents re-execution of each "step" but allows the creation of new initialization steps in
* case an upgrade adds a module that needs to be initialized.
*
* For example:
*
* [.hljs-theme-light.nopadding]
* ```
* contract MyToken is ERC20Upgradeable {
* function initialize() initializer public {
* __ERC20_init("MyToken", "MTK");
* }
* }
* contract MyTokenV2 is MyToken, ERC20PermitUpgradeable {
* function initializeV2() reinitializer(2) public {
* __ERC20Permit_init("MyToken");
* }
* }
* ```
*
* TIP: To avoid leaving the proxy in an uninitialized state, the initializer function should be called as early as
* possible by providing the encoded function call as the `_data` argument to {ERC1967Proxy-constructor}.
*
* CAUTION: When used with inheritance, manual care must be taken to not invoke a parent initializer twice, or to ensure
* that all initializers are idempotent. This is not verified automatically as constructors are by Solidity.
*
* [CAUTION]
* ====
* Avoid leaving a contract uninitialized.
*
* An uninitialized contract can be taken over by an attacker. This applies to both a proxy and its implementation
* contract, which may impact the proxy. To prevent the implementation contract from being used, you should invoke
* the {_disableInitializers} function in the constructor to automatically lock it when it is deployed:
*
* [.hljs-theme-light.nopadding]
* ```
* /// @custom:oz-upgrades-unsafe-allow constructor
* constructor() {
* _disableInitializers();
* }
* ```
* ====
*/
abstract contract Initializable {
/**
* @dev Indicates that the contract has been initialized.
* @custom:oz-retyped-from bool
*/
uint8 private _initialized;
/**
* @dev Indicates that the contract is in the process of being initialized.
*/
bool private _initializing;
/**
* @dev Triggered when the contract has been initialized or reinitialized.
*/
event Initialized(uint8 version);
/**
* @dev A modifier that defines a protected initializer function that can be invoked at most once. In its scope,
* `onlyInitializing` functions can be used to initialize parent contracts.
*
* Similar to `reinitializer(1)`, except that functions marked with `initializer` can be nested in the context of a
* constructor.
*
* Emits an {Initialized} event.
*/
modifier initializer() {
bool isTopLevelCall = !_initializing;
require(
(isTopLevelCall && _initialized < 1) || (!AddressUpgradeable.isContract(address(this)) && _initialized == 1),
"Initializable: contract is already initialized"
);
_initialized = 1;
if (isTopLevelCall) {
_initializing = true;
}
_;
if (isTopLevelCall) {
_initializing = false;
emit Initialized(1);
}
}
/**
* @dev A modifier that defines a protected reinitializer function that can be invoked at most once, and only if the
* contract hasn't been initialized to a greater version before. In its scope, `onlyInitializing` functions can be
* used to initialize parent contracts.
*
* A reinitializer may be used after the original initialization step. This is essential to configure modules that
* are added through upgrades and that require initialization.
*
* When `version` is 1, this modifier is similar to `initializer`, except that functions marked with `reinitializer`
* cannot be nested. If one is invoked in the context of another, execution will revert.
*
* Note that versions can jump in increments greater than 1; this implies that if multiple reinitializers coexist in
* a contract, executing them in the right order is up to the developer or operator.
*
* WARNING: setting the version to 255 will prevent any future reinitialization.
*
* Emits an {Initialized} event.
*/
modifier reinitializer(uint8 version) {
require(!_initializing && _initialized < version, "Initializable: contract is already initialized");
_initialized = version;
_initializing = true;
_;
_initializing = false;
emit Initialized(version);
}
/**
* @dev Modifier to protect an initialization function so that it can only be invoked by functions with the
* {initializer} and {reinitializer} modifiers, directly or indirectly.
*/
modifier onlyInitializing() {
require(_initializing, "Initializable: contract is not initializing");
_;
}
/**
* @dev Locks the contract, preventing any future reinitialization. This cannot be part of an initializer call.
* Calling this in the constructor of a contract will prevent that contract from being initialized or reinitialized
* to any version. It is recommended to use this to lock implementation contracts that are designed to be called
* through proxies.
*
* Emits an {Initialized} event the first time it is successfully executed.
*/
function _disableInitializers() internal virtual {
require(!_initializing, "Initializable: contract is initializing");
if (_initialized < type(uint8).max) {
_initialized = type(uint8).max;
emit Initialized(type(uint8).max);
}
}
/**
* @dev Internal function that returns the initialized version. Returns `_initialized`
*/
function _getInitializedVersion() internal view returns (uint8) {
return _initialized;
}
/**
* @dev Internal function that returns the initialized version. Returns `_initializing`
*/
function _isInitializing() internal view returns (bool) {
return _initializing;
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (token/common/ERC2981.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "../../interfaces/IERC2981Upgradeable.sol";
import "../../utils/introspection/ERC165Upgradeable.sol";
import "../../proxy/utils/Initializable.sol";
/**
* @dev Implementation of the NFT Royalty Standard, a standardized way to retrieve royalty payment information.
*
* Royalty information can be specified globally for all token ids via {_setDefaultRoyalty}, and/or individually for
* specific token ids via {_setTokenRoyalty}. The latter takes precedence over the first.
*
* Royalty is specified as a fraction of sale price. {_feeDenominator} is overridable but defaults to 10000, meaning the
* fee is specified in basis points by default.
*
* IMPORTANT: ERC-2981 only specifies a way to signal royalty information and does not enforce its payment. See
* https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2981#optional-royalty-payments[Rationale] in the EIP. Marketplaces are expected to
* voluntarily pay royalties together with sales, but note that this standard is not yet widely supported.
*
* _Available since v4.5._
*/
abstract contract ERC2981Upgradeable is Initializable, IERC2981Upgradeable, ERC165Upgradeable {
function __ERC2981_init() internal onlyInitializing {
}
function __ERC2981_init_unchained() internal onlyInitializing {
}
struct RoyaltyInfo {
address receiver;
uint96 royaltyFraction;
}
RoyaltyInfo private _defaultRoyaltyInfo;
mapping(uint256 => RoyaltyInfo) private _tokenRoyaltyInfo;
/**
* @dev See {IERC165-supportsInterface}.
*/
function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override(IERC165Upgradeable, ERC165Upgradeable) returns (bool) {
return interfaceId == type(IERC2981Upgradeable).interfaceId || super.supportsInterface(interfaceId);
}
/**
* @inheritdoc IERC2981Upgradeable
*/
function royaltyInfo(uint256 _tokenId, uint256 _salePrice) public view virtual override returns (address, uint256) {
RoyaltyInfo memory royalty = _tokenRoyaltyInfo[_tokenId];
if (royalty.receiver == address(0)) {
royalty = _defaultRoyaltyInfo;
}
uint256 royaltyAmount = (_salePrice * royalty.royaltyFraction) / _feeDenominator();
return (royalty.receiver, royaltyAmount);
}
/**
* @dev The denominator with which to interpret the fee set in {_setTokenRoyalty} and {_setDefaultRoyalty} as a
* fraction of the sale price. Defaults to 10000 so fees are expressed in basis points, but may be customized by an
* override.
*/
function _feeDenominator() internal pure virtual returns (uint96) {
return 10000;
}
/**
* @dev Sets the royalty information that all ids in this contract will default to.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `receiver` cannot be the zero address.
* - `feeNumerator` cannot be greater than the fee denominator.
*/
function _setDefaultRoyalty(address receiver, uint96 feeNumerator) internal virtual {
require(feeNumerator <= _feeDenominator(), "ERC2981: royalty fee will exceed salePrice");
require(receiver != address(0), "ERC2981: invalid receiver");
_defaultRoyaltyInfo = RoyaltyInfo(receiver, feeNumerator);
}
/**
* @dev Removes default royalty information.
*/
function _deleteDefaultRoyalty() internal virtual {
delete _defaultRoyaltyInfo;
}
/**
* @dev Sets the royalty information for a specific token id, overriding the global default.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `receiver` cannot be the zero address.
* - `feeNumerator` cannot be greater than the fee denominator.
*/
function _setTokenRoyalty(
uint256 tokenId,
address receiver,
uint96 feeNumerator
) internal virtual {
require(feeNumerator <= _feeDenominator(), "ERC2981: royalty fee will exceed salePrice");
require(receiver != address(0), "ERC2981: Invalid parameters");
_tokenRoyaltyInfo[tokenId] = RoyaltyInfo(receiver, feeNumerator);
}
/**
* @dev Resets royalty information for the token id back to the global default.
*/
function _resetTokenRoyalty(uint256 tokenId) internal virtual {
delete _tokenRoyaltyInfo[tokenId];
}
/**
* @dev This empty reserved space is put in place to allow future versions to add new
* variables without shifting down storage in the inheritance chain.
* See https://docs.openzeppelin.com/contracts/4.x/upgradeable#storage_gaps
*/
uint256[48] private __gap;
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (token/ERC20/extensions/draft-IERC20Permit.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev Interface of the ERC20 Permit extension allowing approvals to be made via signatures, as defined in
* https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2612[EIP-2612].
*
* Adds the {permit} method, which can be used to change an account's ERC20 allowance (see {IERC20-allowance}) by
* presenting a message signed by the account. By not relying on {IERC20-approve}, the token holder account doesn't
* need to send a transaction, and thus is not required to hold Ether at all.
*/
interface IERC20PermitUpgradeable {
/**
* @dev Sets `value` as the allowance of `spender` over ``owner``'s tokens,
* given ``owner``'s signed approval.
*
* IMPORTANT: The same issues {IERC20-approve} has related to transaction
* ordering also apply here.
*
* Emits an {Approval} event.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `spender` cannot be the zero address.
* - `deadline` must be a timestamp in the future.
* - `v`, `r` and `s` must be a valid `secp256k1` signature from `owner`
* over the EIP712-formatted function arguments.
* - the signature must use ``owner``'s current nonce (see {nonces}).
*
* For more information on the signature format, see the
* https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2612#specification[relevant EIP
* section].
*/
function permit(
address owner,
address spender,
uint256 value,
uint256 deadline,
uint8 v,
bytes32 r,
bytes32 s
) external;
/**
* @dev Returns the current nonce for `owner`. This value must be
* included whenever a signature is generated for {permit}.
*
* Every successful call to {permit} increases ``owner``'s nonce by one. This
* prevents a signature from being used multiple times.
*/
function nonces(address owner) external view returns (uint256);
/**
* @dev Returns the domain separator used in the encoding of the signature for {permit}, as defined by {EIP712}.
*/
// solhint-disable-next-line func-name-mixedcase
function DOMAIN_SEPARATOR() external view returns (bytes32);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.6.0) (token/ERC20/IERC20.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev Interface of the ERC20 standard as defined in the EIP.
*/
interface IERC20Upgradeable {
/**
* @dev Emitted when `value` tokens are moved from one account (`from`) to
* another (`to`).
*
* Note that `value` may be zero.
*/
event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 value);
/**
* @dev Emitted when the allowance of a `spender` for an `owner` is set by
* a call to {approve}. `value` is the new allowance.
*/
event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed spender, uint256 value);
/**
* @dev Returns the amount of tokens in existence.
*/
function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256);
/**
* @dev Returns the amount of tokens owned by `account`.
*/
function balanceOf(address account) external view returns (uint256);
/**
* @dev Moves `amount` tokens from the caller's account to `to`.
*
* Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function transfer(address to, uint256 amount) external returns (bool);
/**
* @dev Returns the remaining number of tokens that `spender` will be
* allowed to spend on behalf of `owner` through {transferFrom}. This is
* zero by default.
*
* This value changes when {approve} or {transferFrom} are called.
*/
function allowance(address owner, address spender) external view returns (uint256);
/**
* @dev Sets `amount` as the allowance of `spender` over the caller's tokens.
*
* Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded.
*
* IMPORTANT: Beware that changing an allowance with this method brings the risk
* that someone may use both the old and the new allowance by unfortunate
* transaction ordering. One possible solution to mitigate this race
* condition is to first reduce the spender's allowance to 0 and set the
* desired value afterwards:
* https://github.com/ethereum/EIPs/issues/20#issuecomment-263524729
*
* Emits an {Approval} event.
*/
function approve(address spender, uint256 amount) external returns (bool);
/**
* @dev Moves `amount` tokens from `from` to `to` using the
* allowance mechanism. `amount` is then deducted from the caller's
* allowance.
*
* Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function transferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 amount
) external returns (bool);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.8.0) (token/ERC20/utils/SafeERC20.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "../IERC20Upgradeable.sol";
import "../extensions/draft-IERC20PermitUpgradeable.sol";
import "../../../utils/AddressUpgradeable.sol";
/**
* @title SafeERC20
* @dev Wrappers around ERC20 operations that throw on failure (when the token
* contract returns false). Tokens that return no value (and instead revert or
* throw on failure) are also supported, non-reverting calls are assumed to be
* successful.
* To use this library you can add a `using SafeERC20 for IERC20;` statement to your contract,
* which allows you to call the safe operations as `token.safeTransfer(...)`, etc.
*/
library SafeERC20Upgradeable {
using AddressUpgradeable for address;
function safeTransfer(
IERC20Upgradeable token,
address to,
uint256 value
) internal {
_callOptionalReturn(token, abi.encodeWithSelector(token.transfer.selector, to, value));
}
function safeTransferFrom(
IERC20Upgradeable token,
address from,
address to,
uint256 value
) internal {
_callOptionalReturn(token, abi.encodeWithSelector(token.transferFrom.selector, from, to, value));
}
/**
* @dev Deprecated. This function has issues similar to the ones found in
* {IERC20-approve}, and its usage is discouraged.
*
* Whenever possible, use {safeIncreaseAllowance} and
* {safeDecreaseAllowance} instead.
*/
function safeApprove(
IERC20Upgradeable token,
address spender,
uint256 value
) internal {
// safeApprove should only be called when setting an initial allowance,
// or when resetting it to zero. To increase and decrease it, use
// 'safeIncreaseAllowance' and 'safeDecreaseAllowance'
require(
(value == 0) || (token.allowance(address(this), spender) == 0),
"SafeERC20: approve from non-zero to non-zero allowance"
);
_callOptionalReturn(token, abi.encodeWithSelector(token.approve.selector, spender, value));
}
function safeIncreaseAllowance(
IERC20Upgradeable token,
address spender,
uint256 value
) internal {
uint256 newAllowance = token.allowance(address(this), spender) + value;
_callOptionalReturn(token, abi.encodeWithSelector(token.approve.selector, spender, newAllowance));
}
function safeDecreaseAllowance(
IERC20Upgradeable token,
address spender,
uint256 value
) internal {
unchecked {
uint256 oldAllowance = token.allowance(address(this), spender);
require(oldAllowance >= value, "SafeERC20: decreased allowance below zero");
uint256 newAllowance = oldAllowance - value;
_callOptionalReturn(token, abi.encodeWithSelector(token.approve.selector, spender, newAllowance));
}
}
function safePermit(
IERC20PermitUpgradeable token,
address owner,
address spender,
uint256 value,
uint256 deadline,
uint8 v,
bytes32 r,
bytes32 s
) internal {
uint256 nonceBefore = token.nonces(owner);
token.permit(owner, spender, value, deadline, v, r, s);
uint256 nonceAfter = token.nonces(owner);
require(nonceAfter == nonceBefore + 1, "SafeERC20: permit did not succeed");
}
/**
* @dev Imitates a Solidity high-level call (i.e. a regular function call to a contract), relaxing the requirement
* on the return value: the return value is optional (but if data is returned, it must not be false).
* @param token The token targeted by the call.
* @param data The call data (encoded using abi.encode or one of its variants).
*/
function _callOptionalReturn(IERC20Upgradeable token, bytes memory data) private {
// We need to perform a low level call here, to bypass Solidity's return data size checking mechanism, since
// we're implementing it ourselves. We use {Address-functionCall} to perform this call, which verifies that
// the target address contains contract code and also asserts for success in the low-level call.
bytes memory returndata = address(token).functionCall(data, "SafeERC20: low-level call failed");
if (returndata.length > 0) {
// Return data is optional
require(abi.decode(returndata, (bool)), "SafeERC20: ERC20 operation did not succeed");
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.8.0) (utils/Address.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.1;
/**
* @dev Collection of functions related to the address type
*/
library AddressUpgradeable {
/**
* @dev Returns true if `account` is a contract.
*
* [IMPORTANT]
* ====
* It is unsafe to assume that an address for which this function returns
* false is an externally-owned account (EOA) and not a contract.
*
* Among others, `isContract` will return false for the following
* types of addresses:
*
* - an externally-owned account
* - a contract in construction
* - an address where a contract will be created
* - an address where a contract lived, but was destroyed
* ====
*
* [IMPORTANT]
* ====
* You shouldn't rely on `isContract` to protect against flash loan attacks!
*
* Preventing calls from contracts is highly discouraged. It breaks composability, breaks support for smart wallets
* like Gnosis Safe, and does not provide security since it can be circumvented by calling from a contract
* constructor.
* ====
*/
function isContract(address account) internal view returns (bool) {
// This method relies on extcodesize/address.code.length, which returns 0
// for contracts in construction, since the code is only stored at the end
// of the constructor execution.
return account.code.length > 0;
}
/**
* @dev Replacement for Solidity's `transfer`: sends `amount` wei to
* `recipient`, forwarding all available gas and reverting on errors.
*
* https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1884[EIP1884] increases the gas cost
* of certain opcodes, possibly making contracts go over the 2300 gas limit
* imposed by `transfer`, making them unable to receive funds via
* `transfer`. {sendValue} removes this limitation.
*
* https://diligence.consensys.net/posts/2019/09/stop-using-soliditys-transfer-now/[Learn more].
*
* IMPORTANT: because control is transferred to `recipient`, care must be
* taken to not create reentrancy vulnerabilities. Consider using
* {ReentrancyGuard} or the
* https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/v0.5.11/security-considerations.html#use-the-checks-effects-interactions-pattern[checks-effects-interactions pattern].
*/
function sendValue(address payable recipient, uint256 amount) internal {
require(address(this).balance >= amount, "Address: insufficient balance");
(bool success, ) = recipient.call{value: amount}("");
require(success, "Address: unable to send value, recipient may have reverted");
}
/**
* @dev Performs a Solidity function call using a low level `call`. A
* plain `call` is an unsafe replacement for a function call: use this
* function instead.
*
* If `target` reverts with a revert reason, it is bubbled up by this
* function (like regular Solidity function calls).
*
* Returns the raw returned data. To convert to the expected return value,
* use https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/latest/units-and-global-variables.html?highlight=abi.decode#abi-encoding-and-decoding-functions[`abi.decode`].
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `target` must be a contract.
* - calling `target` with `data` must not revert.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) {
return functionCallWithValue(target, data, 0, "Address: low-level call failed");
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], but with
* `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCall(
address target,
bytes memory data,
string memory errorMessage
) internal returns (bytes memory) {
return functionCallWithValue(target, data, 0, errorMessage);
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
* but also transferring `value` wei to `target`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - the calling contract must have an ETH balance of at least `value`.
* - the called Solidity function must be `payable`.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCallWithValue(
address target,
bytes memory data,
uint256 value
) internal returns (bytes memory) {
return functionCallWithValue(target, data, value, "Address: low-level call with value failed");
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCallWithValue-address-bytes-uint256-}[`functionCallWithValue`], but
* with `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCallWithValue(
address target,
bytes memory data,
uint256 value,
string memory errorMessage
) internal returns (bytes memory) {
require(address(this).balance >= value, "Address: insufficient balance for call");
(bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.call{value: value}(data);
return verifyCallResultFromTarget(target, success, returndata, errorMessage);
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
* but performing a static call.
*
* _Available since v3.3._
*/
function functionStaticCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
return functionStaticCall(target, data, "Address: low-level static call failed");
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`],
* but performing a static call.
*
* _Available since v3.3._
*/
function functionStaticCall(
address target,
bytes memory data,
string memory errorMessage
) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
(bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.staticcall(data);
return verifyCallResultFromTarget(target, success, returndata, errorMessage);
}
/**
* @dev Tool to verify that a low level call to smart-contract was successful, and revert (either by bubbling
* the revert reason or using the provided one) in case of unsuccessful call or if target was not a contract.
*
* _Available since v4.8._
*/
function verifyCallResultFromTarget(
address target,
bool success,
bytes memory returndata,
string memory errorMessage
) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
if (success) {
if (returndata.length == 0) {
// only check isContract if the call was successful and the return data is empty
// otherwise we already know that it was a contract
require(isContract(target), "Address: call to non-contract");
}
return returndata;
} else {
_revert(returndata, errorMessage);
}
}
/**
* @dev Tool to verify that a low level call was successful, and revert if it wasn't, either by bubbling the
* revert reason or using the provided one.
*
* _Available since v4.3._
*/
function verifyCallResult(
bool success,
bytes memory returndata,
string memory errorMessage
) internal pure returns (bytes memory) {
if (success) {
return returndata;
} else {
_revert(returndata, errorMessage);
}
}
function _revert(bytes memory returndata, string memory errorMessage) private pure {
// Look for revert reason and bubble it up if present
if (returndata.length > 0) {
// The easiest way to bubble the revert reason is using memory via assembly
/// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
assembly {
let returndata_size := mload(returndata)
revert(add(32, returndata), returndata_size)
}
} else {
revert(errorMessage);
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/Context.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "../proxy/utils/Initializable.sol";
/**
* @dev Provides information about the current execution context, including the
* sender of the transaction and its data. While these are generally available
* via msg.sender and msg.data, they should not be accessed in such a direct
* manner, since when dealing with meta-transactions the account sending and
* paying for execution may not be the actual sender (as far as an application
* is concerned).
*
* This contract is only required for intermediate, library-like contracts.
*/
abstract contract ContextUpgradeable is Initializable {
function __Context_init() internal onlyInitializing {
}
function __Context_init_unchained() internal onlyInitializing {
}
function _msgSender() internal view virtual returns (address) {
return msg.sender;
}
function _msgData() internal view virtual returns (bytes calldata) {
return msg.data;
}
/**
* @dev This empty reserved space is put in place to allow future versions to add new
* variables without shifting down storage in the inheritance chain.
* See https://docs.openzeppelin.com/contracts/4.x/upgradeable#storage_gaps
*/
uint256[50] private __gap;
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/introspection/ERC165.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "./IERC165Upgradeable.sol";
import "../../proxy/utils/Initializable.sol";
/**
* @dev Implementation of the {IERC165} interface.
*
* Contracts that want to implement ERC165 should inherit from this contract and override {supportsInterface} to check
* for the additional interface id that will be supported. For example:
*
* ```solidity
* function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
* return interfaceId == type(MyInterface).interfaceId || super.supportsInterface(interfaceId);
* }
* ```
*
* Alternatively, {ERC165Storage} provides an easier to use but more expensive implementation.
*/
abstract contract ERC165Upgradeable is Initializable, IERC165Upgradeable {
function __ERC165_init() internal onlyInitializing {
}
function __ERC165_init_unchained() internal onlyInitializing {
}
/**
* @dev See {IERC165-supportsInterface}.
*/
function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
return interfaceId == type(IERC165Upgradeable).interfaceId;
}
/**
* @dev This empty reserved space is put in place to allow future versions to add new
* variables without shifting down storage in the inheritance chain.
* See https://docs.openzeppelin.com/contracts/4.x/upgradeable#storage_gaps
*/
uint256[50] private __gap;
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/introspection/IERC165.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev Interface of the ERC165 standard, as defined in the
* https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165[EIP].
*
* Implementers can declare support of contract interfaces, which can then be
* queried by others ({ERC165Checker}).
*
* For an implementation, see {ERC165}.
*/
interface IERC165Upgradeable {
/**
* @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by
* `interfaceId`. See the corresponding
* https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified[EIP section]
* to learn more about how these ids are created.
*
* This function call must use less than 30 000 gas.
*/
function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) external view returns (bool);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.8.0) (utils/cryptography/MerkleProof.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev These functions deal with verification of Merkle Tree proofs.
*
* The tree and the proofs can be generated using our
* https://github.com/OpenZeppelin/merkle-tree[JavaScript library].
* You will find a quickstart guide in the readme.
*
* WARNING: You should avoid using leaf values that are 64 bytes long prior to
* hashing, or use a hash function other than keccak256 for hashing leaves.
* This is because the concatenation of a sorted pair of internal nodes in
* the merkle tree could be reinterpreted as a leaf value.
* OpenZeppelin's JavaScript library generates merkle trees that are safe
* against this attack out of the box.
*/
library MerkleProof {
/**
* @dev Returns true if a `leaf` can be proved to be a part of a Merkle tree
* defined by `root`. For this, a `proof` must be provided, containing
* sibling hashes on the branch from the leaf to the root of the tree. Each
* pair of leaves and each pair of pre-images are assumed to be sorted.
*/
function verify(
bytes32[] memory proof,
bytes32 root,
bytes32 leaf
) internal pure returns (bool) {
return processProof(proof, leaf) == root;
}
/**
* @dev Calldata version of {verify}
*
* _Available since v4.7._
*/
function verifyCalldata(
bytes32[] calldata proof,
bytes32 root,
bytes32 leaf
) internal pure returns (bool) {
return processProofCalldata(proof, leaf) == root;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the rebuilt hash obtained by traversing a Merkle tree up
* from `leaf` using `proof`. A `proof` is valid if and only if the rebuilt
* hash matches the root of the tree. When processing the proof, the pairs
* of leafs & pre-images are assumed to be sorted.
*
* _Available since v4.4._
*/
function processProof(bytes32[] memory proof, bytes32 leaf) internal pure returns (bytes32) {
bytes32 computedHash = leaf;
for (uint256 i = 0; i < proof.length; i++) {
computedHash = _hashPair(computedHash, proof[i]);
}
return computedHash;
}
/**
* @dev Calldata version of {processProof}
*
* _Available since v4.7._
*/
function processProofCalldata(bytes32[] calldata proof, bytes32 leaf) internal pure returns (bytes32) {
bytes32 computedHash = leaf;
for (uint256 i = 0; i < proof.length; i++) {
computedHash = _hashPair(computedHash, proof[i]);
}
return computedHash;
}
/**
* @dev Returns true if the `leaves` can be simultaneously proven to be a part of a merkle tree defined by
* `root`, according to `proof` and `proofFlags` as described in {processMultiProof}.
*
* CAUTION: Not all merkle trees admit multiproofs. See {processMultiProof} for details.
*
* _Available since v4.7._
*/
function multiProofVerify(
bytes32[] memory proof,
bool[] memory proofFlags,
bytes32 root,
bytes32[] memory leaves
) internal pure returns (bool) {
return processMultiProof(proof, proofFlags, leaves) == root;
}
/**
* @dev Calldata version of {multiProofVerify}
*
* CAUTION: Not all merkle trees admit multiproofs. See {processMultiProof} for details.
*
* _Available since v4.7._
*/
function multiProofVerifyCalldata(
bytes32[] calldata proof,
bool[] calldata proofFlags,
bytes32 root,
bytes32[] memory leaves
) internal pure returns (bool) {
return processMultiProofCalldata(proof, proofFlags, leaves) == root;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the root of a tree reconstructed from `leaves` and sibling nodes in `proof`. The reconstruction
* proceeds by incrementally reconstructing all inner nodes by combining a leaf/inner node with either another
* leaf/inner node or a proof sibling node, depending on whether each `proofFlags` item is true or false
* respectively.
*
* CAUTION: Not all merkle trees admit multiproofs. To use multiproofs, it is sufficient to ensure that: 1) the tree
* is complete (but not necessarily perfect), 2) the leaves to be proven are in the opposite order they are in the
* tree (i.e., as seen from right to left starting at the deepest layer and continuing at the next layer).
*
* _Available since v4.7._
*/
function processMultiProof(
bytes32[] memory proof,
bool[] memory proofFlags,
bytes32[] memory leaves
) internal pure returns (bytes32 merkleRoot) {
// This function rebuild the root hash by traversing the tree up from the leaves. The root is rebuilt by
// consuming and producing values on a queue. The queue starts with the `leaves` array, then goes onto the
// `hashes` array. At the end of the process, the last hash in the `hashes` array should contain the root of
// the merkle tree.
uint256 leavesLen = leaves.length;
uint256 totalHashes = proofFlags.length;
// Check proof validity.
require(leavesLen + proof.length - 1 == totalHashes, "MerkleProof: invalid multiproof");
// The xxxPos values are "pointers" to the next value to consume in each array. All accesses are done using
// `xxx[xxxPos++]`, which return the current value and increment the pointer, thus mimicking a queue's "pop".
bytes32[] memory hashes = new bytes32[](totalHashes);
uint256 leafPos = 0;
uint256 hashPos = 0;
uint256 proofPos = 0;
// At each step, we compute the next hash using two values:
// - a value from the "main queue". If not all leaves have been consumed, we get the next leaf, otherwise we
// get the next hash.
// - depending on the flag, either another value for the "main queue" (merging branches) or an element from the
// `proof` array.
for (uint256 i = 0; i < totalHashes; i++) {
bytes32 a = leafPos < leavesLen ? leaves[leafPos++] : hashes[hashPos++];
bytes32 b = proofFlags[i] ? leafPos < leavesLen ? leaves[leafPos++] : hashes[hashPos++] : proof[proofPos++];
hashes[i] = _hashPair(a, b);
}
if (totalHashes > 0) {
return hashes[totalHashes - 1];
} else if (leavesLen > 0) {
return leaves[0];
} else {
return proof[0];
}
}
/**
* @dev Calldata version of {processMultiProof}.
*
* CAUTION: Not all merkle trees admit multiproofs. See {processMultiProof} for details.
*
* _Available since v4.7._
*/
function processMultiProofCalldata(
bytes32[] calldata proof,
bool[] calldata proofFlags,
bytes32[] memory leaves
) internal pure returns (bytes32 merkleRoot) {
// This function rebuild the root hash by traversing the tree up from the leaves. The root is rebuilt by
// consuming and producing values on a queue. The queue starts with the `leaves` array, then goes onto the
// `hashes` array. At the end of the process, the last hash in the `hashes` array should contain the root of
// the merkle tree.
uint256 leavesLen = leaves.length;
uint256 totalHashes = proofFlags.length;
// Check proof validity.
require(leavesLen + proof.length - 1 == totalHashes, "MerkleProof: invalid multiproof");
// The xxxPos values are "pointers" to the next value to consume in each array. All accesses are done using
// `xxx[xxxPos++]`, which return the current value and increment the pointer, thus mimicking a queue's "pop".
bytes32[] memory hashes = new bytes32[](totalHashes);
uint256 leafPos = 0;
uint256 hashPos = 0;
uint256 proofPos = 0;
// At each step, we compute the next hash using two values:
// - a value from the "main queue". If not all leaves have been consumed, we get the next leaf, otherwise we
// get the next hash.
// - depending on the flag, either another value for the "main queue" (merging branches) or an element from the
// `proof` array.
for (uint256 i = 0; i < totalHashes; i++) {
bytes32 a = leafPos < leavesLen ? leaves[leafPos++] : hashes[hashPos++];
bytes32 b = proofFlags[i] ? leafPos < leavesLen ? leaves[leafPos++] : hashes[hashPos++] : proof[proofPos++];
hashes[i] = _hashPair(a, b);
}
if (totalHashes > 0) {
return hashes[totalHashes - 1];
} else if (leavesLen > 0) {
return leaves[0];
} else {
return proof[0];
}
}
function _hashPair(bytes32 a, bytes32 b) private pure returns (bytes32) {
return a < b ? _efficientHash(a, b) : _efficientHash(b, a);
}
function _efficientHash(bytes32 a, bytes32 b) private pure returns (bytes32 value) {
/// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
assembly {
mstore(0x00, a)
mstore(0x20, b)
value := keccak256(0x00, 0x40)
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.17;
import "erc721a-upgradeable/contracts/extensions/ERC721AQueryableUpgradeable.sol";
import "@openzeppelin/contracts-upgradeable/access/OwnableUpgradeable.sol";
import "@openzeppelin/contracts-upgradeable/token/common/ERC2981Upgradeable.sol";
import "@openzeppelin/contracts/utils/cryptography/MerkleProof.sol";
import "@openzeppelin/contracts-upgradeable/finance/PaymentSplitterUpgradeable.sol";
import "operator-filter-registry/src/upgradeable/OperatorFiltererUpgradeable.sol";
struct PhaseSettings {
/// @dev phase supply. This can be released to public by ending the phase.
uint64 maxSupply;
/// @dev tracks the total amount minted in the phase
uint64 amountMinted;
/// @dev wallet maximum for the phase
uint64 maxPerWallet;
/// @dev merkle root for the phase (if applicable, otherwise bytes32(0))
bytes32 merkleRoot;
/// @dev whether the phase is active
bool isActive;
/// @dev price for the phase (or free if 0)
uint256 price;
}
struct BaseSettings {
/// @dev public sale supply. ending a phase will carry supply into this value
uint64 maxSupply;
/// @dev global wallet maximum across all phases (including public)
uint64 maxPerWallet;
/// @dev tracks the total amount minted in the public sale
uint64 amountMinted;
/// @dev price for the public sale (or free if 0)
uint256 price;
}
struct SaleState {
uint64 numPhases;
mapping(uint256 => PhaseSettings) phases;
}
struct PaymentSplitterSettings {
address[] payees;
uint256[] shares;
}
struct RoyaltySettings {
address royaltyAddress;
uint96 royaltyAmount;
}
error SaleInactive();
error SoldOut();
error InvalidPrice();
error ExceedMaxPerWallet();
error InvalidProof();
error PhaseNotActive();
error NotAllowlisted();
error InvalidMintFunction();
error InvalidAirdrop();
error InvalidPhase();
error BurningNotAllowed();
/// @author Bueno.art
/// @title ERC-721 Multi-Phase Drop Contract
contract Bueno721Drop is
ERC721AQueryableUpgradeable,
OwnableUpgradeable,
ERC2981Upgradeable,
PaymentSplitterUpgradeable,
OperatorFiltererUpgradeable
{
string public _baseTokenURI;
SaleState public saleState;
BaseSettings public baseSettings;
address[] public withdrawAddresses;
mapping(address => mapping(uint256 => uint64)) private amountMintedForPhase;
bool public isPublicActive;
bool private allowBurning;
event TokensMinted(address indexed to, uint256 quantity);
event TokenBurned(address indexed owner, uint256 tokenId);
event TokensAirdropped(uint256 numRecipients, uint256 numTokens);
event PhasesActivated(uint256[] phaseIds, bool activatedPublic);
event PhasesPaused(uint256[] phaseIds, bool pausedPublic);
event PhaseEnded(uint256 phaseIds);
event BurnStatusChanged(bool burnActive);
event PhaseSettingsUpdated(uint256 phaseId, PhaseSettings settings);
event BaseSettingsUpdated(BaseSettings settings);
event BaseURIUpdated(string baseURI);
event RoyaltyUpdated(address royaltyAddress, uint96 royaltyAmount);
/// @custom:oz-upgrades-unsafe-allow constructor
constructor() {
_disableInitializers();
}
function initialize(
string memory _name,
string memory _symbol,
string memory _baseUri,
RoyaltySettings calldata _royaltySettings,
PhaseSettings[] calldata _phases,
BaseSettings calldata _baseSettings,
PaymentSplitterSettings calldata _paymentSplitterSettings,
uint256 _maxIntendedSupply,
bool _allowBurning,
address _deployer,
address _operatorFilter
) public initializerERC721A initializer {
__ERC721A_init(_name, _symbol);
__Ownable_init();
__PaymentSplitter_init(
_paymentSplitterSettings.payees,
_paymentSplitterSettings.shares
);
uint64 numPhases = uint64(_phases.length);
uint256 supplyValidationCount = _baseSettings.maxSupply;
for (uint256 i = 0; i < numPhases; ) {
saleState.phases[i] = _phases[i];
supplyValidationCount += _phases[i].maxSupply;
// numPhases has a maximum value of 2^64 - 1
unchecked {
++i;
}
}
require(
supplyValidationCount == _maxIntendedSupply,
"Supply of all phases must equal maxIntendedSupply"
);
_baseTokenURI = _baseUri;
withdrawAddresses = _paymentSplitterSettings.payees;
saleState.numPhases = numPhases;
baseSettings = _baseSettings;
allowBurning = _allowBurning;
_setDefaultRoyalty(
_royaltySettings.royaltyAddress,
_royaltySettings.royaltyAmount
);
transferOwnership(_deployer);
OperatorFiltererUpgradeable.__OperatorFilterer_init(
_operatorFilter,
_operatorFilter == address(0) ? false : true // only subscribe if a filter is provided
);
}
// ========= EXTERNAL MINTING METHODS =========
/**
* @notice Mint tokens for an allowlisted phase
* @dev Calling this function for a phase that doesn't have an allowlist will fail
*/
function mintPhaseAllowlist(
uint256 phaseIndex,
uint64 quantity,
bytes32[] calldata proof
) external payable {
uint64 updatedAmountMinted = _checkAllowlistPhaseMintConditions(
msg.sender,
quantity,
proof,
phaseIndex,
msg.value
);
_checkGlobalPerWalletMax(msg.sender, quantity);
saleState.phases[phaseIndex].amountMinted += quantity;
amountMintedForPhase[msg.sender][phaseIndex] = updatedAmountMinted;
_mint(msg.sender, quantity);
emit TokensMinted(msg.sender, quantity);
}
/**
* @notice Mint tokens for a non-allowlist phase.
* @dev Calling this function for a phase that has an allowlist will fail
*/
function mintPhase(uint256 phaseIndex, uint64 quantity) external payable {
uint64 updatedAmountMinted = _checkPhaseMintConditions(
msg.sender,
quantity,
phaseIndex,
msg.value
);
_checkGlobalPerWalletMax(msg.sender, quantity);
saleState.phases[phaseIndex].amountMinted += quantity;
amountMintedForPhase[msg.sender][phaseIndex] = updatedAmountMinted;
_mint(msg.sender, quantity);
emit TokensMinted(msg.sender, quantity);
}
/**
* @notice Mint tokens in the public sale
*/
function mintPublic(uint64 quantity) external payable {
uint64 updatedAmountMinted = _checkPublicMintConditions(
quantity,
msg.value
);
_checkGlobalPerWalletMax(msg.sender, quantity);
baseSettings.amountMinted = updatedAmountMinted;
_mint(msg.sender, quantity);
emit TokensMinted(msg.sender, quantity);
}
/**
* @notice Mint tokens in all possible phases (including public sale)
*/
function mintBatch(
uint64[] calldata quantities,
bytes32[][] calldata proofs,
uint256[] calldata phaseIndices,
uint64 publicQuantity
) external payable {
uint256 phaseLength = phaseIndices.length;
if (
phaseLength > saleState.numPhases ||
phaseLength != quantities.length ||
phaseLength != proofs.length
) {
revert InvalidPhase();
}
uint256 balance = msg.value;
uint256 quantityToMint;
for (uint256 i = 0; i < phaseLength; ) {
uint64 updatedAmount;
uint256 phaseIndex = phaseIndices[i];
uint64 quantity = quantities[i];
bytes32[] calldata proof = proofs[i];
PhaseSettings storage phase = saleState.phases[phaseIndex];
uint256 priceForPhase = phase.price * quantity;
// Since price is strictly checked in the _check* functions below,
// we have an additional check here to ensure that the balance doesn't underflow
if (balance < priceForPhase) {
revert InvalidPrice();
}
// if the phase has no allowlist, the merkleRoot will be zeroed out.
if (phase.merkleRoot == bytes32(0)) {
updatedAmount = _checkPhaseMintConditions(
msg.sender,
quantity,
phaseIndex,
priceForPhase
);
} else {
updatedAmount = _checkAllowlistPhaseMintConditions(
msg.sender,
quantity,
proof,
phaseIndex,
priceForPhase
);
}
// quantity & phaseLength have a maximum value of 2^64 - 1
// balance underflow is checked above
unchecked {
saleState.phases[phaseIndex].amountMinted += quantity;
amountMintedForPhase[msg.sender][phaseIndex] = updatedAmount;
balance -= priceForPhase;
quantityToMint += quantity;
++i;
}
}
uint256 totalMintQuantity = quantityToMint;
if (publicQuantity > 0) {
_checkPublicMintConditions(publicQuantity, balance);
// publicQuantity has a max value of 2^64 - 1
unchecked {
baseSettings.amountMinted += publicQuantity;
totalMintQuantity += publicQuantity;
}
}
_checkGlobalPerWalletMax(msg.sender, totalMintQuantity);
_mint(msg.sender, totalMintQuantity);
emit TokensMinted(msg.sender, totalMintQuantity);
}
/**
* @notice Burn a token, if the contract allows for it
*/
function burn(uint256 tokenId) external {
if (!allowBurning) {
revert BurningNotAllowed();
}
_burn(tokenId, true);
emit TokenBurned(msg.sender, tokenId);
}
// ========= OWNER METHODS =========
/**
* @notice Perform a batch airdrop for a particular phase.
* @dev Minted tokens are pulled from the phase that is specified in the airdropper.
*/
function airdropForPhase(
uint256 phaseIndex,
uint64[] calldata quantities,
address[] calldata recipients
) external onlyOwner {
uint256 numRecipients = recipients.length;
uint256 totalAirdropped;
if (numRecipients != quantities.length) revert InvalidAirdrop();
PhaseSettings storage phase = saleState.phases[phaseIndex];
for (uint256 i = 0; i < numRecipients; ) {
uint64 updatedAmountMinted = phase.amountMinted + quantities[i];
if (updatedAmountMinted > phase.maxSupply) {
revert SoldOut();
}
// airdrops are not subject to the per-wallet mint limits,
// but we track how much is minted for the phase
phase.amountMinted = updatedAmountMinted;
totalAirdropped += quantities[i];
_mint(recipients[i], quantities[i]);
// numRecipients has a maximum value of 2^256 - 1
unchecked {
++i;
}
}
emit TokensAirdropped(numRecipients, totalAirdropped);
}
/**
* @notice Perform a batch airdrop for the public phase.
* @dev Minted tokens are pulled from the public phase.
*/
function airdropPublic(
uint64[] calldata quantities,
address[] calldata recipients
) external onlyOwner {
uint256 numRecipients = recipients.length;
uint256 totalAirdropped;
if (numRecipients != quantities.length) revert InvalidAirdrop();
for (uint256 i = 0; i < numRecipients; ) {
uint64 updatedAmountMinted = baseSettings.amountMinted +
quantities[i];
if (updatedAmountMinted > baseSettings.maxSupply) {
revert SoldOut();
}
// airdrops are not subject to the per-wallet mint limits,
// but we track how much is minted for the phase
baseSettings.amountMinted = updatedAmountMinted;
totalAirdropped += quantities[i];
_mint(recipients[i], quantities[i]);
// numRecipients has a maximum value of 2^256 - 1
unchecked {
++i;
}
}
emit TokensAirdropped(numRecipients, totalAirdropped);
}
/**
* @notice Specify which phases are active.
* Public sale can be activated by setting `activatePublic` to true.
*/
function activatePhases(
uint256[] calldata phaseIndices,
bool activatePublic
) external onlyOwner {
uint256 numPhases = phaseIndices.length;
// activate all the phases provided in phaseIndices
for (uint256 i = 0; i < numPhases; ) {
uint256 phaseIndex = phaseIndices[i];
if (phaseIndex >= saleState.numPhases) {
// phaseIndex is out of bounds
revert InvalidPhase();
}
saleState.phases[phaseIndices[i]].isActive = true;
// numPhases has a maximum value of 2^256 - 1
unchecked {
++i;
}
}
// calling this function with activatePublic=false only indicates the public sale
// is not intended to be activated, but it does not pause it.
if (activatePublic) {
isPublicActive = true;
}
emit PhasesActivated(phaseIndices, activatePublic);
}
/**
* @notice Specify which phases are inactive (paused).
* Public sale can be paused by setting `pausePublic` to true.
* Pausing is separate from ending, since ending permanently closes the phase.
*/
function pausePhases(
uint256[] calldata phaseIndices,
bool pausePublic
) external onlyOwner {
uint256 numPhases = phaseIndices.length;
for (uint256 i = 0; i < numPhases; ) {
uint256 phaseIndex = phaseIndices[i];
if (phaseIndex >= saleState.numPhases) {
// phaseIndex is out of bounds
revert InvalidPhase();
}
saleState.phases[phaseIndex].isActive = false;
// numPhases has a maximum value of 2^256 - 1
unchecked {
++i;
}
}
// calling this function with pausePublic=false only indicates the public sale
// is not intended to be paused, but it does not pause it.
if (pausePublic) {
isPublicActive = false;
}
emit PhasesPaused(phaseIndices, pausePublic);
}
/**
* @notice If enabled, the token can be burned, for approved operators.
* @dev The burn method will revert unless this is enabled
*/
function toggleBurning() external onlyOwner {
allowBurning = !allowBurning;
emit BurnStatusChanged(allowBurning);
}
/**
* @notice Permanently closes a phase by capping the supply & releasing it
*/
function endPhase(uint256 phaseIndex) public onlyOwner {
PhaseSettings storage phase = saleState.phases[phaseIndex];
// if the phase never had supply, there is nothing to do
if (phase.maxSupply == 0) {
revert InvalidPhase();
}
// transfer the remaining supply into the base settings (used for public sale accounting)
baseSettings.maxSupply += phase.maxSupply - phase.amountMinted;
// remove the supply from the phase
phase.maxSupply = 0;
emit PhaseEnded(phaseIndex);
}
function endPhases(uint64[] calldata phaseIndices) external onlyOwner {
uint256 phaseIndicesLength = phaseIndices.length;
// ensure that phaseIndices argument will only ever be as large as the number of phases
if (phaseIndicesLength > saleState.numPhases) {
revert InvalidPhase();
}
for (uint256 i = 0; i < phaseIndicesLength; ) {
endPhase(phaseIndices[i]);
// phaseIndicesLength has a maximum value of 2^256 - 1
unchecked {
++i;
}
}
}
/**
* @notice Updates the minting rules for a particular phase
* @dev supply & amountMinted are not changeable
*/
function updatePhaseSettings(
uint256 phaseIndex,
PhaseSettings calldata phase
) external onlyOwner {
uint64 existingAmountMinted = saleState.phases[phaseIndex].amountMinted;
uint64 existingMaxSupply = saleState.phases[phaseIndex].maxSupply;
bool existingStatus = saleState.phases[phaseIndex].isActive;
saleState.phases[phaseIndex] = phase;
// ensure that the amountMinted, maxSupply, and status values cannot be set
saleState.phases[phaseIndex].amountMinted = existingAmountMinted;
saleState.phases[phaseIndex].maxSupply = existingMaxSupply;
saleState.phases[phaseIndex].isActive = existingStatus;
emit PhaseSettingsUpdated(phaseIndex, phase);
}
/**
* @notice Updates the the base minting settings
* The global maxPerWallet setting applies to all phases
* Pricing and other fields will apply to the public sale
*
* @dev maxSupply & amountMinted are not changeable
*/
function updateBaseSettings(
BaseSettings calldata _baseSettings
) external onlyOwner {
uint64 existingMaxSupply = baseSettings.maxSupply;
uint64 existingAmountMinted = baseSettings.amountMinted;
baseSettings = _baseSettings;
// ensure that the maxSupply & amountMinted value cannot be set
baseSettings.maxSupply = existingMaxSupply;
baseSettings.amountMinted = existingAmountMinted;
emit BaseSettingsUpdated(_baseSettings);
}
/**
* @dev Payment can be pulled via PaymentSplitter.release
* this method is provided for convenience to release all payee funds
*/
function withdraw() external onlyOwner {
uint256 numAddresses = withdrawAddresses.length;
for (uint256 i = 0; i < numAddresses; ) {
address payable withdrawAddress = payable(withdrawAddresses[i]);
if (releasable(withdrawAddress) > 0) {
release(withdrawAddress);
}
// numAddresses has a maximum value of 2^256 - 1
unchecked {
++i;
}
}
}
function setBaseURI(string memory baseURI) external onlyOwner {
_baseTokenURI = baseURI;
emit BaseURIUpdated(baseURI);
}
function setRoyaltyInfo(
address receiver,
uint96 feeBasisPoints
) external onlyOwner {
_setDefaultRoyalty(receiver, feeBasisPoints);
emit RoyaltyUpdated(receiver, feeBasisPoints);
}
// ========= VIEW METHODS =========
function _startTokenId() internal view virtual override returns (uint256) {
return 1;
}
function _checkAllowlistPhaseMintConditions(
address wallet,
uint64 quantity,
bytes32[] calldata proof,
uint256 phaseIndex,
uint256 balance
) internal view returns (uint64) {
PhaseSettings storage phase = saleState.phases[phaseIndex];
if (!phase.isActive) {
revert PhaseNotActive();
}
// there should be a valid merkle root for the phase
if (phase.merkleRoot == bytes32(0)) {
revert InvalidMintFunction();
}
if (phase.amountMinted + quantity > phase.maxSupply) {
revert SoldOut();
}
if (balance != quantity * phase.price) {
revert InvalidPrice();
}
if (
!MerkleProof.verify(
proof,
phase.merkleRoot,
keccak256(abi.encodePacked(wallet))
)
) {
revert InvalidProof();
}
uint256 amountMinted = amountMintedForPhase[wallet][phaseIndex];
uint256 updatedAmountMinted = amountMinted + quantity;
// phases can have a maxPerWallet
if (
phase.maxPerWallet > 0 && updatedAmountMinted > phase.maxPerWallet
) {
revert ExceedMaxPerWallet();
}
return uint64(updatedAmountMinted);
}
function _checkPhaseMintConditions(
address wallet,
uint256 quantity,
uint256 phaseIndex,
uint256 balance
) internal view returns (uint64) {
PhaseSettings storage phase = saleState.phases[phaseIndex];
if (!phase.isActive) {
revert PhaseNotActive();
}
// the phase should not have a merkleRoot
if (phase.merkleRoot != bytes32(0)) {
revert InvalidMintFunction();
}
if (phase.amountMinted + quantity > phase.maxSupply) {
revert SoldOut();
}
if (balance != quantity * phase.price) {
revert InvalidPrice();
}
uint256 amountMinted = amountMintedForPhase[wallet][phaseIndex];
uint256 updatedAmountMinted = amountMinted + quantity;
// phases can have a maxPerWallet
if (
phase.maxPerWallet > 0 && updatedAmountMinted > phase.maxPerWallet
) {
revert ExceedMaxPerWallet();
}
return uint64(updatedAmountMinted);
}
function _checkPublicMintConditions(
uint256 quantity,
uint256 balance
) internal view returns (uint64) {
if (!isPublicActive) {
revert PhaseNotActive();
}
uint256 updatedAmountMinted = baseSettings.amountMinted + quantity;
if (updatedAmountMinted > baseSettings.maxSupply) {
revert SoldOut();
}
if (balance != quantity * baseSettings.price) {
revert InvalidPrice();
}
return uint64(updatedAmountMinted);
}
function _checkGlobalPerWalletMax(
address wallet,
uint256 quantity
) internal view {
if (
baseSettings.maxPerWallet > 0 &&
_numberMinted(wallet) + quantity > baseSettings.maxPerWallet
) {
revert ExceedMaxPerWallet();
}
}
function getDataForPhase(
uint256 phaseIndex
) external view returns (PhaseSettings memory) {
return saleState.phases[phaseIndex];
}
function getMintBalance(address wallet) external view returns (uint256) {
return _numberMinted(wallet);
}
function getAmountMintedForPhase(
uint256 phaseIndex,
address wallet
) external view returns (uint64) {
return amountMintedForPhase[wallet][phaseIndex];
}
function getAmountMintedForOwner(
address wallet
) external view returns (uint256[] memory) {
uint256[] memory amountMintedPerPhase = new uint256[](
saleState.numPhases + 1
);
for (uint64 i = 0; i < saleState.numPhases; ) {
amountMintedPerPhase[i] = amountMintedForPhase[wallet][i];
// numPhases has a maximum value of 2^64 - 1
unchecked {
++i;
}
}
amountMintedPerPhase[saleState.numPhases] = _numberMinted(wallet);
return amountMintedPerPhase;
}
/**
* @dev See {ERC721-_baseURI}.
*/
function _baseURI() internal view virtual override returns (string memory) {
return _baseTokenURI;
}
function supportsInterface(
bytes4 interfaceId
)
public
view
virtual
override(IERC721AUpgradeable, ERC721AUpgradeable, ERC2981Upgradeable)
returns (bool)
{
return
ERC721AUpgradeable.supportsInterface(interfaceId) ||
ERC2981Upgradeable.supportsInterface(interfaceId);
}
// ========= OPERATOR FILTERER OVERRIDES =========
function setApprovalForAll(
address operator,
bool approved
)
public
override(ERC721AUpgradeable, IERC721AUpgradeable)
onlyAllowedOperatorApproval(operator)
{
super.setApprovalForAll(operator, approved);
}
function approve(
address operator,
uint256 tokenId
)
public
payable
override(ERC721AUpgradeable, IERC721AUpgradeable)
onlyAllowedOperatorApproval(operator)
{
super.approve(operator, tokenId);
}
function transferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
)
public
payable
override(ERC721AUpgradeable, IERC721AUpgradeable)
onlyAllowedOperator(from)
{
super.transferFrom(from, to, tokenId);
}
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
)
public
payable
override(ERC721AUpgradeable, IERC721AUpgradeable)
onlyAllowedOperator(from)
{
super.safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId);
}
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes memory data
)
public
payable
override(ERC721AUpgradeable, IERC721AUpgradeable)
onlyAllowedOperator(from)
{
super.safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, data);
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev This is a base contract to aid in writing upgradeable diamond facet contracts, or any kind of contract that will be deployed
* behind a proxy. Since proxied contracts do not make use of a constructor, it's common to move constructor logic to an
* external initializer function, usually called `initialize`. It then becomes necessary to protect this initializer
* function so it can only be called once. The {initializer} modifier provided by this contract will have this effect.
*
* TIP: To avoid leaving the proxy in an uninitialized state, the initializer function should be called as early as
* possible by providing the encoded function call as the `_data` argument to {ERC1967Proxy-constructor}.
*
* CAUTION: When used with inheritance, manual care must be taken to not invoke a parent initializer twice, or to ensure
* that all initializers are idempotent. This is not verified automatically as constructors are by Solidity.
*/
import {ERC721A__InitializableStorage} from './ERC721A__InitializableStorage.sol';
abstract contract ERC721A__Initializable {
using ERC721A__InitializableStorage for ERC721A__InitializableStorage.Layout;
/**
* @dev Modifier to protect an initializer function from being invoked twice.
*/
modifier initializerERC721A() {
// If the contract is initializing we ignore whether _initialized is set in order to support multiple
// inheritance patterns, but we only do this in the context of a constructor, because in other contexts the
// contract may have been reentered.
require(
ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initializing
? _isConstructor()
: !ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initialized,
'ERC721A__Initializable: contract is already initialized'
);
bool isTopLevelCall = !ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initializing;
if (isTopLevelCall) {
ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initializing = true;
ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initialized = true;
}
_;
if (isTopLevelCall) {
ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initializing = false;
}
}
/**
* @dev Modifier to protect an initialization function so that it can only be invoked by functions with the
* {initializer} modifier, directly or indirectly.
*/
modifier onlyInitializingERC721A() {
require(
ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initializing,
'ERC721A__Initializable: contract is not initializing'
);
_;
}
/// @dev Returns true if and only if the function is running in the constructor
function _isConstructor() private view returns (bool) {
// extcodesize checks the size of the code stored in an address, and
// address returns the current address. Since the code is still not
// deployed when running a constructor, any checks on its code size will
// yield zero, making it an effective way to detect if a contract is
// under construction or not.
address self = address(this);
uint256 cs;
assembly {
cs := extcodesize(self)
}
return cs == 0;
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev This is a base storage for the initialization function for upgradeable diamond facet contracts
**/
library ERC721A__InitializableStorage {
struct Layout {
/*
* Indicates that the contract has been initialized.
*/
bool _initialized;
/*
* Indicates that the contract is in the process of being initialized.
*/
bool _initializing;
}
bytes32 internal constant STORAGE_SLOT = keccak256('ERC721A.contracts.storage.initializable.facet');
function layout() internal pure returns (Layout storage l) {
bytes32 slot = STORAGE_SLOT;
assembly {
l.slot := slot
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
library ERC721AStorage {
// Bypass for a `--via-ir` bug (https://github.com/chiru-labs/ERC721A/pull/364).
struct TokenApprovalRef {
address value;
}
struct Layout {
// =============================================================
// STORAGE
// =============================================================
// The next token ID to be minted.
uint256 _currentIndex;
// The number of tokens burned.
uint256 _burnCounter;
// Token name
string _name;
// Token symbol
string _symbol;
// Mapping from token ID to ownership details
// An empty struct value does not necessarily mean the token is unowned.
// See {_packedOwnershipOf} implementation for details.
//
// Bits Layout:
// - [0..159] `addr`
// - [160..223] `startTimestamp`
// - [224] `burned`
// - [225] `nextInitialized`
// - [232..255] `extraData`
mapping(uint256 => uint256) _packedOwnerships;
// Mapping owner address to address data.
//
// Bits Layout:
// - [0..63] `balance`
// - [64..127] `numberMinted`
// - [128..191] `numberBurned`
// - [192..255] `aux`
mapping(address => uint256) _packedAddressData;
// Mapping from token ID to approved address.
mapping(uint256 => ERC721AStorage.TokenApprovalRef) _tokenApprovals;
// Mapping from owner to operator approvals
mapping(address => mapping(address => bool)) _operatorApprovals;
}
bytes32 internal constant STORAGE_SLOT = keccak256('ERC721A.contracts.storage.ERC721A');
function layout() internal pure returns (Layout storage l) {
bytes32 slot = STORAGE_SLOT;
assembly {
l.slot := slot
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// ERC721A Contracts v4.2.3
// Creator: Chiru Labs
pragma solidity ^0.8.4;
import './IERC721AUpgradeable.sol';
import {ERC721AStorage} from './ERC721AStorage.sol';
import './ERC721A__Initializable.sol';
/**
* @dev Interface of ERC721 token receiver.
*/
interface ERC721A__IERC721ReceiverUpgradeable {
function onERC721Received(
address operator,
address from,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes calldata data
) external returns (bytes4);
}
/**
* @title ERC721A
*
* @dev Implementation of the [ERC721](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-721)
* Non-Fungible Token Standard, including the Metadata extension.
* Optimized for lower gas during batch mints.
*
* Token IDs are minted in sequential order (e.g. 0, 1, 2, 3, ...)
* starting from `_startTokenId()`.
*
* Assumptions:
*
* - An owner cannot have more than 2**64 - 1 (max value of uint64) of supply.
* - The maximum token ID cannot exceed 2**256 - 1 (max value of uint256).
*/
contract ERC721AUpgradeable is ERC721A__Initializable, IERC721AUpgradeable {
using ERC721AStorage for ERC721AStorage.Layout;
// =============================================================
// CONSTANTS
// =============================================================
// Mask of an entry in packed address data.
uint256 private constant _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY = (1 << 64) - 1;
// The bit position of `numberMinted` in packed address data.
uint256 private constant _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED = 64;
// The bit position of `numberBurned` in packed address data.
uint256 private constant _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED = 128;
// The bit position of `aux` in packed address data.
uint256 private constant _BITPOS_AUX = 192;
// Mask of all 256 bits in packed address data except the 64 bits for `aux`.
uint256 private constant _BITMASK_AUX_COMPLEMENT = (1 << 192) - 1;
// The bit position of `startTimestamp` in packed ownership.
uint256 private constant _BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP = 160;
// The bit mask of the `burned` bit in packed ownership.
uint256 private constant _BITMASK_BURNED = 1 << 224;
// The bit position of the `nextInitialized` bit in packed ownership.
uint256 private constant _BITPOS_NEXT_INITIALIZED = 225;
// The bit mask of the `nextInitialized` bit in packed ownership.
uint256 private constant _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED = 1 << 225;
// The bit position of `extraData` in packed ownership.
uint256 private constant _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA = 232;
// Mask of all 256 bits in a packed ownership except the 24 bits for `extraData`.
uint256 private constant _BITMASK_EXTRA_DATA_COMPLEMENT = (1 << 232) - 1;
// The mask of the lower 160 bits for addresses.
uint256 private constant _BITMASK_ADDRESS = (1 << 160) - 1;
// The maximum `quantity` that can be minted with {_mintERC2309}.
// This limit is to prevent overflows on the address data entries.
// For a limit of 5000, a total of 3.689e15 calls to {_mintERC2309}
// is required to cause an overflow, which is unrealistic.
uint256 private constant _MAX_MINT_ERC2309_QUANTITY_LIMIT = 5000;
// The `Transfer` event signature is given by:
// `keccak256(bytes("Transfer(address,address,uint256)"))`.
bytes32 private constant _TRANSFER_EVENT_SIGNATURE =
0xddf252ad1be2c89b69c2b068fc378daa952ba7f163c4a11628f55a4df523b3ef;
// =============================================================
// CONSTRUCTOR
// =============================================================
function __ERC721A_init(string memory name_, string memory symbol_) internal onlyInitializingERC721A {
__ERC721A_init_unchained(name_, symbol_);
}
function __ERC721A_init_unchained(string memory name_, string memory symbol_) internal onlyInitializingERC721A {
ERC721AStorage.layout()._name = name_;
ERC721AStorage.layout()._symbol = symbol_;
ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex = _startTokenId();
}
// =============================================================
// TOKEN COUNTING OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns the starting token ID.
* To change the starting token ID, please override this function.
*/
function _startTokenId() internal view virtual returns (uint256) {
return 0;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the next token ID to be minted.
*/
function _nextTokenId() internal view virtual returns (uint256) {
return ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the total number of tokens in existence.
* Burned tokens will reduce the count.
* To get the total number of tokens minted, please see {_totalMinted}.
*/
function totalSupply() public view virtual override returns (uint256) {
// Counter underflow is impossible as _burnCounter cannot be incremented
// more than `_currentIndex - _startTokenId()` times.
unchecked {
return ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex - ERC721AStorage.layout()._burnCounter - _startTokenId();
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns the total amount of tokens minted in the contract.
*/
function _totalMinted() internal view virtual returns (uint256) {
// Counter underflow is impossible as `_currentIndex` does not decrement,
// and it is initialized to `_startTokenId()`.
unchecked {
return ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex - _startTokenId();
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns the total number of tokens burned.
*/
function _totalBurned() internal view virtual returns (uint256) {
return ERC721AStorage.layout()._burnCounter;
}
// =============================================================
// ADDRESS DATA OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns the number of tokens in `owner`'s account.
*/
function balanceOf(address owner) public view virtual override returns (uint256) {
if (owner == address(0)) revert BalanceQueryForZeroAddress();
return ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[owner] & _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY;
}
/**
* Returns the number of tokens minted by `owner`.
*/
function _numberMinted(address owner) internal view returns (uint256) {
return
(ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[owner] >> _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED) & _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY;
}
/**
* Returns the number of tokens burned by or on behalf of `owner`.
*/
function _numberBurned(address owner) internal view returns (uint256) {
return
(ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[owner] >> _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED) & _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY;
}
/**
* Returns the auxiliary data for `owner`. (e.g. number of whitelist mint slots used).
*/
function _getAux(address owner) internal view returns (uint64) {
return uint64(ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[owner] >> _BITPOS_AUX);
}
/**
* Sets the auxiliary data for `owner`. (e.g. number of whitelist mint slots used).
* If there are multiple variables, please pack them into a uint64.
*/
function _setAux(address owner, uint64 aux) internal virtual {
uint256 packed = ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[owner];
uint256 auxCasted;
// Cast `aux` with assembly to avoid redundant masking.
assembly {
auxCasted := aux
}
packed = (packed & _BITMASK_AUX_COMPLEMENT) | (auxCasted << _BITPOS_AUX);
ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[owner] = packed;
}
// =============================================================
// IERC165
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by
* `interfaceId`. See the corresponding
* [EIP section](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified)
* to learn more about how these ids are created.
*
* This function call must use less than 30000 gas.
*/
function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
// The interface IDs are constants representing the first 4 bytes
// of the XOR of all function selectors in the interface.
// See: [ERC165](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165)
// (e.g. `bytes4(i.functionA.selector ^ i.functionB.selector ^ ...)`)
return
interfaceId == 0x01ffc9a7 || // ERC165 interface ID for ERC165.
interfaceId == 0x80ac58cd || // ERC165 interface ID for ERC721.
interfaceId == 0x5b5e139f; // ERC165 interface ID for ERC721Metadata.
}
// =============================================================
// IERC721Metadata
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns the token collection name.
*/
function name() public view virtual override returns (string memory) {
return ERC721AStorage.layout()._name;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the token collection symbol.
*/
function symbol() public view virtual override returns (string memory) {
return ERC721AStorage.layout()._symbol;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the Uniform Resource Identifier (URI) for `tokenId` token.
*/
function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (string memory) {
if (!_exists(tokenId)) revert URIQueryForNonexistentToken();
string memory baseURI = _baseURI();
return bytes(baseURI).length != 0 ? string(abi.encodePacked(baseURI, _toString(tokenId))) : '';
}
/**
* @dev Base URI for computing {tokenURI}. If set, the resulting URI for each
* token will be the concatenation of the `baseURI` and the `tokenId`. Empty
* by default, it can be overridden in child contracts.
*/
function _baseURI() internal view virtual returns (string memory) {
return '';
}
// =============================================================
// OWNERSHIPS OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns the owner of the `tokenId` token.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*/
function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (address) {
return address(uint160(_packedOwnershipOf(tokenId)));
}
/**
* @dev Gas spent here starts off proportional to the maximum mint batch size.
* It gradually moves to O(1) as tokens get transferred around over time.
*/
function _ownershipOf(uint256 tokenId) internal view virtual returns (TokenOwnership memory) {
return _unpackedOwnership(_packedOwnershipOf(tokenId));
}
/**
* @dev Returns the unpacked `TokenOwnership` struct at `index`.
*/
function _ownershipAt(uint256 index) internal view virtual returns (TokenOwnership memory) {
return _unpackedOwnership(ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[index]);
}
/**
* @dev Initializes the ownership slot minted at `index` for efficiency purposes.
*/
function _initializeOwnershipAt(uint256 index) internal virtual {
if (ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[index] == 0) {
ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[index] = _packedOwnershipOf(index);
}
}
/**
* Returns the packed ownership data of `tokenId`.
*/
function _packedOwnershipOf(uint256 tokenId) private view returns (uint256 packed) {
if (_startTokenId() <= tokenId) {
packed = ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[tokenId];
// If not burned.
if (packed & _BITMASK_BURNED == 0) {
// If the data at the starting slot does not exist, start the scan.
if (packed == 0) {
if (tokenId >= ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex) revert OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken();
// Invariant:
// There will always be an initialized ownership slot
// (i.e. `ownership.addr != address(0) && ownership.burned == false`)
// before an unintialized ownership slot
// (i.e. `ownership.addr == address(0) && ownership.burned == false`)
// Hence, `tokenId` will not underflow.
//
// We can directly compare the packed value.
// If the address is zero, packed will be zero.
for (;;) {
unchecked {
packed = ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[--tokenId];
}
if (packed == 0) continue;
return packed;
}
}
// Otherwise, the data exists and is not burned. We can skip the scan.
// This is possible because we have already achieved the target condition.
// This saves 2143 gas on transfers of initialized tokens.
return packed;
}
}
revert OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken();
}
/**
* @dev Returns the unpacked `TokenOwnership` struct from `packed`.
*/
function _unpackedOwnership(uint256 packed) private pure returns (TokenOwnership memory ownership) {
ownership.addr = address(uint160(packed));
ownership.startTimestamp = uint64(packed >> _BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP);
ownership.burned = packed & _BITMASK_BURNED != 0;
ownership.extraData = uint24(packed >> _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA);
}
/**
* @dev Packs ownership data into a single uint256.
*/
function _packOwnershipData(address owner, uint256 flags) private view returns (uint256 result) {
assembly {
// Mask `owner` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
owner := and(owner, _BITMASK_ADDRESS)
// `owner | (block.timestamp << _BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP) | flags`.
result := or(owner, or(shl(_BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP, timestamp()), flags))
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns the `nextInitialized` flag set if `quantity` equals 1.
*/
function _nextInitializedFlag(uint256 quantity) private pure returns (uint256 result) {
// For branchless setting of the `nextInitialized` flag.
assembly {
// `(quantity == 1) << _BITPOS_NEXT_INITIALIZED`.
result := shl(_BITPOS_NEXT_INITIALIZED, eq(quantity, 1))
}
}
// =============================================================
// APPROVAL OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account. See {ERC721A-_approve}.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
*/
function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) public payable virtual override {
_approve(to, tokenId, true);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the account approved for `tokenId` token.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*/
function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (address) {
if (!_exists(tokenId)) revert ApprovalQueryForNonexistentToken();
return ERC721AStorage.layout()._tokenApprovals[tokenId].value;
}
/**
* @dev Approve or remove `operator` as an operator for the caller.
* Operators can call {transferFrom} or {safeTransferFrom}
* for any token owned by the caller.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The `operator` cannot be the caller.
*
* Emits an {ApprovalForAll} event.
*/
function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool approved) public virtual override {
ERC721AStorage.layout()._operatorApprovals[_msgSenderERC721A()][operator] = approved;
emit ApprovalForAll(_msgSenderERC721A(), operator, approved);
}
/**
* @dev Returns if the `operator` is allowed to manage all of the assets of `owner`.
*
* See {setApprovalForAll}.
*/
function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
return ERC721AStorage.layout()._operatorApprovals[owner][operator];
}
/**
* @dev Returns whether `tokenId` exists.
*
* Tokens can be managed by their owner or approved accounts via {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
*
* Tokens start existing when they are minted. See {_mint}.
*/
function _exists(uint256 tokenId) internal view virtual returns (bool) {
return
_startTokenId() <= tokenId &&
tokenId < ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex && // If within bounds,
ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[tokenId] & _BITMASK_BURNED == 0; // and not burned.
}
/**
* @dev Returns whether `msgSender` is equal to `approvedAddress` or `owner`.
*/
function _isSenderApprovedOrOwner(
address approvedAddress,
address owner,
address msgSender
) private pure returns (bool result) {
assembly {
// Mask `owner` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
owner := and(owner, _BITMASK_ADDRESS)
// Mask `msgSender` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
msgSender := and(msgSender, _BITMASK_ADDRESS)
// `msgSender == owner || msgSender == approvedAddress`.
result := or(eq(msgSender, owner), eq(msgSender, approvedAddress))
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns the storage slot and value for the approved address of `tokenId`.
*/
function _getApprovedSlotAndAddress(uint256 tokenId)
private
view
returns (uint256 approvedAddressSlot, address approvedAddress)
{
ERC721AStorage.TokenApprovalRef storage tokenApproval = ERC721AStorage.layout()._tokenApprovals[tokenId];
// The following is equivalent to `approvedAddress = _tokenApprovals[tokenId].value`.
assembly {
approvedAddressSlot := tokenApproval.slot
approvedAddress := sload(approvedAddressSlot)
}
}
// =============================================================
// TRANSFER OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Transfers `tokenId` from `from` to `to`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `from` cannot be the zero address.
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`.
* - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token
* by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function transferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) public payable virtual override {
uint256 prevOwnershipPacked = _packedOwnershipOf(tokenId);
if (address(uint160(prevOwnershipPacked)) != from) revert TransferFromIncorrectOwner();
(uint256 approvedAddressSlot, address approvedAddress) = _getApprovedSlotAndAddress(tokenId);
// The nested ifs save around 20+ gas over a compound boolean condition.
if (!_isSenderApprovedOrOwner(approvedAddress, from, _msgSenderERC721A()))
if (!isApprovedForAll(from, _msgSenderERC721A())) revert TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
if (to == address(0)) revert TransferToZeroAddress();
_beforeTokenTransfers(from, to, tokenId, 1);
// Clear approvals from the previous owner.
assembly {
if approvedAddress {
// This is equivalent to `delete _tokenApprovals[tokenId]`.
sstore(approvedAddressSlot, 0)
}
}
// Underflow of the sender's balance is impossible because we check for
// ownership above and the recipient's balance can't realistically overflow.
// Counter overflow is incredibly unrealistic as `tokenId` would have to be 2**256.
unchecked {
// We can directly increment and decrement the balances.
--ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[from]; // Updates: `balance -= 1`.
++ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[to]; // Updates: `balance += 1`.
// Updates:
// - `address` to the next owner.
// - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of transfering.
// - `burned` to `false`.
// - `nextInitialized` to `true`.
ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[tokenId] = _packOwnershipData(
to,
_BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED | _nextExtraData(from, to, prevOwnershipPacked)
);
// If the next slot may not have been initialized (i.e. `nextInitialized == false`) .
if (prevOwnershipPacked & _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED == 0) {
uint256 nextTokenId = tokenId + 1;
// If the next slot's address is zero and not burned (i.e. packed value is zero).
if (ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] == 0) {
// If the next slot is within bounds.
if (nextTokenId != ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex) {
// Initialize the next slot to maintain correctness for `ownerOf(tokenId + 1)`.
ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] = prevOwnershipPacked;
}
}
}
}
emit Transfer(from, to, tokenId);
_afterTokenTransfers(from, to, tokenId, 1);
}
/**
* @dev Equivalent to `safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, '')`.
*/
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) public payable virtual override {
safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, '');
}
/**
* @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `from` cannot be the zero address.
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`.
* - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token
* by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
* - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement
* {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes memory _data
) public payable virtual override {
transferFrom(from, to, tokenId);
if (to.code.length != 0)
if (!_checkContractOnERC721Received(from, to, tokenId, _data)) {
revert TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer();
}
}
/**
* @dev Hook that is called before a set of serially-ordered token IDs
* are about to be transferred. This includes minting.
* And also called before burning one token.
*
* `startTokenId` - the first token ID to be transferred.
* `quantity` - the amount to be transferred.
*
* Calling conditions:
*
* - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` will be
* transferred to `to`.
* - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` will be minted for `to`.
* - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` will be burned by `from`.
* - `from` and `to` are never both zero.
*/
function _beforeTokenTransfers(
address from,
address to,
uint256 startTokenId,
uint256 quantity
) internal virtual {}
/**
* @dev Hook that is called after a set of serially-ordered token IDs
* have been transferred. This includes minting.
* And also called after one token has been burned.
*
* `startTokenId` - the first token ID to be transferred.
* `quantity` - the amount to be transferred.
*
* Calling conditions:
*
* - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` has been
* transferred to `to`.
* - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` has been minted for `to`.
* - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` has been burned by `from`.
* - `from` and `to` are never both zero.
*/
function _afterTokenTransfers(
address from,
address to,
uint256 startTokenId,
uint256 quantity
) internal virtual {}
/**
* @dev Private function to invoke {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received} on a target contract.
*
* `from` - Previous owner of the given token ID.
* `to` - Target address that will receive the token.
* `tokenId` - Token ID to be transferred.
* `_data` - Optional data to send along with the call.
*
* Returns whether the call correctly returned the expected magic value.
*/
function _checkContractOnERC721Received(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes memory _data
) private returns (bool) {
try
ERC721A__IERC721ReceiverUpgradeable(to).onERC721Received(_msgSenderERC721A(), from, tokenId, _data)
returns (bytes4 retval) {
return retval == ERC721A__IERC721ReceiverUpgradeable(to).onERC721Received.selector;
} catch (bytes memory reason) {
if (reason.length == 0) {
revert TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer();
} else {
assembly {
revert(add(32, reason), mload(reason))
}
}
}
}
// =============================================================
// MINT OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `quantity` must be greater than 0.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event for each mint.
*/
function _mint(address to, uint256 quantity) internal virtual {
uint256 startTokenId = ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex;
if (quantity == 0) revert MintZeroQuantity();
_beforeTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
// Overflows are incredibly unrealistic.
// `balance` and `numberMinted` have a maximum limit of 2**64.
// `tokenId` has a maximum limit of 2**256.
unchecked {
// Updates:
// - `balance += quantity`.
// - `numberMinted += quantity`.
//
// We can directly add to the `balance` and `numberMinted`.
ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[to] += quantity * ((1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED) | 1);
// Updates:
// - `address` to the owner.
// - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of minting.
// - `burned` to `false`.
// - `nextInitialized` to `quantity == 1`.
ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[startTokenId] = _packOwnershipData(
to,
_nextInitializedFlag(quantity) | _nextExtraData(address(0), to, 0)
);
uint256 toMasked;
uint256 end = startTokenId + quantity;
// Use assembly to loop and emit the `Transfer` event for gas savings.
// The duplicated `log4` removes an extra check and reduces stack juggling.
// The assembly, together with the surrounding Solidity code, have been
// delicately arranged to nudge the compiler into producing optimized opcodes.
assembly {
// Mask `to` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
toMasked := and(to, _BITMASK_ADDRESS)
// Emit the `Transfer` event.
log4(
0, // Start of data (0, since no data).
0, // End of data (0, since no data).
_TRANSFER_EVENT_SIGNATURE, // Signature.
0, // `address(0)`.
toMasked, // `to`.
startTokenId // `tokenId`.
)
// The `iszero(eq(,))` check ensures that large values of `quantity`
// that overflows uint256 will make the loop run out of gas.
// The compiler will optimize the `iszero` away for performance.
for {
let tokenId := add(startTokenId, 1)
} iszero(eq(tokenId, end)) {
tokenId := add(tokenId, 1)
} {
// Emit the `Transfer` event. Similar to above.
log4(0, 0, _TRANSFER_EVENT_SIGNATURE, 0, toMasked, tokenId)
}
}
if (toMasked == 0) revert MintToZeroAddress();
ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex = end;
}
_afterTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
}
/**
* @dev Mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`.
*
* This function is intended for efficient minting only during contract creation.
*
* It emits only one {ConsecutiveTransfer} as defined in
* [ERC2309](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2309),
* instead of a sequence of {Transfer} event(s).
*
* Calling this function outside of contract creation WILL make your contract
* non-compliant with the ERC721 standard.
* For full ERC721 compliance, substituting ERC721 {Transfer} event(s) with the ERC2309
* {ConsecutiveTransfer} event is only permissible during contract creation.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `quantity` must be greater than 0.
*
* Emits a {ConsecutiveTransfer} event.
*/
function _mintERC2309(address to, uint256 quantity) internal virtual {
uint256 startTokenId = ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex;
if (to == address(0)) revert MintToZeroAddress();
if (quantity == 0) revert MintZeroQuantity();
if (quantity > _MAX_MINT_ERC2309_QUANTITY_LIMIT) revert MintERC2309QuantityExceedsLimit();
_beforeTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
// Overflows are unrealistic due to the above check for `quantity` to be below the limit.
unchecked {
// Updates:
// - `balance += quantity`.
// - `numberMinted += quantity`.
//
// We can directly add to the `balance` and `numberMinted`.
ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[to] += quantity * ((1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED) | 1);
// Updates:
// - `address` to the owner.
// - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of minting.
// - `burned` to `false`.
// - `nextInitialized` to `quantity == 1`.
ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[startTokenId] = _packOwnershipData(
to,
_nextInitializedFlag(quantity) | _nextExtraData(address(0), to, 0)
);
emit ConsecutiveTransfer(startTokenId, startTokenId + quantity - 1, address(0), to);
ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex = startTokenId + quantity;
}
_afterTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
}
/**
* @dev Safely mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement
* {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called for each safe transfer.
* - `quantity` must be greater than 0.
*
* See {_mint}.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event for each mint.
*/
function _safeMint(
address to,
uint256 quantity,
bytes memory _data
) internal virtual {
_mint(to, quantity);
unchecked {
if (to.code.length != 0) {
uint256 end = ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex;
uint256 index = end - quantity;
do {
if (!_checkContractOnERC721Received(address(0), to, index++, _data)) {
revert TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer();
}
} while (index < end);
// Reentrancy protection.
if (ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex != end) revert();
}
}
}
/**
* @dev Equivalent to `_safeMint(to, quantity, '')`.
*/
function _safeMint(address to, uint256 quantity) internal virtual {
_safeMint(to, quantity, '');
}
// =============================================================
// APPROVAL OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Equivalent to `_approve(to, tokenId, false)`.
*/
function _approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) internal virtual {
_approve(to, tokenId, false);
}
/**
* @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account.
* The approval is cleared when the token is transferred.
*
* Only a single account can be approved at a time, so approving the
* zero address clears previous approvals.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*
* Emits an {Approval} event.
*/
function _approve(
address to,
uint256 tokenId,
bool approvalCheck
) internal virtual {
address owner = ownerOf(tokenId);
if (approvalCheck)
if (_msgSenderERC721A() != owner)
if (!isApprovedForAll(owner, _msgSenderERC721A())) {
revert ApprovalCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
}
ERC721AStorage.layout()._tokenApprovals[tokenId].value = to;
emit Approval(owner, to, tokenId);
}
// =============================================================
// BURN OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Equivalent to `_burn(tokenId, false)`.
*/
function _burn(uint256 tokenId) internal virtual {
_burn(tokenId, false);
}
/**
* @dev Destroys `tokenId`.
* The approval is cleared when the token is burned.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function _burn(uint256 tokenId, bool approvalCheck) internal virtual {
uint256 prevOwnershipPacked = _packedOwnershipOf(tokenId);
address from = address(uint160(prevOwnershipPacked));
(uint256 approvedAddressSlot, address approvedAddress) = _getApprovedSlotAndAddress(tokenId);
if (approvalCheck) {
// The nested ifs save around 20+ gas over a compound boolean condition.
if (!_isSenderApprovedOrOwner(approvedAddress, from, _msgSenderERC721A()))
if (!isApprovedForAll(from, _msgSenderERC721A())) revert TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
}
_beforeTokenTransfers(from, address(0), tokenId, 1);
// Clear approvals from the previous owner.
assembly {
if approvedAddress {
// This is equivalent to `delete _tokenApprovals[tokenId]`.
sstore(approvedAddressSlot, 0)
}
}
// Underflow of the sender's balance is impossible because we check for
// ownership above and the recipient's balance can't realistically overflow.
// Counter overflow is incredibly unrealistic as `tokenId` would have to be 2**256.
unchecked {
// Updates:
// - `balance -= 1`.
// - `numberBurned += 1`.
//
// We can directly decrement the balance, and increment the number burned.
// This is equivalent to `packed -= 1; packed += 1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED;`.
ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[from] += (1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED) - 1;
// Updates:
// - `address` to the last owner.
// - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of burning.
// - `burned` to `true`.
// - `nextInitialized` to `true`.
ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[tokenId] = _packOwnershipData(
from,
(_BITMASK_BURNED | _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED) | _nextExtraData(from, address(0), prevOwnershipPacked)
);
// If the next slot may not have been initialized (i.e. `nextInitialized == false`) .
if (prevOwnershipPacked & _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED == 0) {
uint256 nextTokenId = tokenId + 1;
// If the next slot's address is zero and not burned (i.e. packed value is zero).
if (ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] == 0) {
// If the next slot is within bounds.
if (nextTokenId != ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex) {
// Initialize the next slot to maintain correctness for `ownerOf(tokenId + 1)`.
ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] = prevOwnershipPacked;
}
}
}
}
emit Transfer(from, address(0), tokenId);
_afterTokenTransfers(from, address(0), tokenId, 1);
// Overflow not possible, as _burnCounter cannot be exceed _currentIndex times.
unchecked {
ERC721AStorage.layout()._burnCounter++;
}
}
// =============================================================
// EXTRA DATA OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Directly sets the extra data for the ownership data `index`.
*/
function _setExtraDataAt(uint256 index, uint24 extraData) internal virtual {
uint256 packed = ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[index];
if (packed == 0) revert OwnershipNotInitializedForExtraData();
uint256 extraDataCasted;
// Cast `extraData` with assembly to avoid redundant masking.
assembly {
extraDataCasted := extraData
}
packed = (packed & _BITMASK_EXTRA_DATA_COMPLEMENT) | (extraDataCasted << _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA);
ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[index] = packed;
}
/**
* @dev Called during each token transfer to set the 24bit `extraData` field.
* Intended to be overridden by the cosumer contract.
*
* `previousExtraData` - the value of `extraData` before transfer.
*
* Calling conditions:
*
* - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` will be
* transferred to `to`.
* - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` will be minted for `to`.
* - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` will be burned by `from`.
* - `from` and `to` are never both zero.
*/
function _extraData(
address from,
address to,
uint24 previousExtraData
) internal view virtual returns (uint24) {}
/**
* @dev Returns the next extra data for the packed ownership data.
* The returned result is shifted into position.
*/
function _nextExtraData(
address from,
address to,
uint256 prevOwnershipPacked
) private view returns (uint256) {
uint24 extraData = uint24(prevOwnershipPacked >> _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA);
return uint256(_extraData(from, to, extraData)) << _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA;
}
// =============================================================
// OTHER OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns the message sender (defaults to `msg.sender`).
*
* If you are writing GSN compatible contracts, you need to override this function.
*/
function _msgSenderERC721A() internal view virtual returns (address) {
return msg.sender;
}
/**
* @dev Converts a uint256 to its ASCII string decimal representation.
*/
function _toString(uint256 value) internal pure virtual returns (string memory str) {
assembly {
// The maximum value of a uint256 contains 78 digits (1 byte per digit), but
// we allocate 0xa0 bytes to keep the free memory pointer 32-byte word aligned.
// We will need 1 word for the trailing zeros padding, 1 word for the length,
// and 3 words for a maximum of 78 digits. Total: 5 * 0x20 = 0xa0.
let m := add(mload(0x40), 0xa0)
// Update the free memory pointer to allocate.
mstore(0x40, m)
// Assign the `str` to the end.
str := sub(m, 0x20)
// Zeroize the slot after the string.
mstore(str, 0)
// Cache the end of the memory to calculate the length later.
let end := str
// We write the string from rightmost digit to leftmost digit.
// The following is essentially a do-while loop that also handles the zero case.
// prettier-ignore
for { let temp := value } 1 {} {
str := sub(str, 1)
// Write the character to the pointer.
// The ASCII index of the '0' character is 48.
mstore8(str, add(48, mod(temp, 10)))
// Keep dividing `temp` until zero.
temp := div(temp, 10)
// prettier-ignore
if iszero(temp) { break }
}
let length := sub(end, str)
// Move the pointer 32 bytes leftwards to make room for the length.
str := sub(str, 0x20)
// Store the length.
mstore(str, length)
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// ERC721A Contracts v4.2.3
// Creator: Chiru Labs
pragma solidity ^0.8.4;
import './IERC721AQueryableUpgradeable.sol';
import '../ERC721AUpgradeable.sol';
import '../ERC721A__Initializable.sol';
/**
* @title ERC721AQueryable.
*
* @dev ERC721A subclass with convenience query functions.
*/
abstract contract ERC721AQueryableUpgradeable is
ERC721A__Initializable,
ERC721AUpgradeable,
IERC721AQueryableUpgradeable
{
function __ERC721AQueryable_init() internal onlyInitializingERC721A {
__ERC721AQueryable_init_unchained();
}
function __ERC721AQueryable_init_unchained() internal onlyInitializingERC721A {}
/**
* @dev Returns the `TokenOwnership` struct at `tokenId` without reverting.
*
* If the `tokenId` is out of bounds:
*
* - `addr = address(0)`
* - `startTimestamp = 0`
* - `burned = false`
* - `extraData = 0`
*
* If the `tokenId` is burned:
*
* - `addr = <Address of owner before token was burned>`
* - `startTimestamp = <Timestamp when token was burned>`
* - `burned = true`
* - `extraData = <Extra data when token was burned>`
*
* Otherwise:
*
* - `addr = <Address of owner>`
* - `startTimestamp = <Timestamp of start of ownership>`
* - `burned = false`
* - `extraData = <Extra data at start of ownership>`
*/
function explicitOwnershipOf(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (TokenOwnership memory) {
TokenOwnership memory ownership;
if (tokenId < _startTokenId() || tokenId >= _nextTokenId()) {
return ownership;
}
ownership = _ownershipAt(tokenId);
if (ownership.burned) {
return ownership;
}
return _ownershipOf(tokenId);
}
/**
* @dev Returns an array of `TokenOwnership` structs at `tokenIds` in order.
* See {ERC721AQueryable-explicitOwnershipOf}
*/
function explicitOwnershipsOf(uint256[] calldata tokenIds)
external
view
virtual
override
returns (TokenOwnership[] memory)
{
unchecked {
uint256 tokenIdsLength = tokenIds.length;
TokenOwnership[] memory ownerships = new TokenOwnership[](tokenIdsLength);
for (uint256 i; i != tokenIdsLength; ++i) {
ownerships[i] = explicitOwnershipOf(tokenIds[i]);
}
return ownerships;
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns an array of token IDs owned by `owner`,
* in the range [`start`, `stop`)
* (i.e. `start <= tokenId < stop`).
*
* This function allows for tokens to be queried if the collection
* grows too big for a single call of {ERC721AQueryable-tokensOfOwner}.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `start < stop`
*/
function tokensOfOwnerIn(
address owner,
uint256 start,
uint256 stop
) external view virtual override returns (uint256[] memory) {
unchecked {
if (start >= stop) revert InvalidQueryRange();
uint256 tokenIdsIdx;
uint256 stopLimit = _nextTokenId();
// Set `start = max(start, _startTokenId())`.
if (start < _startTokenId()) {
start = _startTokenId();
}
// Set `stop = min(stop, stopLimit)`.
if (stop > stopLimit) {
stop = stopLimit;
}
uint256 tokenIdsMaxLength = balanceOf(owner);
// Set `tokenIdsMaxLength = min(balanceOf(owner), stop - start)`,
// to cater for cases where `balanceOf(owner)` is too big.
if (start < stop) {
uint256 rangeLength = stop - start;
if (rangeLength < tokenIdsMaxLength) {
tokenIdsMaxLength = rangeLength;
}
} else {
tokenIdsMaxLength = 0;
}
uint256[] memory tokenIds = new uint256[](tokenIdsMaxLength);
if (tokenIdsMaxLength == 0) {
return tokenIds;
}
// We need to call `explicitOwnershipOf(start)`,
// because the slot at `start` may not be initialized.
TokenOwnership memory ownership = explicitOwnershipOf(start);
address currOwnershipAddr;
// If the starting slot exists (i.e. not burned), initialize `currOwnershipAddr`.
// `ownership.address` will not be zero, as `start` is clamped to the valid token ID range.
if (!ownership.burned) {
currOwnershipAddr = ownership.addr;
}
for (uint256 i = start; i != stop && tokenIdsIdx != tokenIdsMaxLength; ++i) {
ownership = _ownershipAt(i);
if (ownership.burned) {
continue;
}
if (ownership.addr != address(0)) {
currOwnershipAddr = ownership.addr;
}
if (currOwnershipAddr == owner) {
tokenIds[tokenIdsIdx++] = i;
}
}
// Downsize the array to fit.
assembly {
mstore(tokenIds, tokenIdsIdx)
}
return tokenIds;
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns an array of token IDs owned by `owner`.
*
* This function scans the ownership mapping and is O(`totalSupply`) in complexity.
* It is meant to be called off-chain.
*
* See {ERC721AQueryable-tokensOfOwnerIn} for splitting the scan into
* multiple smaller scans if the collection is large enough to cause
* an out-of-gas error (10K collections should be fine).
*/
function tokensOfOwner(address owner) external view virtual override returns (uint256[] memory) {
unchecked {
uint256 tokenIdsIdx;
address currOwnershipAddr;
uint256 tokenIdsLength = balanceOf(owner);
uint256[] memory tokenIds = new uint256[](tokenIdsLength);
TokenOwnership memory ownership;
for (uint256 i = _startTokenId(); tokenIdsIdx != tokenIdsLength; ++i) {
ownership = _ownershipAt(i);
if (ownership.burned) {
continue;
}
if (ownership.addr != address(0)) {
currOwnershipAddr = ownership.addr;
}
if (currOwnershipAddr == owner) {
tokenIds[tokenIdsIdx++] = i;
}
}
return tokenIds;
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// ERC721A Contracts v4.2.3
// Creator: Chiru Labs
pragma solidity ^0.8.4;
import '../IERC721AUpgradeable.sol';
/**
* @dev Interface of ERC721AQueryable.
*/
interface IERC721AQueryableUpgradeable is IERC721AUpgradeable {
/**
* Invalid query range (`start` >= `stop`).
*/
error InvalidQueryRange();
/**
* @dev Returns the `TokenOwnership` struct at `tokenId` without reverting.
*
* If the `tokenId` is out of bounds:
*
* - `addr = address(0)`
* - `startTimestamp = 0`
* - `burned = false`
* - `extraData = 0`
*
* If the `tokenId` is burned:
*
* - `addr = <Address of owner before token was burned>`
* - `startTimestamp = <Timestamp when token was burned>`
* - `burned = true`
* - `extraData = <Extra data when token was burned>`
*
* Otherwise:
*
* - `addr = <Address of owner>`
* - `startTimestamp = <Timestamp of start of ownership>`
* - `burned = false`
* - `extraData = <Extra data at start of ownership>`
*/
function explicitOwnershipOf(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (TokenOwnership memory);
/**
* @dev Returns an array of `TokenOwnership` structs at `tokenIds` in order.
* See {ERC721AQueryable-explicitOwnershipOf}
*/
function explicitOwnershipsOf(uint256[] memory tokenIds) external view returns (TokenOwnership[] memory);
/**
* @dev Returns an array of token IDs owned by `owner`,
* in the range [`start`, `stop`)
* (i.e. `start <= tokenId < stop`).
*
* This function allows for tokens to be queried if the collection
* grows too big for a single call of {ERC721AQueryable-tokensOfOwner}.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `start < stop`
*/
function tokensOfOwnerIn(
address owner,
uint256 start,
uint256 stop
) external view returns (uint256[] memory);
/**
* @dev Returns an array of token IDs owned by `owner`.
*
* This function scans the ownership mapping and is O(`totalSupply`) in complexity.
* It is meant to be called off-chain.
*
* See {ERC721AQueryable-tokensOfOwnerIn} for splitting the scan into
* multiple smaller scans if the collection is large enough to cause
* an out-of-gas error (10K collections should be fine).
*/
function tokensOfOwner(address owner) external view returns (uint256[] memory);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// ERC721A Contracts v4.2.3
// Creator: Chiru Labs
pragma solidity ^0.8.4;
/**
* @dev Interface of ERC721A.
*/
interface IERC721AUpgradeable {
/**
* The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
*/
error ApprovalCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
/**
* The token does not exist.
*/
error ApprovalQueryForNonexistentToken();
/**
* Cannot query the balance for the zero address.
*/
error BalanceQueryForZeroAddress();
/**
* Cannot mint to the zero address.
*/
error MintToZeroAddress();
/**
* The quantity of tokens minted must be more than zero.
*/
error MintZeroQuantity();
/**
* The token does not exist.
*/
error OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken();
/**
* The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
*/
error TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
/**
* The token must be owned by `from`.
*/
error TransferFromIncorrectOwner();
/**
* Cannot safely transfer to a contract that does not implement the
* ERC721Receiver interface.
*/
error TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer();
/**
* Cannot transfer to the zero address.
*/
error TransferToZeroAddress();
/**
* The token does not exist.
*/
error URIQueryForNonexistentToken();
/**
* The `quantity` minted with ERC2309 exceeds the safety limit.
*/
error MintERC2309QuantityExceedsLimit();
/**
* The `extraData` cannot be set on an unintialized ownership slot.
*/
error OwnershipNotInitializedForExtraData();
// =============================================================
// STRUCTS
// =============================================================
struct TokenOwnership {
// The address of the owner.
address addr;
// Stores the start time of ownership with minimal overhead for tokenomics.
uint64 startTimestamp;
// Whether the token has been burned.
bool burned;
// Arbitrary data similar to `startTimestamp` that can be set via {_extraData}.
uint24 extraData;
}
// =============================================================
// TOKEN COUNTERS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns the total number of tokens in existence.
* Burned tokens will reduce the count.
* To get the total number of tokens minted, please see {_totalMinted}.
*/
function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256);
// =============================================================
// IERC165
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by
* `interfaceId`. See the corresponding
* [EIP section](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified)
* to learn more about how these ids are created.
*
* This function call must use less than 30000 gas.
*/
function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) external view returns (bool);
// =============================================================
// IERC721
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Emitted when `tokenId` token is transferred from `from` to `to`.
*/
event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 indexed tokenId);
/**
* @dev Emitted when `owner` enables `approved` to manage the `tokenId` token.
*/
event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed approved, uint256 indexed tokenId);
/**
* @dev Emitted when `owner` enables or disables
* (`approved`) `operator` to manage all of its assets.
*/
event ApprovalForAll(address indexed owner, address indexed operator, bool approved);
/**
* @dev Returns the number of tokens in `owner`'s account.
*/
function balanceOf(address owner) external view returns (uint256 balance);
/**
* @dev Returns the owner of the `tokenId` token.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*/
function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address owner);
/**
* @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`,
* checking first that contract recipients are aware of the ERC721 protocol
* to prevent tokens from being forever locked.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `from` cannot be the zero address.
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`.
* - If the caller is not `from`, it must be have been allowed to move
* this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
* - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement
* {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes calldata data
) external payable;
/**
* @dev Equivalent to `safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, '')`.
*/
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) external payable;
/**
* @dev Transfers `tokenId` from `from` to `to`.
*
* WARNING: Usage of this method is discouraged, use {safeTransferFrom}
* whenever possible.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `from` cannot be the zero address.
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`.
* - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token
* by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function transferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) external payable;
/**
* @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account.
* The approval is cleared when the token is transferred.
*
* Only a single account can be approved at a time, so approving the
* zero address clears previous approvals.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*
* Emits an {Approval} event.
*/
function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) external payable;
/**
* @dev Approve or remove `operator` as an operator for the caller.
* Operators can call {transferFrom} or {safeTransferFrom}
* for any token owned by the caller.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The `operator` cannot be the caller.
*
* Emits an {ApprovalForAll} event.
*/
function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool _approved) external;
/**
* @dev Returns the account approved for `tokenId` token.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*/
function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address operator);
/**
* @dev Returns if the `operator` is allowed to manage all of the assets of `owner`.
*
* See {setApprovalForAll}.
*/
function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) external view returns (bool);
// =============================================================
// IERC721Metadata
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns the token collection name.
*/
function name() external view returns (string memory);
/**
* @dev Returns the token collection symbol.
*/
function symbol() external view returns (string memory);
/**
* @dev Returns the Uniform Resource Identifier (URI) for `tokenId` token.
*/
function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (string memory);
// =============================================================
// IERC2309
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Emitted when tokens in `fromTokenId` to `toTokenId`
* (inclusive) is transferred from `from` to `to`, as defined in the
* [ERC2309](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2309) standard.
*
* See {_mintERC2309} for more details.
*/
event ConsecutiveTransfer(uint256 indexed fromTokenId, uint256 toTokenId, address indexed from, address indexed to);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.13;
interface IOperatorFilterRegistry {
function isOperatorAllowed(address registrant, address operator) external view returns (bool);
function register(address registrant) external;
function registerAndSubscribe(address registrant, address subscription) external;
function registerAndCopyEntries(address registrant, address registrantToCopy) external;
function unregister(address addr) external;
function updateOperator(address registrant, address operator, bool filtered) external;
function updateOperators(address registrant, address[] calldata operators, bool filtered) external;
function updateCodeHash(address registrant, bytes32 codehash, bool filtered) external;
function updateCodeHashes(address registrant, bytes32[] calldata codeHashes, bool filtered) external;
function subscribe(address registrant, address registrantToSubscribe) external;
function unsubscribe(address registrant, bool copyExistingEntries) external;
function subscriptionOf(address addr) external returns (address registrant);
function subscribers(address registrant) external returns (address[] memory);
function subscriberAt(address registrant, uint256 index) external returns (address);
function copyEntriesOf(address registrant, address registrantToCopy) external;
function isOperatorFiltered(address registrant, address operator) external returns (bool);
function isCodeHashOfFiltered(address registrant, address operatorWithCode) external returns (bool);
function isCodeHashFiltered(address registrant, bytes32 codeHash) external returns (bool);
function filteredOperators(address addr) external returns (address[] memory);
function filteredCodeHashes(address addr) external returns (bytes32[] memory);
function filteredOperatorAt(address registrant, uint256 index) external returns (address);
function filteredCodeHashAt(address registrant, uint256 index) external returns (bytes32);
function isRegistered(address addr) external returns (bool);
function codeHashOf(address addr) external returns (bytes32);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.13;
import {IOperatorFilterRegistry} from "../IOperatorFilterRegistry.sol";
import {Initializable} from "@openzeppelin/contracts-upgradeable/proxy/utils/Initializable.sol";
abstract contract OperatorFiltererUpgradeable is Initializable {
error OperatorNotAllowed(address operator);
IOperatorFilterRegistry constant operatorFilterRegistry =
IOperatorFilterRegistry(0x000000000000AAeB6D7670E522A718067333cd4E);
function __OperatorFilterer_init(address subscriptionOrRegistrantToCopy, bool subscribe)
internal
onlyInitializing
{
// If an inheriting token contract is deployed to a network without the registry deployed, the modifier
// will not revert, but the contract will need to be registered with the registry once it is deployed in
// order for the modifier to filter addresses.
if (address(operatorFilterRegistry).code.length > 0) {
if (!operatorFilterRegistry.isRegistered(address(this))) {
if (subscribe) {
operatorFilterRegistry.registerAndSubscribe(address(this), subscriptionOrRegistrantToCopy);
} else {
if (subscriptionOrRegistrantToCopy != address(0)) {
operatorFilterRegistry.registerAndCopyEntries(address(this), subscriptionOrRegistrantToCopy);
} else {
operatorFilterRegistry.register(address(this));
}
}
}
}
}
modifier onlyAllowedOperator(address from) virtual {
// Check registry code length to facilitate testing in environments without a deployed registry.
if (address(operatorFilterRegistry).code.length > 0) {
// Allow spending tokens from addresses with balance
// Note that this still allows listings and marketplaces with escrow to transfer tokens if transferred
// from an EOA.
if (from == msg.sender) {
_;
return;
}
if (!operatorFilterRegistry.isOperatorAllowed(address(this), msg.sender)) {
revert OperatorNotAllowed(msg.sender);
}
}
_;
}
modifier onlyAllowedOperatorApproval(address operator) virtual {
// Check registry code length to facilitate testing in environments without a deployed registry.
if (address(operatorFilterRegistry).code.length > 0) {
if (!operatorFilterRegistry.isOperatorAllowed(address(this), operator)) {
revert OperatorNotAllowed(operator);
}
}
_;
}
}
File 3 of 7: X2Y2_r1
// SPDX-License-Identifier: Unlicensed
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
pragma abicoder v2;
import './IDelegate.sol';
import './IWETHUpgradable.sol';
import './MarketConsts.sol';
import '@openzeppelin/contracts-upgradeable/access/OwnableUpgradeable.sol';
import '@openzeppelin/contracts-upgradeable/proxy/utils/Initializable.sol';
import '@openzeppelin/contracts-upgradeable/security/PausableUpgradeable.sol';
import '@openzeppelin/contracts-upgradeable/security/ReentrancyGuardUpgradeable.sol';
import '@openzeppelin/contracts-upgradeable/token/ERC20/utils/SafeERC20Upgradeable.sol';
import '@openzeppelin/contracts/utils/cryptography/ECDSA.sol';
interface IX2Y2Run {
function run1(
Market.Order memory order,
Market.SettleShared memory shared,
Market.SettleDetail memory detail
) external returns (uint256);
}
contract X2Y2_r1 is
Initializable,
ReentrancyGuardUpgradeable,
OwnableUpgradeable,
PausableUpgradeable,
IX2Y2Run
{
using SafeERC20Upgradeable for IERC20Upgradeable;
event EvProfit(bytes32 itemHash, address currency, address to, uint256 amount);
event EvAuctionRefund(
bytes32 indexed itemHash,
address currency,
address to,
uint256 amount,
uint256 incentive
);
event EvInventory(
bytes32 indexed itemHash,
address maker,
address taker,
uint256 orderSalt,
uint256 settleSalt,
uint256 intent,
uint256 delegateType,
uint256 deadline,
IERC20Upgradeable currency,
bytes dataMask,
Market.OrderItem item,
Market.SettleDetail detail
);
event EvSigner(address signer, bool isRemoval);
event EvDelegate(address delegate, bool isRemoval);
event EvFeeCapUpdate(uint256 newValue);
event EvCancel(bytes32 indexed itemHash);
event EvFailure(uint256 index, bytes error);
mapping(address => bool) public delegates;
mapping(address => bool) public signers;
mapping(bytes32 => Market.InvStatus) public inventoryStatus;
mapping(bytes32 => Market.OngoingAuction) public ongoingAuctions;
uint256 public constant RATE_BASE = 1e6;
uint256 public feeCapPct;
IWETHUpgradable public weth;
receive() external payable {}
function pause() public onlyOwner {
_pause();
}
function unpause() public onlyOwner {
_unpause();
}
function initialize(uint256 feeCapPct_, address weth_) public initializer {
feeCapPct = feeCapPct_;
weth = IWETHUpgradable(weth_);
__ReentrancyGuard_init_unchained();
__Pausable_init_unchained();
__Ownable_init_unchained();
}
function updateFeeCap(uint256 val) public virtual onlyOwner {
feeCapPct = val;
emit EvFeeCapUpdate(val);
}
function updateSigners(address[] memory toAdd, address[] memory toRemove)
public
virtual
onlyOwner
{
for (uint256 i = 0; i < toAdd.length; i++) {
signers[toAdd[i]] = true;
emit EvSigner(toAdd[i], false);
}
for (uint256 i = 0; i < toRemove.length; i++) {
delete signers[toRemove[i]];
emit EvSigner(toRemove[i], true);
}
}
function updateDelegates(address[] memory toAdd, address[] memory toRemove)
public
virtual
onlyOwner
{
for (uint256 i = 0; i < toAdd.length; i++) {
delegates[toAdd[i]] = true;
emit EvDelegate(toAdd[i], false);
}
for (uint256 i = 0; i < toRemove.length; i++) {
delete delegates[toRemove[i]];
emit EvDelegate(toRemove[i], true);
}
}
function cancel(
bytes32[] memory itemHashes,
uint256 deadline,
uint8 v,
bytes32 r,
bytes32 s
) public virtual nonReentrant whenNotPaused {
require(deadline > block.timestamp, 'deadline reached');
bytes32 hash = keccak256(abi.encode(itemHashes.length, itemHashes, deadline));
address signer = ECDSA.recover(hash, v, r, s);
require(signers[signer], 'Input signature error');
for (uint256 i = 0; i < itemHashes.length; i++) {
bytes32 h = itemHashes[i];
if (inventoryStatus[h] == Market.InvStatus.NEW) {
inventoryStatus[h] = Market.InvStatus.CANCELLED;
emit EvCancel(h);
}
}
}
function run(Market.RunInput memory input) public payable virtual nonReentrant whenNotPaused {
require(input.shared.deadline > block.timestamp, 'input deadline reached');
require(msg.sender == input.shared.user, 'sender does not match');
_verifyInputSignature(input);
uint256 amountEth = msg.value;
if (input.shared.amountToWeth > 0) {
uint256 amt = input.shared.amountToWeth;
weth.deposit{value: amt}();
SafeERC20Upgradeable.safeTransfer(weth, msg.sender, amt);
amountEth -= amt;
}
if (input.shared.amountToEth > 0) {
uint256 amt = input.shared.amountToEth;
SafeERC20Upgradeable.safeTransferFrom(weth, msg.sender, address(this), amt);
weth.withdraw(amt);
amountEth += amt;
}
for (uint256 i = 0; i < input.orders.length; i++) {
_verifyOrderSignature(input.orders[i]);
}
for (uint256 i = 0; i < input.details.length; i++) {
Market.SettleDetail memory detail = input.details[i];
Market.Order memory order = input.orders[detail.orderIdx];
if (input.shared.canFail) {
try IX2Y2Run(address(this)).run1(order, input.shared, detail) returns (
uint256 ethPayment
) {
amountEth -= ethPayment;
} catch Error(string memory _err) {
emit EvFailure(i, bytes(_err));
} catch (bytes memory _err) {
emit EvFailure(i, _err);
}
} else {
amountEth -= _run(order, input.shared, detail);
}
}
if (amountEth > 0) {
payable(msg.sender).transfer(amountEth);
}
}
function run1(
Market.Order memory order,
Market.SettleShared memory shared,
Market.SettleDetail memory detail
) external virtual returns (uint256) {
require(msg.sender == address(this), 'unsafe call');
return _run(order, shared, detail);
}
function _hashItem(Market.Order memory order, Market.OrderItem memory item)
internal
view
virtual
returns (bytes32)
{
return
keccak256(
abi.encode(
order.salt,
order.user,
order.network,
order.intent,
order.delegateType,
order.deadline,
order.currency,
order.dataMask,
item
)
);
}
function _emitInventory(
bytes32 itemHash,
Market.Order memory order,
Market.OrderItem memory item,
Market.SettleShared memory shared,
Market.SettleDetail memory detail
) internal virtual {
emit EvInventory(
itemHash,
order.user,
shared.user,
order.salt,
shared.salt,
order.intent,
order.delegateType,
order.deadline,
order.currency,
order.dataMask,
item,
detail
);
}
function _run(
Market.Order memory order,
Market.SettleShared memory shared,
Market.SettleDetail memory detail
) internal virtual returns (uint256) {
uint256 nativeAmount = 0;
Market.OrderItem memory item = order.items[detail.itemIdx];
bytes32 itemHash = _hashItem(order, item);
{
require(itemHash == detail.itemHash, 'item hash does not match');
require(order.network == block.chainid, 'wrong network');
require(
address(detail.executionDelegate) != address(0) &&
delegates[address(detail.executionDelegate)],
'unknown delegate'
);
}
bytes memory data = item.data;
{
if (order.dataMask.length > 0 && detail.dataReplacement.length > 0) {
_arrayReplace(data, detail.dataReplacement, order.dataMask);
}
}
if (detail.op == Market.Op.COMPLETE_SELL_OFFER) {
require(inventoryStatus[itemHash] == Market.InvStatus.NEW, 'order already exists');
require(order.intent == Market.INTENT_SELL, 'intent != sell');
_assertDelegation(order, detail);
require(order.deadline > block.timestamp, 'deadline reached');
require(detail.price >= item.price, 'underpaid');
nativeAmount = _takePayment(itemHash, order.currency, shared.user, detail.price);
require(
detail.executionDelegate.executeSell(order.user, shared.user, data),
'delegation error'
);
_distributeFeeAndProfit(
itemHash,
order.user,
order.currency,
detail,
detail.price,
detail.price
);
inventoryStatus[itemHash] = Market.InvStatus.COMPLETE;
} else if (detail.op == Market.Op.COMPLETE_BUY_OFFER) {
require(inventoryStatus[itemHash] == Market.InvStatus.NEW, 'order already exists');
require(order.intent == Market.INTENT_BUY, 'intent != buy');
_assertDelegation(order, detail);
require(order.deadline > block.timestamp, 'deadline reached');
require(item.price == detail.price, 'price not match');
require(!_isNative(order.currency), 'native token not supported');
nativeAmount = _takePayment(itemHash, order.currency, order.user, detail.price);
require(
detail.executionDelegate.executeBuy(shared.user, order.user, data),
'delegation error'
);
_distributeFeeAndProfit(
itemHash,
shared.user,
order.currency,
detail,
detail.price,
detail.price
);
inventoryStatus[itemHash] = Market.InvStatus.COMPLETE;
} else if (detail.op == Market.Op.CANCEL_OFFER) {
require(inventoryStatus[itemHash] == Market.InvStatus.NEW, 'unable to cancel');
require(order.deadline > block.timestamp, 'deadline reached');
inventoryStatus[itemHash] = Market.InvStatus.CANCELLED;
emit EvCancel(itemHash);
} else if (detail.op == Market.Op.BID) {
require(order.intent == Market.INTENT_AUCTION, 'intent != auction');
_assertDelegation(order, detail);
bool firstBid = false;
if (ongoingAuctions[itemHash].bidder == address(0)) {
require(inventoryStatus[itemHash] == Market.InvStatus.NEW, 'order already exists');
require(order.deadline > block.timestamp, 'auction ended');
require(detail.price >= item.price, 'underpaid');
firstBid = true;
ongoingAuctions[itemHash] = Market.OngoingAuction({
price: detail.price,
netPrice: detail.price,
bidder: shared.user,
endAt: order.deadline
});
inventoryStatus[itemHash] = Market.InvStatus.AUCTION;
require(
detail.executionDelegate.executeBid(order.user, address(0), shared.user, data),
'delegation error'
);
}
Market.OngoingAuction storage auc = ongoingAuctions[itemHash];
require(auc.endAt > block.timestamp, 'auction ended');
nativeAmount = _takePayment(itemHash, order.currency, shared.user, detail.price);
if (!firstBid) {
require(
inventoryStatus[itemHash] == Market.InvStatus.AUCTION,
'order is not auction'
);
require(
detail.price - auc.price >= (auc.price * detail.aucMinIncrementPct) / RATE_BASE,
'underbid'
);
uint256 bidRefund = auc.netPrice;
uint256 incentive = (detail.price * detail.bidIncentivePct) / RATE_BASE;
if (bidRefund + incentive > 0) {
_transferTo(order.currency, auc.bidder, bidRefund + incentive);
emit EvAuctionRefund(
itemHash,
address(order.currency),
auc.bidder,
bidRefund,
incentive
);
}
require(
detail.executionDelegate.executeBid(order.user, auc.bidder, shared.user, data),
'delegation error'
);
auc.price = detail.price;
auc.netPrice = detail.price - incentive;
auc.bidder = shared.user;
}
if (block.timestamp + detail.aucIncDurationSecs > auc.endAt) {
auc.endAt += detail.aucIncDurationSecs;
}
} else if (
detail.op == Market.Op.REFUND_AUCTION ||
detail.op == Market.Op.REFUND_AUCTION_STUCK_ITEM
) {
require(
inventoryStatus[itemHash] == Market.InvStatus.AUCTION,
'cannot cancel non-auction order'
);
Market.OngoingAuction storage auc = ongoingAuctions[itemHash];
if (auc.netPrice > 0) {
_transferTo(order.currency, auc.bidder, auc.netPrice);
emit EvAuctionRefund(
itemHash,
address(order.currency),
auc.bidder,
auc.netPrice,
0
);
}
_assertDelegation(order, detail);
if (detail.op == Market.Op.REFUND_AUCTION) {
require(
detail.executionDelegate.executeAuctionRefund(order.user, auc.bidder, data),
'delegation error'
);
}
delete ongoingAuctions[itemHash];
inventoryStatus[itemHash] = Market.InvStatus.REFUNDED;
} else if (detail.op == Market.Op.COMPLETE_AUCTION) {
require(
inventoryStatus[itemHash] == Market.InvStatus.AUCTION,
'cannot complete non-auction order'
);
_assertDelegation(order, detail);
Market.OngoingAuction storage auc = ongoingAuctions[itemHash];
require(block.timestamp >= auc.endAt, 'auction not finished yet');
require(
detail.executionDelegate.executeAuctionComplete(order.user, auc.bidder, data),
'delegation error'
);
_distributeFeeAndProfit(
itemHash,
order.user,
order.currency,
detail,
auc.price,
auc.netPrice
);
inventoryStatus[itemHash] = Market.InvStatus.COMPLETE;
delete ongoingAuctions[itemHash];
} else {
revert('unknown op');
}
_emitInventory(itemHash, order, item, shared, detail);
return nativeAmount;
}
function _assertDelegation(Market.Order memory order, Market.SettleDetail memory detail)
internal
view
virtual
{
require(
detail.executionDelegate.delegateType() == order.delegateType,
'delegation type error'
);
}
// modifies `src`
function _arrayReplace(
bytes memory src,
bytes memory replacement,
bytes memory mask
) internal view virtual {
require(src.length == replacement.length);
require(src.length == mask.length);
for (uint256 i = 0; i < src.length; i++) {
if (mask[i] != 0) {
src[i] = replacement[i];
}
}
}
function _verifyInputSignature(Market.RunInput memory input) internal view virtual {
bytes32 hash = keccak256(abi.encode(input.shared, input.details.length, input.details));
address signer = ECDSA.recover(hash, input.v, input.r, input.s);
require(signers[signer], 'Input signature error');
}
function _verifyOrderSignature(Market.Order memory order) internal view virtual {
address orderSigner;
if (order.signVersion == Market.SIGN_V1) {
bytes32 orderHash = keccak256(
abi.encode(
order.salt,
order.user,
order.network,
order.intent,
order.delegateType,
order.deadline,
order.currency,
order.dataMask,
order.items.length,
order.items
)
);
orderSigner = ECDSA.recover(
ECDSA.toEthSignedMessageHash(orderHash),
order.v,
order.r,
order.s
);
} else {
revert('unknown signature version');
}
require(orderSigner == order.user, 'Order signature does not match');
}
function _isNative(IERC20Upgradeable currency) internal view virtual returns (bool) {
return address(currency) == address(0);
}
function _takePayment(
bytes32 itemHash,
IERC20Upgradeable currency,
address from,
uint256 amount
) internal virtual returns (uint256) {
if (amount > 0) {
if (_isNative(currency)) {
return amount;
} else {
currency.safeTransferFrom(from, address(this), amount);
}
}
return 0;
}
function _transferTo(
IERC20Upgradeable currency,
address to,
uint256 amount
) internal virtual {
if (amount > 0) {
if (_isNative(currency)) {
AddressUpgradeable.sendValue(payable(to), amount);
} else {
currency.safeTransfer(to, amount);
}
}
}
function _distributeFeeAndProfit(
bytes32 itemHash,
address seller,
IERC20Upgradeable currency,
Market.SettleDetail memory sd,
uint256 price,
uint256 netPrice
) internal virtual {
require(price >= netPrice, 'price error');
uint256 payment = netPrice;
uint256 totalFeePct;
for (uint256 i = 0; i < sd.fees.length; i++) {
Market.Fee memory fee = sd.fees[i];
totalFeePct += fee.percentage;
uint256 amount = (price * fee.percentage) / RATE_BASE;
payment -= amount;
_transferTo(currency, fee.to, amount);
}
require(feeCapPct >= totalFeePct, 'total fee cap exceeded');
_transferTo(currency, seller, payment);
emit EvProfit(itemHash, address(currency), seller, payment);
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: Unlicensed
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
pragma abicoder v2;
interface IDelegate {
function delegateType() external view returns (uint256);
function executeSell(
address seller,
address buyer,
bytes calldata data
) external returns (bool);
function executeBuy(
address seller,
address buyer,
bytes calldata data
) external returns (bool);
function executeBid(
address seller,
address previousBidder,
address bidder,
bytes calldata data
) external returns (bool);
function executeAuctionComplete(
address seller,
address buyer,
bytes calldata data
) external returns (bool);
function executeAuctionRefund(
address seller,
address lastBidder,
bytes calldata data
) external returns (bool);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: Unlicensed
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
pragma abicoder v2;
import '@openzeppelin/contracts-upgradeable/token/ERC20/IERC20Upgradeable.sol';
interface IWETHUpgradable is IERC20Upgradeable {
function deposit() external payable;
function withdraw(uint256 wad) external;
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: Unlicensed
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
pragma abicoder v2;
import './IDelegate.sol';
import './IWETHUpgradable.sol';
library Market {
uint256 constant INTENT_SELL = 1;
uint256 constant INTENT_AUCTION = 2;
uint256 constant INTENT_BUY = 3;
uint8 constant SIGN_V1 = 1;
uint8 constant SIGN_V3 = 3;
struct OrderItem {
uint256 price;
bytes data;
}
struct Order {
uint256 salt;
address user;
uint256 network;
uint256 intent;
uint256 delegateType;
uint256 deadline;
IERC20Upgradeable currency;
bytes dataMask;
OrderItem[] items;
// signature
bytes32 r;
bytes32 s;
uint8 v;
uint8 signVersion;
}
struct Fee {
uint256 percentage;
address to;
}
struct SettleDetail {
Market.Op op;
uint256 orderIdx;
uint256 itemIdx;
uint256 price;
bytes32 itemHash;
IDelegate executionDelegate;
bytes dataReplacement;
uint256 bidIncentivePct;
uint256 aucMinIncrementPct;
uint256 aucIncDurationSecs;
Fee[] fees;
}
struct SettleShared {
uint256 salt;
uint256 deadline;
uint256 amountToEth;
uint256 amountToWeth;
address user;
bool canFail;
}
struct RunInput {
Order[] orders;
SettleDetail[] details;
SettleShared shared;
// signature
bytes32 r;
bytes32 s;
uint8 v;
}
struct OngoingAuction {
uint256 price;
uint256 netPrice;
uint256 endAt;
address bidder;
}
enum InvStatus {
NEW,
AUCTION,
COMPLETE,
CANCELLED,
REFUNDED
}
enum Op {
INVALID,
// off-chain
COMPLETE_SELL_OFFER,
COMPLETE_BUY_OFFER,
CANCEL_OFFER,
// auction
BID,
COMPLETE_AUCTION,
REFUND_AUCTION,
REFUND_AUCTION_STUCK_ITEM
}
enum DelegationType {
INVALID,
ERC721,
ERC1155
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (access/Ownable.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "../utils/ContextUpgradeable.sol";
import "../proxy/utils/Initializable.sol";
/**
* @dev Contract module which provides a basic access control mechanism, where
* there is an account (an owner) that can be granted exclusive access to
* specific functions.
*
* By default, the owner account will be the one that deploys the contract. This
* can later be changed with {transferOwnership}.
*
* This module is used through inheritance. It will make available the modifier
* `onlyOwner`, which can be applied to your functions to restrict their use to
* the owner.
*/
abstract contract OwnableUpgradeable is Initializable, ContextUpgradeable {
address private _owner;
event OwnershipTransferred(address indexed previousOwner, address indexed newOwner);
/**
* @dev Initializes the contract setting the deployer as the initial owner.
*/
function __Ownable_init() internal onlyInitializing {
__Context_init_unchained();
__Ownable_init_unchained();
}
function __Ownable_init_unchained() internal onlyInitializing {
_transferOwnership(_msgSender());
}
/**
* @dev Returns the address of the current owner.
*/
function owner() public view virtual returns (address) {
return _owner;
}
/**
* @dev Throws if called by any account other than the owner.
*/
modifier onlyOwner() {
require(owner() == _msgSender(), "Ownable: caller is not the owner");
_;
}
/**
* @dev Leaves the contract without owner. It will not be possible to call
* `onlyOwner` functions anymore. Can only be called by the current owner.
*
* NOTE: Renouncing ownership will leave the contract without an owner,
* thereby removing any functionality that is only available to the owner.
*/
function renounceOwnership() public virtual onlyOwner {
_transferOwnership(address(0));
}
/**
* @dev Transfers ownership of the contract to a new account (`newOwner`).
* Can only be called by the current owner.
*/
function transferOwnership(address newOwner) public virtual onlyOwner {
require(newOwner != address(0), "Ownable: new owner is the zero address");
_transferOwnership(newOwner);
}
/**
* @dev Transfers ownership of the contract to a new account (`newOwner`).
* Internal function without access restriction.
*/
function _transferOwnership(address newOwner) internal virtual {
address oldOwner = _owner;
_owner = newOwner;
emit OwnershipTransferred(oldOwner, newOwner);
}
uint256[49] private __gap;
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (proxy/utils/Initializable.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "../../utils/AddressUpgradeable.sol";
/**
* @dev This is a base contract to aid in writing upgradeable contracts, or any kind of contract that will be deployed
* behind a proxy. Since a proxied contract can't have a constructor, it's common to move constructor logic to an
* external initializer function, usually called `initialize`. It then becomes necessary to protect this initializer
* function so it can only be called once. The {initializer} modifier provided by this contract will have this effect.
*
* TIP: To avoid leaving the proxy in an uninitialized state, the initializer function should be called as early as
* possible by providing the encoded function call as the `_data` argument to {ERC1967Proxy-constructor}.
*
* CAUTION: When used with inheritance, manual care must be taken to not invoke a parent initializer twice, or to ensure
* that all initializers are idempotent. This is not verified automatically as constructors are by Solidity.
*
* [CAUTION]
* ====
* Avoid leaving a contract uninitialized.
*
* An uninitialized contract can be taken over by an attacker. This applies to both a proxy and its implementation
* contract, which may impact the proxy. To initialize the implementation contract, you can either invoke the
* initializer manually, or you can include a constructor to automatically mark it as initialized when it is deployed:
*
* [.hljs-theme-light.nopadding]
* ```
* /// @custom:oz-upgrades-unsafe-allow constructor
* constructor() initializer {}
* ```
* ====
*/
abstract contract Initializable {
/**
* @dev Indicates that the contract has been initialized.
*/
bool private _initialized;
/**
* @dev Indicates that the contract is in the process of being initialized.
*/
bool private _initializing;
/**
* @dev Modifier to protect an initializer function from being invoked twice.
*/
modifier initializer() {
// If the contract is initializing we ignore whether _initialized is set in order to support multiple
// inheritance patterns, but we only do this in the context of a constructor, because in other contexts the
// contract may have been reentered.
require(_initializing ? _isConstructor() : !_initialized, "Initializable: contract is already initialized");
bool isTopLevelCall = !_initializing;
if (isTopLevelCall) {
_initializing = true;
_initialized = true;
}
_;
if (isTopLevelCall) {
_initializing = false;
}
}
/**
* @dev Modifier to protect an initialization function so that it can only be invoked by functions with the
* {initializer} modifier, directly or indirectly.
*/
modifier onlyInitializing() {
require(_initializing, "Initializable: contract is not initializing");
_;
}
function _isConstructor() private view returns (bool) {
return !AddressUpgradeable.isContract(address(this));
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (security/Pausable.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "../utils/ContextUpgradeable.sol";
import "../proxy/utils/Initializable.sol";
/**
* @dev Contract module which allows children to implement an emergency stop
* mechanism that can be triggered by an authorized account.
*
* This module is used through inheritance. It will make available the
* modifiers `whenNotPaused` and `whenPaused`, which can be applied to
* the functions of your contract. Note that they will not be pausable by
* simply including this module, only once the modifiers are put in place.
*/
abstract contract PausableUpgradeable is Initializable, ContextUpgradeable {
/**
* @dev Emitted when the pause is triggered by `account`.
*/
event Paused(address account);
/**
* @dev Emitted when the pause is lifted by `account`.
*/
event Unpaused(address account);
bool private _paused;
/**
* @dev Initializes the contract in unpaused state.
*/
function __Pausable_init() internal onlyInitializing {
__Context_init_unchained();
__Pausable_init_unchained();
}
function __Pausable_init_unchained() internal onlyInitializing {
_paused = false;
}
/**
* @dev Returns true if the contract is paused, and false otherwise.
*/
function paused() public view virtual returns (bool) {
return _paused;
}
/**
* @dev Modifier to make a function callable only when the contract is not paused.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The contract must not be paused.
*/
modifier whenNotPaused() {
require(!paused(), "Pausable: paused");
_;
}
/**
* @dev Modifier to make a function callable only when the contract is paused.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The contract must be paused.
*/
modifier whenPaused() {
require(paused(), "Pausable: not paused");
_;
}
/**
* @dev Triggers stopped state.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The contract must not be paused.
*/
function _pause() internal virtual whenNotPaused {
_paused = true;
emit Paused(_msgSender());
}
/**
* @dev Returns to normal state.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The contract must be paused.
*/
function _unpause() internal virtual whenPaused {
_paused = false;
emit Unpaused(_msgSender());
}
uint256[49] private __gap;
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (security/ReentrancyGuard.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "../proxy/utils/Initializable.sol";
/**
* @dev Contract module that helps prevent reentrant calls to a function.
*
* Inheriting from `ReentrancyGuard` will make the {nonReentrant} modifier
* available, which can be applied to functions to make sure there are no nested
* (reentrant) calls to them.
*
* Note that because there is a single `nonReentrant` guard, functions marked as
* `nonReentrant` may not call one another. This can be worked around by making
* those functions `private`, and then adding `external` `nonReentrant` entry
* points to them.
*
* TIP: If you would like to learn more about reentrancy and alternative ways
* to protect against it, check out our blog post
* https://blog.openzeppelin.com/reentrancy-after-istanbul/[Reentrancy After Istanbul].
*/
abstract contract ReentrancyGuardUpgradeable is Initializable {
// Booleans are more expensive than uint256 or any type that takes up a full
// word because each write operation emits an extra SLOAD to first read the
// slot's contents, replace the bits taken up by the boolean, and then write
// back. This is the compiler's defense against contract upgrades and
// pointer aliasing, and it cannot be disabled.
// The values being non-zero value makes deployment a bit more expensive,
// but in exchange the refund on every call to nonReentrant will be lower in
// amount. Since refunds are capped to a percentage of the total
// transaction's gas, it is best to keep them low in cases like this one, to
// increase the likelihood of the full refund coming into effect.
uint256 private constant _NOT_ENTERED = 1;
uint256 private constant _ENTERED = 2;
uint256 private _status;
function __ReentrancyGuard_init() internal onlyInitializing {
__ReentrancyGuard_init_unchained();
}
function __ReentrancyGuard_init_unchained() internal onlyInitializing {
_status = _NOT_ENTERED;
}
/**
* @dev Prevents a contract from calling itself, directly or indirectly.
* Calling a `nonReentrant` function from another `nonReentrant`
* function is not supported. It is possible to prevent this from happening
* by making the `nonReentrant` function external, and making it call a
* `private` function that does the actual work.
*/
modifier nonReentrant() {
// On the first call to nonReentrant, _notEntered will be true
require(_status != _ENTERED, "ReentrancyGuard: reentrant call");
// Any calls to nonReentrant after this point will fail
_status = _ENTERED;
_;
// By storing the original value once again, a refund is triggered (see
// https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2200)
_status = _NOT_ENTERED;
}
uint256[49] private __gap;
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (token/ERC20/utils/SafeERC20.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "../IERC20Upgradeable.sol";
import "../../../utils/AddressUpgradeable.sol";
/**
* @title SafeERC20
* @dev Wrappers around ERC20 operations that throw on failure (when the token
* contract returns false). Tokens that return no value (and instead revert or
* throw on failure) are also supported, non-reverting calls are assumed to be
* successful.
* To use this library you can add a `using SafeERC20 for IERC20;` statement to your contract,
* which allows you to call the safe operations as `token.safeTransfer(...)`, etc.
*/
library SafeERC20Upgradeable {
using AddressUpgradeable for address;
function safeTransfer(
IERC20Upgradeable token,
address to,
uint256 value
) internal {
_callOptionalReturn(token, abi.encodeWithSelector(token.transfer.selector, to, value));
}
function safeTransferFrom(
IERC20Upgradeable token,
address from,
address to,
uint256 value
) internal {
_callOptionalReturn(token, abi.encodeWithSelector(token.transferFrom.selector, from, to, value));
}
/**
* @dev Deprecated. This function has issues similar to the ones found in
* {IERC20-approve}, and its usage is discouraged.
*
* Whenever possible, use {safeIncreaseAllowance} and
* {safeDecreaseAllowance} instead.
*/
function safeApprove(
IERC20Upgradeable token,
address spender,
uint256 value
) internal {
// safeApprove should only be called when setting an initial allowance,
// or when resetting it to zero. To increase and decrease it, use
// 'safeIncreaseAllowance' and 'safeDecreaseAllowance'
require(
(value == 0) || (token.allowance(address(this), spender) == 0),
"SafeERC20: approve from non-zero to non-zero allowance"
);
_callOptionalReturn(token, abi.encodeWithSelector(token.approve.selector, spender, value));
}
function safeIncreaseAllowance(
IERC20Upgradeable token,
address spender,
uint256 value
) internal {
uint256 newAllowance = token.allowance(address(this), spender) + value;
_callOptionalReturn(token, abi.encodeWithSelector(token.approve.selector, spender, newAllowance));
}
function safeDecreaseAllowance(
IERC20Upgradeable token,
address spender,
uint256 value
) internal {
unchecked {
uint256 oldAllowance = token.allowance(address(this), spender);
require(oldAllowance >= value, "SafeERC20: decreased allowance below zero");
uint256 newAllowance = oldAllowance - value;
_callOptionalReturn(token, abi.encodeWithSelector(token.approve.selector, spender, newAllowance));
}
}
/**
* @dev Imitates a Solidity high-level call (i.e. a regular function call to a contract), relaxing the requirement
* on the return value: the return value is optional (but if data is returned, it must not be false).
* @param token The token targeted by the call.
* @param data The call data (encoded using abi.encode or one of its variants).
*/
function _callOptionalReturn(IERC20Upgradeable token, bytes memory data) private {
// We need to perform a low level call here, to bypass Solidity's return data size checking mechanism, since
// we're implementing it ourselves. We use {Address.functionCall} to perform this call, which verifies that
// the target address contains contract code and also asserts for success in the low-level call.
bytes memory returndata = address(token).functionCall(data, "SafeERC20: low-level call failed");
if (returndata.length > 0) {
// Return data is optional
require(abi.decode(returndata, (bool)), "SafeERC20: ERC20 operation did not succeed");
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/cryptography/ECDSA.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "../Strings.sol";
/**
* @dev Elliptic Curve Digital Signature Algorithm (ECDSA) operations.
*
* These functions can be used to verify that a message was signed by the holder
* of the private keys of a given address.
*/
library ECDSA {
enum RecoverError {
NoError,
InvalidSignature,
InvalidSignatureLength,
InvalidSignatureS,
InvalidSignatureV
}
function _throwError(RecoverError error) private pure {
if (error == RecoverError.NoError) {
return; // no error: do nothing
} else if (error == RecoverError.InvalidSignature) {
revert("ECDSA: invalid signature");
} else if (error == RecoverError.InvalidSignatureLength) {
revert("ECDSA: invalid signature length");
} else if (error == RecoverError.InvalidSignatureS) {
revert("ECDSA: invalid signature 's' value");
} else if (error == RecoverError.InvalidSignatureV) {
revert("ECDSA: invalid signature 'v' value");
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns the address that signed a hashed message (`hash`) with
* `signature` or error string. This address can then be used for verification purposes.
*
* The `ecrecover` EVM opcode allows for malleable (non-unique) signatures:
* this function rejects them by requiring the `s` value to be in the lower
* half order, and the `v` value to be either 27 or 28.
*
* IMPORTANT: `hash` _must_ be the result of a hash operation for the
* verification to be secure: it is possible to craft signatures that
* recover to arbitrary addresses for non-hashed data. A safe way to ensure
* this is by receiving a hash of the original message (which may otherwise
* be too long), and then calling {toEthSignedMessageHash} on it.
*
* Documentation for signature generation:
* - with https://web3js.readthedocs.io/en/v1.3.4/web3-eth-accounts.html#sign[Web3.js]
* - with https://docs.ethers.io/v5/api/signer/#Signer-signMessage[ethers]
*
* _Available since v4.3._
*/
function tryRecover(bytes32 hash, bytes memory signature) internal pure returns (address, RecoverError) {
// Check the signature length
// - case 65: r,s,v signature (standard)
// - case 64: r,vs signature (cf https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2098) _Available since v4.1._
if (signature.length == 65) {
bytes32 r;
bytes32 s;
uint8 v;
// ecrecover takes the signature parameters, and the only way to get them
// currently is to use assembly.
assembly {
r := mload(add(signature, 0x20))
s := mload(add(signature, 0x40))
v := byte(0, mload(add(signature, 0x60)))
}
return tryRecover(hash, v, r, s);
} else if (signature.length == 64) {
bytes32 r;
bytes32 vs;
// ecrecover takes the signature parameters, and the only way to get them
// currently is to use assembly.
assembly {
r := mload(add(signature, 0x20))
vs := mload(add(signature, 0x40))
}
return tryRecover(hash, r, vs);
} else {
return (address(0), RecoverError.InvalidSignatureLength);
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns the address that signed a hashed message (`hash`) with
* `signature`. This address can then be used for verification purposes.
*
* The `ecrecover` EVM opcode allows for malleable (non-unique) signatures:
* this function rejects them by requiring the `s` value to be in the lower
* half order, and the `v` value to be either 27 or 28.
*
* IMPORTANT: `hash` _must_ be the result of a hash operation for the
* verification to be secure: it is possible to craft signatures that
* recover to arbitrary addresses for non-hashed data. A safe way to ensure
* this is by receiving a hash of the original message (which may otherwise
* be too long), and then calling {toEthSignedMessageHash} on it.
*/
function recover(bytes32 hash, bytes memory signature) internal pure returns (address) {
(address recovered, RecoverError error) = tryRecover(hash, signature);
_throwError(error);
return recovered;
}
/**
* @dev Overload of {ECDSA-tryRecover} that receives the `r` and `vs` short-signature fields separately.
*
* See https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2098[EIP-2098 short signatures]
*
* _Available since v4.3._
*/
function tryRecover(
bytes32 hash,
bytes32 r,
bytes32 vs
) internal pure returns (address, RecoverError) {
bytes32 s;
uint8 v;
assembly {
s := and(vs, 0x7fffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffff)
v := add(shr(255, vs), 27)
}
return tryRecover(hash, v, r, s);
}
/**
* @dev Overload of {ECDSA-recover} that receives the `r and `vs` short-signature fields separately.
*
* _Available since v4.2._
*/
function recover(
bytes32 hash,
bytes32 r,
bytes32 vs
) internal pure returns (address) {
(address recovered, RecoverError error) = tryRecover(hash, r, vs);
_throwError(error);
return recovered;
}
/**
* @dev Overload of {ECDSA-tryRecover} that receives the `v`,
* `r` and `s` signature fields separately.
*
* _Available since v4.3._
*/
function tryRecover(
bytes32 hash,
uint8 v,
bytes32 r,
bytes32 s
) internal pure returns (address, RecoverError) {
// EIP-2 still allows signature malleability for ecrecover(). Remove this possibility and make the signature
// unique. Appendix F in the Ethereum Yellow paper (https://ethereum.github.io/yellowpaper/paper.pdf), defines
// the valid range for s in (301): 0 < s < secp256k1n ÷ 2 + 1, and for v in (302): v ∈ {27, 28}. Most
// signatures from current libraries generate a unique signature with an s-value in the lower half order.
//
// If your library generates malleable signatures, such as s-values in the upper range, calculate a new s-value
// with 0xFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFEBAAEDCE6AF48A03BBFD25E8CD0364141 - s1 and flip v from 27 to 28 or
// vice versa. If your library also generates signatures with 0/1 for v instead 27/28, add 27 to v to accept
// these malleable signatures as well.
if (uint256(s) > 0x7FFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFF5D576E7357A4501DDFE92F46681B20A0) {
return (address(0), RecoverError.InvalidSignatureS);
}
if (v != 27 && v != 28) {
return (address(0), RecoverError.InvalidSignatureV);
}
// If the signature is valid (and not malleable), return the signer address
address signer = ecrecover(hash, v, r, s);
if (signer == address(0)) {
return (address(0), RecoverError.InvalidSignature);
}
return (signer, RecoverError.NoError);
}
/**
* @dev Overload of {ECDSA-recover} that receives the `v`,
* `r` and `s` signature fields separately.
*/
function recover(
bytes32 hash,
uint8 v,
bytes32 r,
bytes32 s
) internal pure returns (address) {
(address recovered, RecoverError error) = tryRecover(hash, v, r, s);
_throwError(error);
return recovered;
}
/**
* @dev Returns an Ethereum Signed Message, created from a `hash`. This
* produces hash corresponding to the one signed with the
* https://eth.wiki/json-rpc/API#eth_sign[`eth_sign`]
* JSON-RPC method as part of EIP-191.
*
* See {recover}.
*/
function toEthSignedMessageHash(bytes32 hash) internal pure returns (bytes32) {
// 32 is the length in bytes of hash,
// enforced by the type signature above
return keccak256(abi.encodePacked("\\x19Ethereum Signed Message:\
32", hash));
}
/**
* @dev Returns an Ethereum Signed Message, created from `s`. This
* produces hash corresponding to the one signed with the
* https://eth.wiki/json-rpc/API#eth_sign[`eth_sign`]
* JSON-RPC method as part of EIP-191.
*
* See {recover}.
*/
function toEthSignedMessageHash(bytes memory s) internal pure returns (bytes32) {
return keccak256(abi.encodePacked("\\x19Ethereum Signed Message:\
", Strings.toString(s.length), s));
}
/**
* @dev Returns an Ethereum Signed Typed Data, created from a
* `domainSeparator` and a `structHash`. This produces hash corresponding
* to the one signed with the
* https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-712[`eth_signTypedData`]
* JSON-RPC method as part of EIP-712.
*
* See {recover}.
*/
function toTypedDataHash(bytes32 domainSeparator, bytes32 structHash) internal pure returns (bytes32) {
return keccak256(abi.encodePacked("\\x19\\x01", domainSeparator, structHash));
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (token/ERC20/IERC20.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev Interface of the ERC20 standard as defined in the EIP.
*/
interface IERC20Upgradeable {
/**
* @dev Returns the amount of tokens in existence.
*/
function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256);
/**
* @dev Returns the amount of tokens owned by `account`.
*/
function balanceOf(address account) external view returns (uint256);
/**
* @dev Moves `amount` tokens from the caller's account to `recipient`.
*
* Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function transfer(address recipient, uint256 amount) external returns (bool);
/**
* @dev Returns the remaining number of tokens that `spender` will be
* allowed to spend on behalf of `owner` through {transferFrom}. This is
* zero by default.
*
* This value changes when {approve} or {transferFrom} are called.
*/
function allowance(address owner, address spender) external view returns (uint256);
/**
* @dev Sets `amount` as the allowance of `spender` over the caller's tokens.
*
* Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded.
*
* IMPORTANT: Beware that changing an allowance with this method brings the risk
* that someone may use both the old and the new allowance by unfortunate
* transaction ordering. One possible solution to mitigate this race
* condition is to first reduce the spender's allowance to 0 and set the
* desired value afterwards:
* https://github.com/ethereum/EIPs/issues/20#issuecomment-263524729
*
* Emits an {Approval} event.
*/
function approve(address spender, uint256 amount) external returns (bool);
/**
* @dev Moves `amount` tokens from `sender` to `recipient` using the
* allowance mechanism. `amount` is then deducted from the caller's
* allowance.
*
* Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function transferFrom(
address sender,
address recipient,
uint256 amount
) external returns (bool);
/**
* @dev Emitted when `value` tokens are moved from one account (`from`) to
* another (`to`).
*
* Note that `value` may be zero.
*/
event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 value);
/**
* @dev Emitted when the allowance of a `spender` for an `owner` is set by
* a call to {approve}. `value` is the new allowance.
*/
event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed spender, uint256 value);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/Context.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "../proxy/utils/Initializable.sol";
/**
* @dev Provides information about the current execution context, including the
* sender of the transaction and its data. While these are generally available
* via msg.sender and msg.data, they should not be accessed in such a direct
* manner, since when dealing with meta-transactions the account sending and
* paying for execution may not be the actual sender (as far as an application
* is concerned).
*
* This contract is only required for intermediate, library-like contracts.
*/
abstract contract ContextUpgradeable is Initializable {
function __Context_init() internal onlyInitializing {
__Context_init_unchained();
}
function __Context_init_unchained() internal onlyInitializing {
}
function _msgSender() internal view virtual returns (address) {
return msg.sender;
}
function _msgData() internal view virtual returns (bytes calldata) {
return msg.data;
}
uint256[50] private __gap;
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/Address.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev Collection of functions related to the address type
*/
library AddressUpgradeable {
/**
* @dev Returns true if `account` is a contract.
*
* [IMPORTANT]
* ====
* It is unsafe to assume that an address for which this function returns
* false is an externally-owned account (EOA) and not a contract.
*
* Among others, `isContract` will return false for the following
* types of addresses:
*
* - an externally-owned account
* - a contract in construction
* - an address where a contract will be created
* - an address where a contract lived, but was destroyed
* ====
*/
function isContract(address account) internal view returns (bool) {
// This method relies on extcodesize, which returns 0 for contracts in
// construction, since the code is only stored at the end of the
// constructor execution.
uint256 size;
assembly {
size := extcodesize(account)
}
return size > 0;
}
/**
* @dev Replacement for Solidity's `transfer`: sends `amount` wei to
* `recipient`, forwarding all available gas and reverting on errors.
*
* https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1884[EIP1884] increases the gas cost
* of certain opcodes, possibly making contracts go over the 2300 gas limit
* imposed by `transfer`, making them unable to receive funds via
* `transfer`. {sendValue} removes this limitation.
*
* https://diligence.consensys.net/posts/2019/09/stop-using-soliditys-transfer-now/[Learn more].
*
* IMPORTANT: because control is transferred to `recipient`, care must be
* taken to not create reentrancy vulnerabilities. Consider using
* {ReentrancyGuard} or the
* https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/v0.5.11/security-considerations.html#use-the-checks-effects-interactions-pattern[checks-effects-interactions pattern].
*/
function sendValue(address payable recipient, uint256 amount) internal {
require(address(this).balance >= amount, "Address: insufficient balance");
(bool success, ) = recipient.call{value: amount}("");
require(success, "Address: unable to send value, recipient may have reverted");
}
/**
* @dev Performs a Solidity function call using a low level `call`. A
* plain `call` is an unsafe replacement for a function call: use this
* function instead.
*
* If `target` reverts with a revert reason, it is bubbled up by this
* function (like regular Solidity function calls).
*
* Returns the raw returned data. To convert to the expected return value,
* use https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/latest/units-and-global-variables.html?highlight=abi.decode#abi-encoding-and-decoding-functions[`abi.decode`].
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `target` must be a contract.
* - calling `target` with `data` must not revert.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) {
return functionCall(target, data, "Address: low-level call failed");
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], but with
* `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCall(
address target,
bytes memory data,
string memory errorMessage
) internal returns (bytes memory) {
return functionCallWithValue(target, data, 0, errorMessage);
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
* but also transferring `value` wei to `target`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - the calling contract must have an ETH balance of at least `value`.
* - the called Solidity function must be `payable`.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCallWithValue(
address target,
bytes memory data,
uint256 value
) internal returns (bytes memory) {
return functionCallWithValue(target, data, value, "Address: low-level call with value failed");
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCallWithValue-address-bytes-uint256-}[`functionCallWithValue`], but
* with `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCallWithValue(
address target,
bytes memory data,
uint256 value,
string memory errorMessage
) internal returns (bytes memory) {
require(address(this).balance >= value, "Address: insufficient balance for call");
require(isContract(target), "Address: call to non-contract");
(bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.call{value: value}(data);
return verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage);
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
* but performing a static call.
*
* _Available since v3.3._
*/
function functionStaticCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
return functionStaticCall(target, data, "Address: low-level static call failed");
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`],
* but performing a static call.
*
* _Available since v3.3._
*/
function functionStaticCall(
address target,
bytes memory data,
string memory errorMessage
) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
require(isContract(target), "Address: static call to non-contract");
(bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.staticcall(data);
return verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage);
}
/**
* @dev Tool to verifies that a low level call was successful, and revert if it wasn't, either by bubbling the
* revert reason using the provided one.
*
* _Available since v4.3._
*/
function verifyCallResult(
bool success,
bytes memory returndata,
string memory errorMessage
) internal pure returns (bytes memory) {
if (success) {
return returndata;
} else {
// Look for revert reason and bubble it up if present
if (returndata.length > 0) {
// The easiest way to bubble the revert reason is using memory via assembly
assembly {
let returndata_size := mload(returndata)
revert(add(32, returndata), returndata_size)
}
} else {
revert(errorMessage);
}
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/Strings.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev String operations.
*/
library Strings {
bytes16 private constant _HEX_SYMBOLS = "0123456789abcdef";
/**
* @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` decimal representation.
*/
function toString(uint256 value) internal pure returns (string memory) {
// Inspired by OraclizeAPI's implementation - MIT licence
// https://github.com/oraclize/ethereum-api/blob/b42146b063c7d6ee1358846c198246239e9360e8/oraclizeAPI_0.4.25.sol
if (value == 0) {
return "0";
}
uint256 temp = value;
uint256 digits;
while (temp != 0) {
digits++;
temp /= 10;
}
bytes memory buffer = new bytes(digits);
while (value != 0) {
digits -= 1;
buffer[digits] = bytes1(uint8(48 + uint256(value % 10)));
value /= 10;
}
return string(buffer);
}
/**
* @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` hexadecimal representation.
*/
function toHexString(uint256 value) internal pure returns (string memory) {
if (value == 0) {
return "0x00";
}
uint256 temp = value;
uint256 length = 0;
while (temp != 0) {
length++;
temp >>= 8;
}
return toHexString(value, length);
}
/**
* @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` hexadecimal representation with fixed length.
*/
function toHexString(uint256 value, uint256 length) internal pure returns (string memory) {
bytes memory buffer = new bytes(2 * length + 2);
buffer[0] = "0";
buffer[1] = "x";
for (uint256 i = 2 * length + 1; i > 1; --i) {
buffer[i] = _HEX_SYMBOLS[value & 0xf];
value >>= 4;
}
require(value == 0, "Strings: hex length insufficient");
return string(buffer);
}
}
File 4 of 7: ERC721Delegate
// SPDX-License-Identifier: Unlicensed
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
pragma abicoder v2;
import '@openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC721/IERC721.sol';
import '@openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC721/IERC721Receiver.sol';
import '@openzeppelin/contracts/access/AccessControl.sol';
import './MarketConsts.sol';
import './IDelegate.sol';
contract ERC721Delegate is IDelegate, AccessControl, IERC721Receiver {
bytes32 public constant DELEGATION_CALLER = keccak256('DELEGATION_CALLER');
struct Pair {
IERC721 token;
uint256 tokenId;
}
constructor() {
_grantRole(DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE, msg.sender);
}
function onERC721Received(
address,
address,
uint256,
bytes calldata
) external override returns (bytes4) {
return this.onERC721Received.selector;
}
function decode(bytes calldata data) internal pure returns (Pair[] memory) {
return abi.decode(data, (Pair[]));
}
function delegateType() external view returns (uint256) {
// return uint256(Market.DelegationType.ERC721);
return 1;
}
function executeSell(
address seller,
address buyer,
bytes calldata data
) external onlyRole(DELEGATION_CALLER) returns (bool) {
Pair[] memory pairs = decode(data);
for (uint256 i = 0; i < pairs.length; i++) {
Pair memory p = pairs[i];
p.token.safeTransferFrom(seller, buyer, p.tokenId);
}
return true;
}
function executeBuy(
address seller,
address buyer,
bytes calldata data
) external onlyRole(DELEGATION_CALLER) returns (bool) {
Pair[] memory pairs = decode(data);
for (uint256 i = 0; i < pairs.length; i++) {
Pair memory p = pairs[i];
p.token.safeTransferFrom(seller, buyer, p.tokenId);
}
return true;
}
function executeBid(
address seller,
address previousBidder,
address, // bidder,
bytes calldata data
) external onlyRole(DELEGATION_CALLER) returns (bool) {
if (previousBidder == address(0)) {
Pair[] memory pairs = decode(data);
for (uint256 i = 0; i < pairs.length; i++) {
Pair memory p = pairs[i];
p.token.safeTransferFrom(seller, address(this), p.tokenId);
}
}
return true;
}
function executeAuctionComplete(
address, // seller,
address buyer,
bytes calldata data
) external onlyRole(DELEGATION_CALLER) returns (bool) {
Pair[] memory pairs = decode(data);
for (uint256 i = 0; i < pairs.length; i++) {
Pair memory p = pairs[i];
p.token.safeTransferFrom(address(this), buyer, p.tokenId);
}
return true;
}
function executeAuctionRefund(
address seller,
address, // lastBidder,
bytes calldata data
) external onlyRole(DELEGATION_CALLER) returns (bool) {
Pair[] memory pairs = decode(data);
for (uint256 i = 0; i < pairs.length; i++) {
Pair memory p = pairs[i];
p.token.safeTransferFrom(address(this), seller, p.tokenId);
}
return true;
}
function transferBatch(Pair[] memory pairs, address to) public {
for (uint256 i = 0; i < pairs.length; i++) {
Pair memory p = pairs[i];
p.token.safeTransferFrom(msg.sender, to, p.tokenId);
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (token/ERC721/IERC721.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "../../utils/introspection/IERC165.sol";
/**
* @dev Required interface of an ERC721 compliant contract.
*/
interface IERC721 is IERC165 {
/**
* @dev Emitted when `tokenId` token is transferred from `from` to `to`.
*/
event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 indexed tokenId);
/**
* @dev Emitted when `owner` enables `approved` to manage the `tokenId` token.
*/
event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed approved, uint256 indexed tokenId);
/**
* @dev Emitted when `owner` enables or disables (`approved`) `operator` to manage all of its assets.
*/
event ApprovalForAll(address indexed owner, address indexed operator, bool approved);
/**
* @dev Returns the number of tokens in ``owner``'s account.
*/
function balanceOf(address owner) external view returns (uint256 balance);
/**
* @dev Returns the owner of the `tokenId` token.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*/
function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address owner);
/**
* @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`, checking first that contract recipients
* are aware of the ERC721 protocol to prevent tokens from being forever locked.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `from` cannot be the zero address.
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`.
* - If the caller is not `from`, it must be have been allowed to move this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
* - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) external;
/**
* @dev Transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`.
*
* WARNING: Usage of this method is discouraged, use {safeTransferFrom} whenever possible.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `from` cannot be the zero address.
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`.
* - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function transferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) external;
/**
* @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account.
* The approval is cleared when the token is transferred.
*
* Only a single account can be approved at a time, so approving the zero address clears previous approvals.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*
* Emits an {Approval} event.
*/
function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) external;
/**
* @dev Returns the account approved for `tokenId` token.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*/
function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address operator);
/**
* @dev Approve or remove `operator` as an operator for the caller.
* Operators can call {transferFrom} or {safeTransferFrom} for any token owned by the caller.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The `operator` cannot be the caller.
*
* Emits an {ApprovalForAll} event.
*/
function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool _approved) external;
/**
* @dev Returns if the `operator` is allowed to manage all of the assets of `owner`.
*
* See {setApprovalForAll}
*/
function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) external view returns (bool);
/**
* @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `from` cannot be the zero address.
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`.
* - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
* - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes calldata data
) external;
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (token/ERC721/IERC721Receiver.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @title ERC721 token receiver interface
* @dev Interface for any contract that wants to support safeTransfers
* from ERC721 asset contracts.
*/
interface IERC721Receiver {
/**
* @dev Whenever an {IERC721} `tokenId` token is transferred to this contract via {IERC721-safeTransferFrom}
* by `operator` from `from`, this function is called.
*
* It must return its Solidity selector to confirm the token transfer.
* If any other value is returned or the interface is not implemented by the recipient, the transfer will be reverted.
*
* The selector can be obtained in Solidity with `IERC721.onERC721Received.selector`.
*/
function onERC721Received(
address operator,
address from,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes calldata data
) external returns (bytes4);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (access/AccessControl.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "./IAccessControl.sol";
import "../utils/Context.sol";
import "../utils/Strings.sol";
import "../utils/introspection/ERC165.sol";
/**
* @dev Contract module that allows children to implement role-based access
* control mechanisms. This is a lightweight version that doesn't allow enumerating role
* members except through off-chain means by accessing the contract event logs. Some
* applications may benefit from on-chain enumerability, for those cases see
* {AccessControlEnumerable}.
*
* Roles are referred to by their `bytes32` identifier. These should be exposed
* in the external API and be unique. The best way to achieve this is by
* using `public constant` hash digests:
*
* ```
* bytes32 public constant MY_ROLE = keccak256("MY_ROLE");
* ```
*
* Roles can be used to represent a set of permissions. To restrict access to a
* function call, use {hasRole}:
*
* ```
* function foo() public {
* require(hasRole(MY_ROLE, msg.sender));
* ...
* }
* ```
*
* Roles can be granted and revoked dynamically via the {grantRole} and
* {revokeRole} functions. Each role has an associated admin role, and only
* accounts that have a role's admin role can call {grantRole} and {revokeRole}.
*
* By default, the admin role for all roles is `DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE`, which means
* that only accounts with this role will be able to grant or revoke other
* roles. More complex role relationships can be created by using
* {_setRoleAdmin}.
*
* WARNING: The `DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE` is also its own admin: it has permission to
* grant and revoke this role. Extra precautions should be taken to secure
* accounts that have been granted it.
*/
abstract contract AccessControl is Context, IAccessControl, ERC165 {
struct RoleData {
mapping(address => bool) members;
bytes32 adminRole;
}
mapping(bytes32 => RoleData) private _roles;
bytes32 public constant DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE = 0x00;
/**
* @dev Modifier that checks that an account has a specific role. Reverts
* with a standardized message including the required role.
*
* The format of the revert reason is given by the following regular expression:
*
* /^AccessControl: account (0x[0-9a-f]{40}) is missing role (0x[0-9a-f]{64})$/
*
* _Available since v4.1._
*/
modifier onlyRole(bytes32 role) {
_checkRole(role, _msgSender());
_;
}
/**
* @dev See {IERC165-supportsInterface}.
*/
function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
return interfaceId == type(IAccessControl).interfaceId || super.supportsInterface(interfaceId);
}
/**
* @dev Returns `true` if `account` has been granted `role`.
*/
function hasRole(bytes32 role, address account) public view override returns (bool) {
return _roles[role].members[account];
}
/**
* @dev Revert with a standard message if `account` is missing `role`.
*
* The format of the revert reason is given by the following regular expression:
*
* /^AccessControl: account (0x[0-9a-f]{40}) is missing role (0x[0-9a-f]{64})$/
*/
function _checkRole(bytes32 role, address account) internal view {
if (!hasRole(role, account)) {
revert(
string(
abi.encodePacked(
"AccessControl: account ",
Strings.toHexString(uint160(account), 20),
" is missing role ",
Strings.toHexString(uint256(role), 32)
)
)
);
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns the admin role that controls `role`. See {grantRole} and
* {revokeRole}.
*
* To change a role's admin, use {_setRoleAdmin}.
*/
function getRoleAdmin(bytes32 role) public view override returns (bytes32) {
return _roles[role].adminRole;
}
/**
* @dev Grants `role` to `account`.
*
* If `account` had not been already granted `role`, emits a {RoleGranted}
* event.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - the caller must have ``role``'s admin role.
*/
function grantRole(bytes32 role, address account) public virtual override onlyRole(getRoleAdmin(role)) {
_grantRole(role, account);
}
/**
* @dev Revokes `role` from `account`.
*
* If `account` had been granted `role`, emits a {RoleRevoked} event.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - the caller must have ``role``'s admin role.
*/
function revokeRole(bytes32 role, address account) public virtual override onlyRole(getRoleAdmin(role)) {
_revokeRole(role, account);
}
/**
* @dev Revokes `role` from the calling account.
*
* Roles are often managed via {grantRole} and {revokeRole}: this function's
* purpose is to provide a mechanism for accounts to lose their privileges
* if they are compromised (such as when a trusted device is misplaced).
*
* If the calling account had been revoked `role`, emits a {RoleRevoked}
* event.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - the caller must be `account`.
*/
function renounceRole(bytes32 role, address account) public virtual override {
require(account == _msgSender(), "AccessControl: can only renounce roles for self");
_revokeRole(role, account);
}
/**
* @dev Grants `role` to `account`.
*
* If `account` had not been already granted `role`, emits a {RoleGranted}
* event. Note that unlike {grantRole}, this function doesn't perform any
* checks on the calling account.
*
* [WARNING]
* ====
* This function should only be called from the constructor when setting
* up the initial roles for the system.
*
* Using this function in any other way is effectively circumventing the admin
* system imposed by {AccessControl}.
* ====
*
* NOTE: This function is deprecated in favor of {_grantRole}.
*/
function _setupRole(bytes32 role, address account) internal virtual {
_grantRole(role, account);
}
/**
* @dev Sets `adminRole` as ``role``'s admin role.
*
* Emits a {RoleAdminChanged} event.
*/
function _setRoleAdmin(bytes32 role, bytes32 adminRole) internal virtual {
bytes32 previousAdminRole = getRoleAdmin(role);
_roles[role].adminRole = adminRole;
emit RoleAdminChanged(role, previousAdminRole, adminRole);
}
/**
* @dev Grants `role` to `account`.
*
* Internal function without access restriction.
*/
function _grantRole(bytes32 role, address account) internal virtual {
if (!hasRole(role, account)) {
_roles[role].members[account] = true;
emit RoleGranted(role, account, _msgSender());
}
}
/**
* @dev Revokes `role` from `account`.
*
* Internal function without access restriction.
*/
function _revokeRole(bytes32 role, address account) internal virtual {
if (hasRole(role, account)) {
_roles[role].members[account] = false;
emit RoleRevoked(role, account, _msgSender());
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: Unlicensed
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
pragma abicoder v2;
import './IDelegate.sol';
import './IWETHUpgradable.sol';
library Market {
uint256 constant INTENT_SELL = 1;
uint256 constant INTENT_AUCTION = 2;
uint256 constant INTENT_BUY = 3;
uint8 constant SIGN_V1 = 1;
uint8 constant SIGN_V3 = 3;
struct OrderItem {
uint256 price;
bytes data;
}
struct Order {
uint256 salt;
address user;
uint256 network;
uint256 intent;
uint256 delegateType;
uint256 deadline;
IERC20Upgradeable currency;
bytes dataMask;
OrderItem[] items;
// signature
bytes32 r;
bytes32 s;
uint8 v;
uint8 signVersion;
}
struct Fee {
uint256 percentage;
address to;
}
struct SettleDetail {
Market.Op op;
uint256 orderIdx;
uint256 itemIdx;
uint256 price;
bytes32 itemHash;
IDelegate executionDelegate;
bytes dataReplacement;
uint256 bidIncentivePct;
uint256 aucMinIncrementPct;
uint256 aucIncDurationSecs;
Fee[] fees;
}
struct SettleShared {
uint256 salt;
uint256 deadline;
uint256 amountToEth;
uint256 amountToWeth;
address user;
bool canFail;
}
struct RunInput {
Order[] orders;
SettleDetail[] details;
SettleShared shared;
// signature
bytes32 r;
bytes32 s;
uint8 v;
}
struct OngoingAuction {
uint256 price;
uint256 netPrice;
uint256 endAt;
address bidder;
}
enum InvStatus {
NEW,
AUCTION,
COMPLETE,
CANCELLED,
REFUNDED
}
enum Op {
INVALID,
// off-chain
COMPLETE_SELL_OFFER,
COMPLETE_BUY_OFFER,
CANCEL_OFFER,
// auction
BID,
COMPLETE_AUCTION,
REFUND_AUCTION,
REFUND_AUCTION_STUCK_ITEM
}
enum DelegationType {
INVALID,
ERC721,
ERC1155
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: Unlicensed
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
pragma abicoder v2;
interface IDelegate {
function delegateType() external view returns (uint256);
function executeSell(
address seller,
address buyer,
bytes calldata data
) external returns (bool);
function executeBuy(
address seller,
address buyer,
bytes calldata data
) external returns (bool);
function executeBid(
address seller,
address previousBidder,
address bidder,
bytes calldata data
) external returns (bool);
function executeAuctionComplete(
address seller,
address buyer,
bytes calldata data
) external returns (bool);
function executeAuctionRefund(
address seller,
address lastBidder,
bytes calldata data
) external returns (bool);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/introspection/IERC165.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev Interface of the ERC165 standard, as defined in the
* https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165[EIP].
*
* Implementers can declare support of contract interfaces, which can then be
* queried by others ({ERC165Checker}).
*
* For an implementation, see {ERC165}.
*/
interface IERC165 {
/**
* @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by
* `interfaceId`. See the corresponding
* https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified[EIP section]
* to learn more about how these ids are created.
*
* This function call must use less than 30 000 gas.
*/
function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) external view returns (bool);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (access/IAccessControl.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev External interface of AccessControl declared to support ERC165 detection.
*/
interface IAccessControl {
/**
* @dev Emitted when `newAdminRole` is set as ``role``'s admin role, replacing `previousAdminRole`
*
* `DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE` is the starting admin for all roles, despite
* {RoleAdminChanged} not being emitted signaling this.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
event RoleAdminChanged(bytes32 indexed role, bytes32 indexed previousAdminRole, bytes32 indexed newAdminRole);
/**
* @dev Emitted when `account` is granted `role`.
*
* `sender` is the account that originated the contract call, an admin role
* bearer except when using {AccessControl-_setupRole}.
*/
event RoleGranted(bytes32 indexed role, address indexed account, address indexed sender);
/**
* @dev Emitted when `account` is revoked `role`.
*
* `sender` is the account that originated the contract call:
* - if using `revokeRole`, it is the admin role bearer
* - if using `renounceRole`, it is the role bearer (i.e. `account`)
*/
event RoleRevoked(bytes32 indexed role, address indexed account, address indexed sender);
/**
* @dev Returns `true` if `account` has been granted `role`.
*/
function hasRole(bytes32 role, address account) external view returns (bool);
/**
* @dev Returns the admin role that controls `role`. See {grantRole} and
* {revokeRole}.
*
* To change a role's admin, use {AccessControl-_setRoleAdmin}.
*/
function getRoleAdmin(bytes32 role) external view returns (bytes32);
/**
* @dev Grants `role` to `account`.
*
* If `account` had not been already granted `role`, emits a {RoleGranted}
* event.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - the caller must have ``role``'s admin role.
*/
function grantRole(bytes32 role, address account) external;
/**
* @dev Revokes `role` from `account`.
*
* If `account` had been granted `role`, emits a {RoleRevoked} event.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - the caller must have ``role``'s admin role.
*/
function revokeRole(bytes32 role, address account) external;
/**
* @dev Revokes `role` from the calling account.
*
* Roles are often managed via {grantRole} and {revokeRole}: this function's
* purpose is to provide a mechanism for accounts to lose their privileges
* if they are compromised (such as when a trusted device is misplaced).
*
* If the calling account had been granted `role`, emits a {RoleRevoked}
* event.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - the caller must be `account`.
*/
function renounceRole(bytes32 role, address account) external;
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/Context.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev Provides information about the current execution context, including the
* sender of the transaction and its data. While these are generally available
* via msg.sender and msg.data, they should not be accessed in such a direct
* manner, since when dealing with meta-transactions the account sending and
* paying for execution may not be the actual sender (as far as an application
* is concerned).
*
* This contract is only required for intermediate, library-like contracts.
*/
abstract contract Context {
function _msgSender() internal view virtual returns (address) {
return msg.sender;
}
function _msgData() internal view virtual returns (bytes calldata) {
return msg.data;
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/Strings.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev String operations.
*/
library Strings {
bytes16 private constant _HEX_SYMBOLS = "0123456789abcdef";
/**
* @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` decimal representation.
*/
function toString(uint256 value) internal pure returns (string memory) {
// Inspired by OraclizeAPI's implementation - MIT licence
// https://github.com/oraclize/ethereum-api/blob/b42146b063c7d6ee1358846c198246239e9360e8/oraclizeAPI_0.4.25.sol
if (value == 0) {
return "0";
}
uint256 temp = value;
uint256 digits;
while (temp != 0) {
digits++;
temp /= 10;
}
bytes memory buffer = new bytes(digits);
while (value != 0) {
digits -= 1;
buffer[digits] = bytes1(uint8(48 + uint256(value % 10)));
value /= 10;
}
return string(buffer);
}
/**
* @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` hexadecimal representation.
*/
function toHexString(uint256 value) internal pure returns (string memory) {
if (value == 0) {
return "0x00";
}
uint256 temp = value;
uint256 length = 0;
while (temp != 0) {
length++;
temp >>= 8;
}
return toHexString(value, length);
}
/**
* @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` hexadecimal representation with fixed length.
*/
function toHexString(uint256 value, uint256 length) internal pure returns (string memory) {
bytes memory buffer = new bytes(2 * length + 2);
buffer[0] = "0";
buffer[1] = "x";
for (uint256 i = 2 * length + 1; i > 1; --i) {
buffer[i] = _HEX_SYMBOLS[value & 0xf];
value >>= 4;
}
require(value == 0, "Strings: hex length insufficient");
return string(buffer);
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/introspection/ERC165.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "./IERC165.sol";
/**
* @dev Implementation of the {IERC165} interface.
*
* Contracts that want to implement ERC165 should inherit from this contract and override {supportsInterface} to check
* for the additional interface id that will be supported. For example:
*
* ```solidity
* function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
* return interfaceId == type(MyInterface).interfaceId || super.supportsInterface(interfaceId);
* }
* ```
*
* Alternatively, {ERC165Storage} provides an easier to use but more expensive implementation.
*/
abstract contract ERC165 is IERC165 {
/**
* @dev See {IERC165-supportsInterface}.
*/
function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
return interfaceId == type(IERC165).interfaceId;
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: Unlicensed
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
pragma abicoder v2;
import '@openzeppelin/contracts-upgradeable/token/ERC20/IERC20Upgradeable.sol';
interface IWETHUpgradable is IERC20Upgradeable {
function deposit() external payable;
function withdraw(uint256 wad) external;
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (token/ERC20/IERC20.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev Interface of the ERC20 standard as defined in the EIP.
*/
interface IERC20Upgradeable {
/**
* @dev Returns the amount of tokens in existence.
*/
function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256);
/**
* @dev Returns the amount of tokens owned by `account`.
*/
function balanceOf(address account) external view returns (uint256);
/**
* @dev Moves `amount` tokens from the caller's account to `recipient`.
*
* Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function transfer(address recipient, uint256 amount) external returns (bool);
/**
* @dev Returns the remaining number of tokens that `spender` will be
* allowed to spend on behalf of `owner` through {transferFrom}. This is
* zero by default.
*
* This value changes when {approve} or {transferFrom} are called.
*/
function allowance(address owner, address spender) external view returns (uint256);
/**
* @dev Sets `amount` as the allowance of `spender` over the caller's tokens.
*
* Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded.
*
* IMPORTANT: Beware that changing an allowance with this method brings the risk
* that someone may use both the old and the new allowance by unfortunate
* transaction ordering. One possible solution to mitigate this race
* condition is to first reduce the spender's allowance to 0 and set the
* desired value afterwards:
* https://github.com/ethereum/EIPs/issues/20#issuecomment-263524729
*
* Emits an {Approval} event.
*/
function approve(address spender, uint256 amount) external returns (bool);
/**
* @dev Moves `amount` tokens from `sender` to `recipient` using the
* allowance mechanism. `amount` is then deducted from the caller's
* allowance.
*
* Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function transferFrom(
address sender,
address recipient,
uint256 amount
) external returns (bool);
/**
* @dev Emitted when `value` tokens are moved from one account (`from`) to
* another (`to`).
*
* Note that `value` may be zero.
*/
event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 value);
/**
* @dev Emitted when the allowance of a `spender` for an `owner` is set by
* a call to {approve}. `value` is the new allowance.
*/
event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed spender, uint256 value);
}
File 5 of 7: Bueno721Drop
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (access/Ownable.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "../utils/ContextUpgradeable.sol";
import "../proxy/utils/Initializable.sol";
/**
* @dev Contract module which provides a basic access control mechanism, where
* there is an account (an owner) that can be granted exclusive access to
* specific functions.
*
* By default, the owner account will be the one that deploys the contract. This
* can later be changed with {transferOwnership}.
*
* This module is used through inheritance. It will make available the modifier
* `onlyOwner`, which can be applied to your functions to restrict their use to
* the owner.
*/
abstract contract OwnableUpgradeable is Initializable, ContextUpgradeable {
address private _owner;
event OwnershipTransferred(address indexed previousOwner, address indexed newOwner);
/**
* @dev Initializes the contract setting the deployer as the initial owner.
*/
function __Ownable_init() internal onlyInitializing {
__Ownable_init_unchained();
}
function __Ownable_init_unchained() internal onlyInitializing {
_transferOwnership(_msgSender());
}
/**
* @dev Throws if called by any account other than the owner.
*/
modifier onlyOwner() {
_checkOwner();
_;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the address of the current owner.
*/
function owner() public view virtual returns (address) {
return _owner;
}
/**
* @dev Throws if the sender is not the owner.
*/
function _checkOwner() internal view virtual {
require(owner() == _msgSender(), "Ownable: caller is not the owner");
}
/**
* @dev Leaves the contract without owner. It will not be possible to call
* `onlyOwner` functions anymore. Can only be called by the current owner.
*
* NOTE: Renouncing ownership will leave the contract without an owner,
* thereby removing any functionality that is only available to the owner.
*/
function renounceOwnership() public virtual onlyOwner {
_transferOwnership(address(0));
}
/**
* @dev Transfers ownership of the contract to a new account (`newOwner`).
* Can only be called by the current owner.
*/
function transferOwnership(address newOwner) public virtual onlyOwner {
require(newOwner != address(0), "Ownable: new owner is the zero address");
_transferOwnership(newOwner);
}
/**
* @dev Transfers ownership of the contract to a new account (`newOwner`).
* Internal function without access restriction.
*/
function _transferOwnership(address newOwner) internal virtual {
address oldOwner = _owner;
_owner = newOwner;
emit OwnershipTransferred(oldOwner, newOwner);
}
/**
* @dev This empty reserved space is put in place to allow future versions to add new
* variables without shifting down storage in the inheritance chain.
* See https://docs.openzeppelin.com/contracts/4.x/upgradeable#storage_gaps
*/
uint256[49] private __gap;
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.8.0) (finance/PaymentSplitter.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "../token/ERC20/utils/SafeERC20Upgradeable.sol";
import "../utils/AddressUpgradeable.sol";
import "../utils/ContextUpgradeable.sol";
import "../proxy/utils/Initializable.sol";
/**
* @title PaymentSplitter
* @dev This contract allows to split Ether payments among a group of accounts. The sender does not need to be aware
* that the Ether will be split in this way, since it is handled transparently by the contract.
*
* The split can be in equal parts or in any other arbitrary proportion. The way this is specified is by assigning each
* account to a number of shares. Of all the Ether that this contract receives, each account will then be able to claim
* an amount proportional to the percentage of total shares they were assigned. The distribution of shares is set at the
* time of contract deployment and can't be updated thereafter.
*
* `PaymentSplitter` follows a _pull payment_ model. This means that payments are not automatically forwarded to the
* accounts but kept in this contract, and the actual transfer is triggered as a separate step by calling the {release}
* function.
*
* NOTE: This contract assumes that ERC20 tokens will behave similarly to native tokens (Ether). Rebasing tokens, and
* tokens that apply fees during transfers, are likely to not be supported as expected. If in doubt, we encourage you
* to run tests before sending real value to this contract.
*/
contract PaymentSplitterUpgradeable is Initializable, ContextUpgradeable {
event PayeeAdded(address account, uint256 shares);
event PaymentReleased(address to, uint256 amount);
event ERC20PaymentReleased(IERC20Upgradeable indexed token, address to, uint256 amount);
event PaymentReceived(address from, uint256 amount);
uint256 private _totalShares;
uint256 private _totalReleased;
mapping(address => uint256) private _shares;
mapping(address => uint256) private _released;
address[] private _payees;
mapping(IERC20Upgradeable => uint256) private _erc20TotalReleased;
mapping(IERC20Upgradeable => mapping(address => uint256)) private _erc20Released;
/**
* @dev Creates an instance of `PaymentSplitter` where each account in `payees` is assigned the number of shares at
* the matching position in the `shares` array.
*
* All addresses in `payees` must be non-zero. Both arrays must have the same non-zero length, and there must be no
* duplicates in `payees`.
*/
function __PaymentSplitter_init(address[] memory payees, uint256[] memory shares_) internal onlyInitializing {
__PaymentSplitter_init_unchained(payees, shares_);
}
function __PaymentSplitter_init_unchained(address[] memory payees, uint256[] memory shares_) internal onlyInitializing {
require(payees.length == shares_.length, "PaymentSplitter: payees and shares length mismatch");
require(payees.length > 0, "PaymentSplitter: no payees");
for (uint256 i = 0; i < payees.length; i++) {
_addPayee(payees[i], shares_[i]);
}
}
/**
* @dev The Ether received will be logged with {PaymentReceived} events. Note that these events are not fully
* reliable: it's possible for a contract to receive Ether without triggering this function. This only affects the
* reliability of the events, and not the actual splitting of Ether.
*
* To learn more about this see the Solidity documentation for
* https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/latest/contracts.html#fallback-function[fallback
* functions].
*/
receive() external payable virtual {
emit PaymentReceived(_msgSender(), msg.value);
}
/**
* @dev Getter for the total shares held by payees.
*/
function totalShares() public view returns (uint256) {
return _totalShares;
}
/**
* @dev Getter for the total amount of Ether already released.
*/
function totalReleased() public view returns (uint256) {
return _totalReleased;
}
/**
* @dev Getter for the total amount of `token` already released. `token` should be the address of an IERC20
* contract.
*/
function totalReleased(IERC20Upgradeable token) public view returns (uint256) {
return _erc20TotalReleased[token];
}
/**
* @dev Getter for the amount of shares held by an account.
*/
function shares(address account) public view returns (uint256) {
return _shares[account];
}
/**
* @dev Getter for the amount of Ether already released to a payee.
*/
function released(address account) public view returns (uint256) {
return _released[account];
}
/**
* @dev Getter for the amount of `token` tokens already released to a payee. `token` should be the address of an
* IERC20 contract.
*/
function released(IERC20Upgradeable token, address account) public view returns (uint256) {
return _erc20Released[token][account];
}
/**
* @dev Getter for the address of the payee number `index`.
*/
function payee(uint256 index) public view returns (address) {
return _payees[index];
}
/**
* @dev Getter for the amount of payee's releasable Ether.
*/
function releasable(address account) public view returns (uint256) {
uint256 totalReceived = address(this).balance + totalReleased();
return _pendingPayment(account, totalReceived, released(account));
}
/**
* @dev Getter for the amount of payee's releasable `token` tokens. `token` should be the address of an
* IERC20 contract.
*/
function releasable(IERC20Upgradeable token, address account) public view returns (uint256) {
uint256 totalReceived = token.balanceOf(address(this)) + totalReleased(token);
return _pendingPayment(account, totalReceived, released(token, account));
}
/**
* @dev Triggers a transfer to `account` of the amount of Ether they are owed, according to their percentage of the
* total shares and their previous withdrawals.
*/
function release(address payable account) public virtual {
require(_shares[account] > 0, "PaymentSplitter: account has no shares");
uint256 payment = releasable(account);
require(payment != 0, "PaymentSplitter: account is not due payment");
// _totalReleased is the sum of all values in _released.
// If "_totalReleased += payment" does not overflow, then "_released[account] += payment" cannot overflow.
_totalReleased += payment;
unchecked {
_released[account] += payment;
}
AddressUpgradeable.sendValue(account, payment);
emit PaymentReleased(account, payment);
}
/**
* @dev Triggers a transfer to `account` of the amount of `token` tokens they are owed, according to their
* percentage of the total shares and their previous withdrawals. `token` must be the address of an IERC20
* contract.
*/
function release(IERC20Upgradeable token, address account) public virtual {
require(_shares[account] > 0, "PaymentSplitter: account has no shares");
uint256 payment = releasable(token, account);
require(payment != 0, "PaymentSplitter: account is not due payment");
// _erc20TotalReleased[token] is the sum of all values in _erc20Released[token].
// If "_erc20TotalReleased[token] += payment" does not overflow, then "_erc20Released[token][account] += payment"
// cannot overflow.
_erc20TotalReleased[token] += payment;
unchecked {
_erc20Released[token][account] += payment;
}
SafeERC20Upgradeable.safeTransfer(token, account, payment);
emit ERC20PaymentReleased(token, account, payment);
}
/**
* @dev internal logic for computing the pending payment of an `account` given the token historical balances and
* already released amounts.
*/
function _pendingPayment(
address account,
uint256 totalReceived,
uint256 alreadyReleased
) private view returns (uint256) {
return (totalReceived * _shares[account]) / _totalShares - alreadyReleased;
}
/**
* @dev Add a new payee to the contract.
* @param account The address of the payee to add.
* @param shares_ The number of shares owned by the payee.
*/
function _addPayee(address account, uint256 shares_) private {
require(account != address(0), "PaymentSplitter: account is the zero address");
require(shares_ > 0, "PaymentSplitter: shares are 0");
require(_shares[account] == 0, "PaymentSplitter: account already has shares");
_payees.push(account);
_shares[account] = shares_;
_totalShares = _totalShares + shares_;
emit PayeeAdded(account, shares_);
}
/**
* @dev This empty reserved space is put in place to allow future versions to add new
* variables without shifting down storage in the inheritance chain.
* See https://docs.openzeppelin.com/contracts/4.x/upgradeable#storage_gaps
*/
uint256[43] private __gap;
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.6.0) (interfaces/IERC2981.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "../utils/introspection/IERC165Upgradeable.sol";
/**
* @dev Interface for the NFT Royalty Standard.
*
* A standardized way to retrieve royalty payment information for non-fungible tokens (NFTs) to enable universal
* support for royalty payments across all NFT marketplaces and ecosystem participants.
*
* _Available since v4.5._
*/
interface IERC2981Upgradeable is IERC165Upgradeable {
/**
* @dev Returns how much royalty is owed and to whom, based on a sale price that may be denominated in any unit of
* exchange. The royalty amount is denominated and should be paid in that same unit of exchange.
*/
function royaltyInfo(uint256 tokenId, uint256 salePrice)
external
view
returns (address receiver, uint256 royaltyAmount);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.8.0) (proxy/utils/Initializable.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.2;
import "../../utils/AddressUpgradeable.sol";
/**
* @dev This is a base contract to aid in writing upgradeable contracts, or any kind of contract that will be deployed
* behind a proxy. Since proxied contracts do not make use of a constructor, it's common to move constructor logic to an
* external initializer function, usually called `initialize`. It then becomes necessary to protect this initializer
* function so it can only be called once. The {initializer} modifier provided by this contract will have this effect.
*
* The initialization functions use a version number. Once a version number is used, it is consumed and cannot be
* reused. This mechanism prevents re-execution of each "step" but allows the creation of new initialization steps in
* case an upgrade adds a module that needs to be initialized.
*
* For example:
*
* [.hljs-theme-light.nopadding]
* ```
* contract MyToken is ERC20Upgradeable {
* function initialize() initializer public {
* __ERC20_init("MyToken", "MTK");
* }
* }
* contract MyTokenV2 is MyToken, ERC20PermitUpgradeable {
* function initializeV2() reinitializer(2) public {
* __ERC20Permit_init("MyToken");
* }
* }
* ```
*
* TIP: To avoid leaving the proxy in an uninitialized state, the initializer function should be called as early as
* possible by providing the encoded function call as the `_data` argument to {ERC1967Proxy-constructor}.
*
* CAUTION: When used with inheritance, manual care must be taken to not invoke a parent initializer twice, or to ensure
* that all initializers are idempotent. This is not verified automatically as constructors are by Solidity.
*
* [CAUTION]
* ====
* Avoid leaving a contract uninitialized.
*
* An uninitialized contract can be taken over by an attacker. This applies to both a proxy and its implementation
* contract, which may impact the proxy. To prevent the implementation contract from being used, you should invoke
* the {_disableInitializers} function in the constructor to automatically lock it when it is deployed:
*
* [.hljs-theme-light.nopadding]
* ```
* /// @custom:oz-upgrades-unsafe-allow constructor
* constructor() {
* _disableInitializers();
* }
* ```
* ====
*/
abstract contract Initializable {
/**
* @dev Indicates that the contract has been initialized.
* @custom:oz-retyped-from bool
*/
uint8 private _initialized;
/**
* @dev Indicates that the contract is in the process of being initialized.
*/
bool private _initializing;
/**
* @dev Triggered when the contract has been initialized or reinitialized.
*/
event Initialized(uint8 version);
/**
* @dev A modifier that defines a protected initializer function that can be invoked at most once. In its scope,
* `onlyInitializing` functions can be used to initialize parent contracts.
*
* Similar to `reinitializer(1)`, except that functions marked with `initializer` can be nested in the context of a
* constructor.
*
* Emits an {Initialized} event.
*/
modifier initializer() {
bool isTopLevelCall = !_initializing;
require(
(isTopLevelCall && _initialized < 1) || (!AddressUpgradeable.isContract(address(this)) && _initialized == 1),
"Initializable: contract is already initialized"
);
_initialized = 1;
if (isTopLevelCall) {
_initializing = true;
}
_;
if (isTopLevelCall) {
_initializing = false;
emit Initialized(1);
}
}
/**
* @dev A modifier that defines a protected reinitializer function that can be invoked at most once, and only if the
* contract hasn't been initialized to a greater version before. In its scope, `onlyInitializing` functions can be
* used to initialize parent contracts.
*
* A reinitializer may be used after the original initialization step. This is essential to configure modules that
* are added through upgrades and that require initialization.
*
* When `version` is 1, this modifier is similar to `initializer`, except that functions marked with `reinitializer`
* cannot be nested. If one is invoked in the context of another, execution will revert.
*
* Note that versions can jump in increments greater than 1; this implies that if multiple reinitializers coexist in
* a contract, executing them in the right order is up to the developer or operator.
*
* WARNING: setting the version to 255 will prevent any future reinitialization.
*
* Emits an {Initialized} event.
*/
modifier reinitializer(uint8 version) {
require(!_initializing && _initialized < version, "Initializable: contract is already initialized");
_initialized = version;
_initializing = true;
_;
_initializing = false;
emit Initialized(version);
}
/**
* @dev Modifier to protect an initialization function so that it can only be invoked by functions with the
* {initializer} and {reinitializer} modifiers, directly or indirectly.
*/
modifier onlyInitializing() {
require(_initializing, "Initializable: contract is not initializing");
_;
}
/**
* @dev Locks the contract, preventing any future reinitialization. This cannot be part of an initializer call.
* Calling this in the constructor of a contract will prevent that contract from being initialized or reinitialized
* to any version. It is recommended to use this to lock implementation contracts that are designed to be called
* through proxies.
*
* Emits an {Initialized} event the first time it is successfully executed.
*/
function _disableInitializers() internal virtual {
require(!_initializing, "Initializable: contract is initializing");
if (_initialized < type(uint8).max) {
_initialized = type(uint8).max;
emit Initialized(type(uint8).max);
}
}
/**
* @dev Internal function that returns the initialized version. Returns `_initialized`
*/
function _getInitializedVersion() internal view returns (uint8) {
return _initialized;
}
/**
* @dev Internal function that returns the initialized version. Returns `_initializing`
*/
function _isInitializing() internal view returns (bool) {
return _initializing;
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (token/common/ERC2981.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "../../interfaces/IERC2981Upgradeable.sol";
import "../../utils/introspection/ERC165Upgradeable.sol";
import "../../proxy/utils/Initializable.sol";
/**
* @dev Implementation of the NFT Royalty Standard, a standardized way to retrieve royalty payment information.
*
* Royalty information can be specified globally for all token ids via {_setDefaultRoyalty}, and/or individually for
* specific token ids via {_setTokenRoyalty}. The latter takes precedence over the first.
*
* Royalty is specified as a fraction of sale price. {_feeDenominator} is overridable but defaults to 10000, meaning the
* fee is specified in basis points by default.
*
* IMPORTANT: ERC-2981 only specifies a way to signal royalty information and does not enforce its payment. See
* https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2981#optional-royalty-payments[Rationale] in the EIP. Marketplaces are expected to
* voluntarily pay royalties together with sales, but note that this standard is not yet widely supported.
*
* _Available since v4.5._
*/
abstract contract ERC2981Upgradeable is Initializable, IERC2981Upgradeable, ERC165Upgradeable {
function __ERC2981_init() internal onlyInitializing {
}
function __ERC2981_init_unchained() internal onlyInitializing {
}
struct RoyaltyInfo {
address receiver;
uint96 royaltyFraction;
}
RoyaltyInfo private _defaultRoyaltyInfo;
mapping(uint256 => RoyaltyInfo) private _tokenRoyaltyInfo;
/**
* @dev See {IERC165-supportsInterface}.
*/
function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override(IERC165Upgradeable, ERC165Upgradeable) returns (bool) {
return interfaceId == type(IERC2981Upgradeable).interfaceId || super.supportsInterface(interfaceId);
}
/**
* @inheritdoc IERC2981Upgradeable
*/
function royaltyInfo(uint256 _tokenId, uint256 _salePrice) public view virtual override returns (address, uint256) {
RoyaltyInfo memory royalty = _tokenRoyaltyInfo[_tokenId];
if (royalty.receiver == address(0)) {
royalty = _defaultRoyaltyInfo;
}
uint256 royaltyAmount = (_salePrice * royalty.royaltyFraction) / _feeDenominator();
return (royalty.receiver, royaltyAmount);
}
/**
* @dev The denominator with which to interpret the fee set in {_setTokenRoyalty} and {_setDefaultRoyalty} as a
* fraction of the sale price. Defaults to 10000 so fees are expressed in basis points, but may be customized by an
* override.
*/
function _feeDenominator() internal pure virtual returns (uint96) {
return 10000;
}
/**
* @dev Sets the royalty information that all ids in this contract will default to.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `receiver` cannot be the zero address.
* - `feeNumerator` cannot be greater than the fee denominator.
*/
function _setDefaultRoyalty(address receiver, uint96 feeNumerator) internal virtual {
require(feeNumerator <= _feeDenominator(), "ERC2981: royalty fee will exceed salePrice");
require(receiver != address(0), "ERC2981: invalid receiver");
_defaultRoyaltyInfo = RoyaltyInfo(receiver, feeNumerator);
}
/**
* @dev Removes default royalty information.
*/
function _deleteDefaultRoyalty() internal virtual {
delete _defaultRoyaltyInfo;
}
/**
* @dev Sets the royalty information for a specific token id, overriding the global default.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `receiver` cannot be the zero address.
* - `feeNumerator` cannot be greater than the fee denominator.
*/
function _setTokenRoyalty(
uint256 tokenId,
address receiver,
uint96 feeNumerator
) internal virtual {
require(feeNumerator <= _feeDenominator(), "ERC2981: royalty fee will exceed salePrice");
require(receiver != address(0), "ERC2981: Invalid parameters");
_tokenRoyaltyInfo[tokenId] = RoyaltyInfo(receiver, feeNumerator);
}
/**
* @dev Resets royalty information for the token id back to the global default.
*/
function _resetTokenRoyalty(uint256 tokenId) internal virtual {
delete _tokenRoyaltyInfo[tokenId];
}
/**
* @dev This empty reserved space is put in place to allow future versions to add new
* variables without shifting down storage in the inheritance chain.
* See https://docs.openzeppelin.com/contracts/4.x/upgradeable#storage_gaps
*/
uint256[48] private __gap;
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (token/ERC20/extensions/draft-IERC20Permit.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev Interface of the ERC20 Permit extension allowing approvals to be made via signatures, as defined in
* https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2612[EIP-2612].
*
* Adds the {permit} method, which can be used to change an account's ERC20 allowance (see {IERC20-allowance}) by
* presenting a message signed by the account. By not relying on {IERC20-approve}, the token holder account doesn't
* need to send a transaction, and thus is not required to hold Ether at all.
*/
interface IERC20PermitUpgradeable {
/**
* @dev Sets `value` as the allowance of `spender` over ``owner``'s tokens,
* given ``owner``'s signed approval.
*
* IMPORTANT: The same issues {IERC20-approve} has related to transaction
* ordering also apply here.
*
* Emits an {Approval} event.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `spender` cannot be the zero address.
* - `deadline` must be a timestamp in the future.
* - `v`, `r` and `s` must be a valid `secp256k1` signature from `owner`
* over the EIP712-formatted function arguments.
* - the signature must use ``owner``'s current nonce (see {nonces}).
*
* For more information on the signature format, see the
* https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2612#specification[relevant EIP
* section].
*/
function permit(
address owner,
address spender,
uint256 value,
uint256 deadline,
uint8 v,
bytes32 r,
bytes32 s
) external;
/**
* @dev Returns the current nonce for `owner`. This value must be
* included whenever a signature is generated for {permit}.
*
* Every successful call to {permit} increases ``owner``'s nonce by one. This
* prevents a signature from being used multiple times.
*/
function nonces(address owner) external view returns (uint256);
/**
* @dev Returns the domain separator used in the encoding of the signature for {permit}, as defined by {EIP712}.
*/
// solhint-disable-next-line func-name-mixedcase
function DOMAIN_SEPARATOR() external view returns (bytes32);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.6.0) (token/ERC20/IERC20.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev Interface of the ERC20 standard as defined in the EIP.
*/
interface IERC20Upgradeable {
/**
* @dev Emitted when `value` tokens are moved from one account (`from`) to
* another (`to`).
*
* Note that `value` may be zero.
*/
event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 value);
/**
* @dev Emitted when the allowance of a `spender` for an `owner` is set by
* a call to {approve}. `value` is the new allowance.
*/
event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed spender, uint256 value);
/**
* @dev Returns the amount of tokens in existence.
*/
function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256);
/**
* @dev Returns the amount of tokens owned by `account`.
*/
function balanceOf(address account) external view returns (uint256);
/**
* @dev Moves `amount` tokens from the caller's account to `to`.
*
* Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function transfer(address to, uint256 amount) external returns (bool);
/**
* @dev Returns the remaining number of tokens that `spender` will be
* allowed to spend on behalf of `owner` through {transferFrom}. This is
* zero by default.
*
* This value changes when {approve} or {transferFrom} are called.
*/
function allowance(address owner, address spender) external view returns (uint256);
/**
* @dev Sets `amount` as the allowance of `spender` over the caller's tokens.
*
* Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded.
*
* IMPORTANT: Beware that changing an allowance with this method brings the risk
* that someone may use both the old and the new allowance by unfortunate
* transaction ordering. One possible solution to mitigate this race
* condition is to first reduce the spender's allowance to 0 and set the
* desired value afterwards:
* https://github.com/ethereum/EIPs/issues/20#issuecomment-263524729
*
* Emits an {Approval} event.
*/
function approve(address spender, uint256 amount) external returns (bool);
/**
* @dev Moves `amount` tokens from `from` to `to` using the
* allowance mechanism. `amount` is then deducted from the caller's
* allowance.
*
* Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function transferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 amount
) external returns (bool);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.8.0) (token/ERC20/utils/SafeERC20.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "../IERC20Upgradeable.sol";
import "../extensions/draft-IERC20PermitUpgradeable.sol";
import "../../../utils/AddressUpgradeable.sol";
/**
* @title SafeERC20
* @dev Wrappers around ERC20 operations that throw on failure (when the token
* contract returns false). Tokens that return no value (and instead revert or
* throw on failure) are also supported, non-reverting calls are assumed to be
* successful.
* To use this library you can add a `using SafeERC20 for IERC20;` statement to your contract,
* which allows you to call the safe operations as `token.safeTransfer(...)`, etc.
*/
library SafeERC20Upgradeable {
using AddressUpgradeable for address;
function safeTransfer(
IERC20Upgradeable token,
address to,
uint256 value
) internal {
_callOptionalReturn(token, abi.encodeWithSelector(token.transfer.selector, to, value));
}
function safeTransferFrom(
IERC20Upgradeable token,
address from,
address to,
uint256 value
) internal {
_callOptionalReturn(token, abi.encodeWithSelector(token.transferFrom.selector, from, to, value));
}
/**
* @dev Deprecated. This function has issues similar to the ones found in
* {IERC20-approve}, and its usage is discouraged.
*
* Whenever possible, use {safeIncreaseAllowance} and
* {safeDecreaseAllowance} instead.
*/
function safeApprove(
IERC20Upgradeable token,
address spender,
uint256 value
) internal {
// safeApprove should only be called when setting an initial allowance,
// or when resetting it to zero. To increase and decrease it, use
// 'safeIncreaseAllowance' and 'safeDecreaseAllowance'
require(
(value == 0) || (token.allowance(address(this), spender) == 0),
"SafeERC20: approve from non-zero to non-zero allowance"
);
_callOptionalReturn(token, abi.encodeWithSelector(token.approve.selector, spender, value));
}
function safeIncreaseAllowance(
IERC20Upgradeable token,
address spender,
uint256 value
) internal {
uint256 newAllowance = token.allowance(address(this), spender) + value;
_callOptionalReturn(token, abi.encodeWithSelector(token.approve.selector, spender, newAllowance));
}
function safeDecreaseAllowance(
IERC20Upgradeable token,
address spender,
uint256 value
) internal {
unchecked {
uint256 oldAllowance = token.allowance(address(this), spender);
require(oldAllowance >= value, "SafeERC20: decreased allowance below zero");
uint256 newAllowance = oldAllowance - value;
_callOptionalReturn(token, abi.encodeWithSelector(token.approve.selector, spender, newAllowance));
}
}
function safePermit(
IERC20PermitUpgradeable token,
address owner,
address spender,
uint256 value,
uint256 deadline,
uint8 v,
bytes32 r,
bytes32 s
) internal {
uint256 nonceBefore = token.nonces(owner);
token.permit(owner, spender, value, deadline, v, r, s);
uint256 nonceAfter = token.nonces(owner);
require(nonceAfter == nonceBefore + 1, "SafeERC20: permit did not succeed");
}
/**
* @dev Imitates a Solidity high-level call (i.e. a regular function call to a contract), relaxing the requirement
* on the return value: the return value is optional (but if data is returned, it must not be false).
* @param token The token targeted by the call.
* @param data The call data (encoded using abi.encode or one of its variants).
*/
function _callOptionalReturn(IERC20Upgradeable token, bytes memory data) private {
// We need to perform a low level call here, to bypass Solidity's return data size checking mechanism, since
// we're implementing it ourselves. We use {Address-functionCall} to perform this call, which verifies that
// the target address contains contract code and also asserts for success in the low-level call.
bytes memory returndata = address(token).functionCall(data, "SafeERC20: low-level call failed");
if (returndata.length > 0) {
// Return data is optional
require(abi.decode(returndata, (bool)), "SafeERC20: ERC20 operation did not succeed");
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.8.0) (utils/Address.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.1;
/**
* @dev Collection of functions related to the address type
*/
library AddressUpgradeable {
/**
* @dev Returns true if `account` is a contract.
*
* [IMPORTANT]
* ====
* It is unsafe to assume that an address for which this function returns
* false is an externally-owned account (EOA) and not a contract.
*
* Among others, `isContract` will return false for the following
* types of addresses:
*
* - an externally-owned account
* - a contract in construction
* - an address where a contract will be created
* - an address where a contract lived, but was destroyed
* ====
*
* [IMPORTANT]
* ====
* You shouldn't rely on `isContract` to protect against flash loan attacks!
*
* Preventing calls from contracts is highly discouraged. It breaks composability, breaks support for smart wallets
* like Gnosis Safe, and does not provide security since it can be circumvented by calling from a contract
* constructor.
* ====
*/
function isContract(address account) internal view returns (bool) {
// This method relies on extcodesize/address.code.length, which returns 0
// for contracts in construction, since the code is only stored at the end
// of the constructor execution.
return account.code.length > 0;
}
/**
* @dev Replacement for Solidity's `transfer`: sends `amount` wei to
* `recipient`, forwarding all available gas and reverting on errors.
*
* https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1884[EIP1884] increases the gas cost
* of certain opcodes, possibly making contracts go over the 2300 gas limit
* imposed by `transfer`, making them unable to receive funds via
* `transfer`. {sendValue} removes this limitation.
*
* https://diligence.consensys.net/posts/2019/09/stop-using-soliditys-transfer-now/[Learn more].
*
* IMPORTANT: because control is transferred to `recipient`, care must be
* taken to not create reentrancy vulnerabilities. Consider using
* {ReentrancyGuard} or the
* https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/v0.5.11/security-considerations.html#use-the-checks-effects-interactions-pattern[checks-effects-interactions pattern].
*/
function sendValue(address payable recipient, uint256 amount) internal {
require(address(this).balance >= amount, "Address: insufficient balance");
(bool success, ) = recipient.call{value: amount}("");
require(success, "Address: unable to send value, recipient may have reverted");
}
/**
* @dev Performs a Solidity function call using a low level `call`. A
* plain `call` is an unsafe replacement for a function call: use this
* function instead.
*
* If `target` reverts with a revert reason, it is bubbled up by this
* function (like regular Solidity function calls).
*
* Returns the raw returned data. To convert to the expected return value,
* use https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/latest/units-and-global-variables.html?highlight=abi.decode#abi-encoding-and-decoding-functions[`abi.decode`].
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `target` must be a contract.
* - calling `target` with `data` must not revert.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) {
return functionCallWithValue(target, data, 0, "Address: low-level call failed");
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], but with
* `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCall(
address target,
bytes memory data,
string memory errorMessage
) internal returns (bytes memory) {
return functionCallWithValue(target, data, 0, errorMessage);
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
* but also transferring `value` wei to `target`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - the calling contract must have an ETH balance of at least `value`.
* - the called Solidity function must be `payable`.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCallWithValue(
address target,
bytes memory data,
uint256 value
) internal returns (bytes memory) {
return functionCallWithValue(target, data, value, "Address: low-level call with value failed");
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCallWithValue-address-bytes-uint256-}[`functionCallWithValue`], but
* with `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCallWithValue(
address target,
bytes memory data,
uint256 value,
string memory errorMessage
) internal returns (bytes memory) {
require(address(this).balance >= value, "Address: insufficient balance for call");
(bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.call{value: value}(data);
return verifyCallResultFromTarget(target, success, returndata, errorMessage);
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
* but performing a static call.
*
* _Available since v3.3._
*/
function functionStaticCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
return functionStaticCall(target, data, "Address: low-level static call failed");
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`],
* but performing a static call.
*
* _Available since v3.3._
*/
function functionStaticCall(
address target,
bytes memory data,
string memory errorMessage
) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
(bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.staticcall(data);
return verifyCallResultFromTarget(target, success, returndata, errorMessage);
}
/**
* @dev Tool to verify that a low level call to smart-contract was successful, and revert (either by bubbling
* the revert reason or using the provided one) in case of unsuccessful call or if target was not a contract.
*
* _Available since v4.8._
*/
function verifyCallResultFromTarget(
address target,
bool success,
bytes memory returndata,
string memory errorMessage
) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
if (success) {
if (returndata.length == 0) {
// only check isContract if the call was successful and the return data is empty
// otherwise we already know that it was a contract
require(isContract(target), "Address: call to non-contract");
}
return returndata;
} else {
_revert(returndata, errorMessage);
}
}
/**
* @dev Tool to verify that a low level call was successful, and revert if it wasn't, either by bubbling the
* revert reason or using the provided one.
*
* _Available since v4.3._
*/
function verifyCallResult(
bool success,
bytes memory returndata,
string memory errorMessage
) internal pure returns (bytes memory) {
if (success) {
return returndata;
} else {
_revert(returndata, errorMessage);
}
}
function _revert(bytes memory returndata, string memory errorMessage) private pure {
// Look for revert reason and bubble it up if present
if (returndata.length > 0) {
// The easiest way to bubble the revert reason is using memory via assembly
/// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
assembly {
let returndata_size := mload(returndata)
revert(add(32, returndata), returndata_size)
}
} else {
revert(errorMessage);
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/Context.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "../proxy/utils/Initializable.sol";
/**
* @dev Provides information about the current execution context, including the
* sender of the transaction and its data. While these are generally available
* via msg.sender and msg.data, they should not be accessed in such a direct
* manner, since when dealing with meta-transactions the account sending and
* paying for execution may not be the actual sender (as far as an application
* is concerned).
*
* This contract is only required for intermediate, library-like contracts.
*/
abstract contract ContextUpgradeable is Initializable {
function __Context_init() internal onlyInitializing {
}
function __Context_init_unchained() internal onlyInitializing {
}
function _msgSender() internal view virtual returns (address) {
return msg.sender;
}
function _msgData() internal view virtual returns (bytes calldata) {
return msg.data;
}
/**
* @dev This empty reserved space is put in place to allow future versions to add new
* variables without shifting down storage in the inheritance chain.
* See https://docs.openzeppelin.com/contracts/4.x/upgradeable#storage_gaps
*/
uint256[50] private __gap;
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/introspection/ERC165.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "./IERC165Upgradeable.sol";
import "../../proxy/utils/Initializable.sol";
/**
* @dev Implementation of the {IERC165} interface.
*
* Contracts that want to implement ERC165 should inherit from this contract and override {supportsInterface} to check
* for the additional interface id that will be supported. For example:
*
* ```solidity
* function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
* return interfaceId == type(MyInterface).interfaceId || super.supportsInterface(interfaceId);
* }
* ```
*
* Alternatively, {ERC165Storage} provides an easier to use but more expensive implementation.
*/
abstract contract ERC165Upgradeable is Initializable, IERC165Upgradeable {
function __ERC165_init() internal onlyInitializing {
}
function __ERC165_init_unchained() internal onlyInitializing {
}
/**
* @dev See {IERC165-supportsInterface}.
*/
function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
return interfaceId == type(IERC165Upgradeable).interfaceId;
}
/**
* @dev This empty reserved space is put in place to allow future versions to add new
* variables without shifting down storage in the inheritance chain.
* See https://docs.openzeppelin.com/contracts/4.x/upgradeable#storage_gaps
*/
uint256[50] private __gap;
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/introspection/IERC165.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev Interface of the ERC165 standard, as defined in the
* https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165[EIP].
*
* Implementers can declare support of contract interfaces, which can then be
* queried by others ({ERC165Checker}).
*
* For an implementation, see {ERC165}.
*/
interface IERC165Upgradeable {
/**
* @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by
* `interfaceId`. See the corresponding
* https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified[EIP section]
* to learn more about how these ids are created.
*
* This function call must use less than 30 000 gas.
*/
function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) external view returns (bool);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.8.0) (utils/cryptography/MerkleProof.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev These functions deal with verification of Merkle Tree proofs.
*
* The tree and the proofs can be generated using our
* https://github.com/OpenZeppelin/merkle-tree[JavaScript library].
* You will find a quickstart guide in the readme.
*
* WARNING: You should avoid using leaf values that are 64 bytes long prior to
* hashing, or use a hash function other than keccak256 for hashing leaves.
* This is because the concatenation of a sorted pair of internal nodes in
* the merkle tree could be reinterpreted as a leaf value.
* OpenZeppelin's JavaScript library generates merkle trees that are safe
* against this attack out of the box.
*/
library MerkleProof {
/**
* @dev Returns true if a `leaf` can be proved to be a part of a Merkle tree
* defined by `root`. For this, a `proof` must be provided, containing
* sibling hashes on the branch from the leaf to the root of the tree. Each
* pair of leaves and each pair of pre-images are assumed to be sorted.
*/
function verify(
bytes32[] memory proof,
bytes32 root,
bytes32 leaf
) internal pure returns (bool) {
return processProof(proof, leaf) == root;
}
/**
* @dev Calldata version of {verify}
*
* _Available since v4.7._
*/
function verifyCalldata(
bytes32[] calldata proof,
bytes32 root,
bytes32 leaf
) internal pure returns (bool) {
return processProofCalldata(proof, leaf) == root;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the rebuilt hash obtained by traversing a Merkle tree up
* from `leaf` using `proof`. A `proof` is valid if and only if the rebuilt
* hash matches the root of the tree. When processing the proof, the pairs
* of leafs & pre-images are assumed to be sorted.
*
* _Available since v4.4._
*/
function processProof(bytes32[] memory proof, bytes32 leaf) internal pure returns (bytes32) {
bytes32 computedHash = leaf;
for (uint256 i = 0; i < proof.length; i++) {
computedHash = _hashPair(computedHash, proof[i]);
}
return computedHash;
}
/**
* @dev Calldata version of {processProof}
*
* _Available since v4.7._
*/
function processProofCalldata(bytes32[] calldata proof, bytes32 leaf) internal pure returns (bytes32) {
bytes32 computedHash = leaf;
for (uint256 i = 0; i < proof.length; i++) {
computedHash = _hashPair(computedHash, proof[i]);
}
return computedHash;
}
/**
* @dev Returns true if the `leaves` can be simultaneously proven to be a part of a merkle tree defined by
* `root`, according to `proof` and `proofFlags` as described in {processMultiProof}.
*
* CAUTION: Not all merkle trees admit multiproofs. See {processMultiProof} for details.
*
* _Available since v4.7._
*/
function multiProofVerify(
bytes32[] memory proof,
bool[] memory proofFlags,
bytes32 root,
bytes32[] memory leaves
) internal pure returns (bool) {
return processMultiProof(proof, proofFlags, leaves) == root;
}
/**
* @dev Calldata version of {multiProofVerify}
*
* CAUTION: Not all merkle trees admit multiproofs. See {processMultiProof} for details.
*
* _Available since v4.7._
*/
function multiProofVerifyCalldata(
bytes32[] calldata proof,
bool[] calldata proofFlags,
bytes32 root,
bytes32[] memory leaves
) internal pure returns (bool) {
return processMultiProofCalldata(proof, proofFlags, leaves) == root;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the root of a tree reconstructed from `leaves` and sibling nodes in `proof`. The reconstruction
* proceeds by incrementally reconstructing all inner nodes by combining a leaf/inner node with either another
* leaf/inner node or a proof sibling node, depending on whether each `proofFlags` item is true or false
* respectively.
*
* CAUTION: Not all merkle trees admit multiproofs. To use multiproofs, it is sufficient to ensure that: 1) the tree
* is complete (but not necessarily perfect), 2) the leaves to be proven are in the opposite order they are in the
* tree (i.e., as seen from right to left starting at the deepest layer and continuing at the next layer).
*
* _Available since v4.7._
*/
function processMultiProof(
bytes32[] memory proof,
bool[] memory proofFlags,
bytes32[] memory leaves
) internal pure returns (bytes32 merkleRoot) {
// This function rebuild the root hash by traversing the tree up from the leaves. The root is rebuilt by
// consuming and producing values on a queue. The queue starts with the `leaves` array, then goes onto the
// `hashes` array. At the end of the process, the last hash in the `hashes` array should contain the root of
// the merkle tree.
uint256 leavesLen = leaves.length;
uint256 totalHashes = proofFlags.length;
// Check proof validity.
require(leavesLen + proof.length - 1 == totalHashes, "MerkleProof: invalid multiproof");
// The xxxPos values are "pointers" to the next value to consume in each array. All accesses are done using
// `xxx[xxxPos++]`, which return the current value and increment the pointer, thus mimicking a queue's "pop".
bytes32[] memory hashes = new bytes32[](totalHashes);
uint256 leafPos = 0;
uint256 hashPos = 0;
uint256 proofPos = 0;
// At each step, we compute the next hash using two values:
// - a value from the "main queue". If not all leaves have been consumed, we get the next leaf, otherwise we
// get the next hash.
// - depending on the flag, either another value for the "main queue" (merging branches) or an element from the
// `proof` array.
for (uint256 i = 0; i < totalHashes; i++) {
bytes32 a = leafPos < leavesLen ? leaves[leafPos++] : hashes[hashPos++];
bytes32 b = proofFlags[i] ? leafPos < leavesLen ? leaves[leafPos++] : hashes[hashPos++] : proof[proofPos++];
hashes[i] = _hashPair(a, b);
}
if (totalHashes > 0) {
return hashes[totalHashes - 1];
} else if (leavesLen > 0) {
return leaves[0];
} else {
return proof[0];
}
}
/**
* @dev Calldata version of {processMultiProof}.
*
* CAUTION: Not all merkle trees admit multiproofs. See {processMultiProof} for details.
*
* _Available since v4.7._
*/
function processMultiProofCalldata(
bytes32[] calldata proof,
bool[] calldata proofFlags,
bytes32[] memory leaves
) internal pure returns (bytes32 merkleRoot) {
// This function rebuild the root hash by traversing the tree up from the leaves. The root is rebuilt by
// consuming and producing values on a queue. The queue starts with the `leaves` array, then goes onto the
// `hashes` array. At the end of the process, the last hash in the `hashes` array should contain the root of
// the merkle tree.
uint256 leavesLen = leaves.length;
uint256 totalHashes = proofFlags.length;
// Check proof validity.
require(leavesLen + proof.length - 1 == totalHashes, "MerkleProof: invalid multiproof");
// The xxxPos values are "pointers" to the next value to consume in each array. All accesses are done using
// `xxx[xxxPos++]`, which return the current value and increment the pointer, thus mimicking a queue's "pop".
bytes32[] memory hashes = new bytes32[](totalHashes);
uint256 leafPos = 0;
uint256 hashPos = 0;
uint256 proofPos = 0;
// At each step, we compute the next hash using two values:
// - a value from the "main queue". If not all leaves have been consumed, we get the next leaf, otherwise we
// get the next hash.
// - depending on the flag, either another value for the "main queue" (merging branches) or an element from the
// `proof` array.
for (uint256 i = 0; i < totalHashes; i++) {
bytes32 a = leafPos < leavesLen ? leaves[leafPos++] : hashes[hashPos++];
bytes32 b = proofFlags[i] ? leafPos < leavesLen ? leaves[leafPos++] : hashes[hashPos++] : proof[proofPos++];
hashes[i] = _hashPair(a, b);
}
if (totalHashes > 0) {
return hashes[totalHashes - 1];
} else if (leavesLen > 0) {
return leaves[0];
} else {
return proof[0];
}
}
function _hashPair(bytes32 a, bytes32 b) private pure returns (bytes32) {
return a < b ? _efficientHash(a, b) : _efficientHash(b, a);
}
function _efficientHash(bytes32 a, bytes32 b) private pure returns (bytes32 value) {
/// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
assembly {
mstore(0x00, a)
mstore(0x20, b)
value := keccak256(0x00, 0x40)
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.17;
import "erc721a-upgradeable/contracts/extensions/ERC721AQueryableUpgradeable.sol";
import "@openzeppelin/contracts-upgradeable/access/OwnableUpgradeable.sol";
import "@openzeppelin/contracts-upgradeable/token/common/ERC2981Upgradeable.sol";
import "@openzeppelin/contracts/utils/cryptography/MerkleProof.sol";
import "@openzeppelin/contracts-upgradeable/finance/PaymentSplitterUpgradeable.sol";
import "operator-filter-registry/src/upgradeable/OperatorFiltererUpgradeable.sol";
struct PhaseSettings {
/// @dev phase supply. This can be released to public by ending the phase.
uint64 maxSupply;
/// @dev tracks the total amount minted in the phase
uint64 amountMinted;
/// @dev wallet maximum for the phase
uint64 maxPerWallet;
/// @dev merkle root for the phase (if applicable, otherwise bytes32(0))
bytes32 merkleRoot;
/// @dev whether the phase is active
bool isActive;
/// @dev price for the phase (or free if 0)
uint256 price;
}
struct BaseSettings {
/// @dev public sale supply. ending a phase will carry supply into this value
uint64 maxSupply;
/// @dev global wallet maximum across all phases (including public)
uint64 maxPerWallet;
/// @dev tracks the total amount minted in the public sale
uint64 amountMinted;
/// @dev price for the public sale (or free if 0)
uint256 price;
}
struct SaleState {
uint64 numPhases;
mapping(uint256 => PhaseSettings) phases;
}
struct PaymentSplitterSettings {
address[] payees;
uint256[] shares;
}
struct RoyaltySettings {
address royaltyAddress;
uint96 royaltyAmount;
}
error SaleInactive();
error SoldOut();
error InvalidPrice();
error ExceedMaxPerWallet();
error InvalidProof();
error PhaseNotActive();
error NotAllowlisted();
error InvalidMintFunction();
error InvalidAirdrop();
error InvalidPhase();
error BurningNotAllowed();
/// @author Bueno.art
/// @title ERC-721 Multi-Phase Drop Contract
contract Bueno721Drop is
ERC721AQueryableUpgradeable,
OwnableUpgradeable,
ERC2981Upgradeable,
PaymentSplitterUpgradeable,
OperatorFiltererUpgradeable
{
string public _baseTokenURI;
SaleState public saleState;
BaseSettings public baseSettings;
address[] public withdrawAddresses;
mapping(address => mapping(uint256 => uint64)) private amountMintedForPhase;
bool public isPublicActive;
bool private allowBurning;
event TokensMinted(address indexed to, uint256 quantity);
event TokenBurned(address indexed owner, uint256 tokenId);
event TokensAirdropped(uint256 numRecipients, uint256 numTokens);
event PhasesActivated(uint256[] phaseIds, bool activatedPublic);
event PhasesPaused(uint256[] phaseIds, bool pausedPublic);
event PhaseEnded(uint256 phaseIds);
event BurnStatusChanged(bool burnActive);
event PhaseSettingsUpdated(uint256 phaseId, PhaseSettings settings);
event BaseSettingsUpdated(BaseSettings settings);
event BaseURIUpdated(string baseURI);
event RoyaltyUpdated(address royaltyAddress, uint96 royaltyAmount);
/// @custom:oz-upgrades-unsafe-allow constructor
constructor() {
_disableInitializers();
}
function initialize(
string memory _name,
string memory _symbol,
string memory _baseUri,
RoyaltySettings calldata _royaltySettings,
PhaseSettings[] calldata _phases,
BaseSettings calldata _baseSettings,
PaymentSplitterSettings calldata _paymentSplitterSettings,
uint256 _maxIntendedSupply,
bool _allowBurning,
address _deployer,
address _operatorFilter
) public initializerERC721A initializer {
__ERC721A_init(_name, _symbol);
__Ownable_init();
__PaymentSplitter_init(
_paymentSplitterSettings.payees,
_paymentSplitterSettings.shares
);
uint64 numPhases = uint64(_phases.length);
uint256 supplyValidationCount = _baseSettings.maxSupply;
for (uint256 i = 0; i < numPhases; ) {
saleState.phases[i] = _phases[i];
supplyValidationCount += _phases[i].maxSupply;
// numPhases has a maximum value of 2^64 - 1
unchecked {
++i;
}
}
require(
supplyValidationCount == _maxIntendedSupply,
"Supply of all phases must equal maxIntendedSupply"
);
_baseTokenURI = _baseUri;
withdrawAddresses = _paymentSplitterSettings.payees;
saleState.numPhases = numPhases;
baseSettings = _baseSettings;
allowBurning = _allowBurning;
_setDefaultRoyalty(
_royaltySettings.royaltyAddress,
_royaltySettings.royaltyAmount
);
transferOwnership(_deployer);
OperatorFiltererUpgradeable.__OperatorFilterer_init(
_operatorFilter,
_operatorFilter == address(0) ? false : true // only subscribe if a filter is provided
);
}
// ========= EXTERNAL MINTING METHODS =========
/**
* @notice Mint tokens for an allowlisted phase
* @dev Calling this function for a phase that doesn't have an allowlist will fail
*/
function mintPhaseAllowlist(
uint256 phaseIndex,
uint64 quantity,
bytes32[] calldata proof
) external payable {
uint64 updatedAmountMinted = _checkAllowlistPhaseMintConditions(
msg.sender,
quantity,
proof,
phaseIndex,
msg.value
);
_checkGlobalPerWalletMax(msg.sender, quantity);
saleState.phases[phaseIndex].amountMinted += quantity;
amountMintedForPhase[msg.sender][phaseIndex] = updatedAmountMinted;
_mint(msg.sender, quantity);
emit TokensMinted(msg.sender, quantity);
}
/**
* @notice Mint tokens for a non-allowlist phase.
* @dev Calling this function for a phase that has an allowlist will fail
*/
function mintPhase(uint256 phaseIndex, uint64 quantity) external payable {
uint64 updatedAmountMinted = _checkPhaseMintConditions(
msg.sender,
quantity,
phaseIndex,
msg.value
);
_checkGlobalPerWalletMax(msg.sender, quantity);
saleState.phases[phaseIndex].amountMinted += quantity;
amountMintedForPhase[msg.sender][phaseIndex] = updatedAmountMinted;
_mint(msg.sender, quantity);
emit TokensMinted(msg.sender, quantity);
}
/**
* @notice Mint tokens in the public sale
*/
function mintPublic(uint64 quantity) external payable {
uint64 updatedAmountMinted = _checkPublicMintConditions(
quantity,
msg.value
);
_checkGlobalPerWalletMax(msg.sender, quantity);
baseSettings.amountMinted = updatedAmountMinted;
_mint(msg.sender, quantity);
emit TokensMinted(msg.sender, quantity);
}
/**
* @notice Mint tokens in all possible phases (including public sale)
*/
function mintBatch(
uint64[] calldata quantities,
bytes32[][] calldata proofs,
uint256[] calldata phaseIndices,
uint64 publicQuantity
) external payable {
uint256 phaseLength = phaseIndices.length;
if (
phaseLength > saleState.numPhases ||
phaseLength != quantities.length ||
phaseLength != proofs.length
) {
revert InvalidPhase();
}
uint256 balance = msg.value;
uint256 quantityToMint;
for (uint256 i = 0; i < phaseLength; ) {
uint64 updatedAmount;
uint256 phaseIndex = phaseIndices[i];
uint64 quantity = quantities[i];
bytes32[] calldata proof = proofs[i];
PhaseSettings storage phase = saleState.phases[phaseIndex];
uint256 priceForPhase = phase.price * quantity;
// Since price is strictly checked in the _check* functions below,
// we have an additional check here to ensure that the balance doesn't underflow
if (balance < priceForPhase) {
revert InvalidPrice();
}
// if the phase has no allowlist, the merkleRoot will be zeroed out.
if (phase.merkleRoot == bytes32(0)) {
updatedAmount = _checkPhaseMintConditions(
msg.sender,
quantity,
phaseIndex,
priceForPhase
);
} else {
updatedAmount = _checkAllowlistPhaseMintConditions(
msg.sender,
quantity,
proof,
phaseIndex,
priceForPhase
);
}
// quantity & phaseLength have a maximum value of 2^64 - 1
// balance underflow is checked above
unchecked {
saleState.phases[phaseIndex].amountMinted += quantity;
amountMintedForPhase[msg.sender][phaseIndex] = updatedAmount;
balance -= priceForPhase;
quantityToMint += quantity;
++i;
}
}
uint256 totalMintQuantity = quantityToMint;
if (publicQuantity > 0) {
_checkPublicMintConditions(publicQuantity, balance);
// publicQuantity has a max value of 2^64 - 1
unchecked {
baseSettings.amountMinted += publicQuantity;
totalMintQuantity += publicQuantity;
}
}
_checkGlobalPerWalletMax(msg.sender, totalMintQuantity);
_mint(msg.sender, totalMintQuantity);
emit TokensMinted(msg.sender, totalMintQuantity);
}
/**
* @notice Burn a token, if the contract allows for it
*/
function burn(uint256 tokenId) external {
if (!allowBurning) {
revert BurningNotAllowed();
}
_burn(tokenId, true);
emit TokenBurned(msg.sender, tokenId);
}
// ========= OWNER METHODS =========
/**
* @notice Perform a batch airdrop for a particular phase.
* @dev Minted tokens are pulled from the phase that is specified in the airdropper.
*/
function airdropForPhase(
uint256 phaseIndex,
uint64[] calldata quantities,
address[] calldata recipients
) external onlyOwner {
uint256 numRecipients = recipients.length;
uint256 totalAirdropped;
if (numRecipients != quantities.length) revert InvalidAirdrop();
PhaseSettings storage phase = saleState.phases[phaseIndex];
for (uint256 i = 0; i < numRecipients; ) {
uint64 updatedAmountMinted = phase.amountMinted + quantities[i];
if (updatedAmountMinted > phase.maxSupply) {
revert SoldOut();
}
// airdrops are not subject to the per-wallet mint limits,
// but we track how much is minted for the phase
phase.amountMinted = updatedAmountMinted;
totalAirdropped += quantities[i];
_mint(recipients[i], quantities[i]);
// numRecipients has a maximum value of 2^256 - 1
unchecked {
++i;
}
}
emit TokensAirdropped(numRecipients, totalAirdropped);
}
/**
* @notice Perform a batch airdrop for the public phase.
* @dev Minted tokens are pulled from the public phase.
*/
function airdropPublic(
uint64[] calldata quantities,
address[] calldata recipients
) external onlyOwner {
uint256 numRecipients = recipients.length;
uint256 totalAirdropped;
if (numRecipients != quantities.length) revert InvalidAirdrop();
for (uint256 i = 0; i < numRecipients; ) {
uint64 updatedAmountMinted = baseSettings.amountMinted +
quantities[i];
if (updatedAmountMinted > baseSettings.maxSupply) {
revert SoldOut();
}
// airdrops are not subject to the per-wallet mint limits,
// but we track how much is minted for the phase
baseSettings.amountMinted = updatedAmountMinted;
totalAirdropped += quantities[i];
_mint(recipients[i], quantities[i]);
// numRecipients has a maximum value of 2^256 - 1
unchecked {
++i;
}
}
emit TokensAirdropped(numRecipients, totalAirdropped);
}
/**
* @notice Specify which phases are active.
* Public sale can be activated by setting `activatePublic` to true.
*/
function activatePhases(
uint256[] calldata phaseIndices,
bool activatePublic
) external onlyOwner {
uint256 numPhases = phaseIndices.length;
// activate all the phases provided in phaseIndices
for (uint256 i = 0; i < numPhases; ) {
uint256 phaseIndex = phaseIndices[i];
if (phaseIndex >= saleState.numPhases) {
// phaseIndex is out of bounds
revert InvalidPhase();
}
saleState.phases[phaseIndices[i]].isActive = true;
// numPhases has a maximum value of 2^256 - 1
unchecked {
++i;
}
}
// calling this function with activatePublic=false only indicates the public sale
// is not intended to be activated, but it does not pause it.
if (activatePublic) {
isPublicActive = true;
}
emit PhasesActivated(phaseIndices, activatePublic);
}
/**
* @notice Specify which phases are inactive (paused).
* Public sale can be paused by setting `pausePublic` to true.
* Pausing is separate from ending, since ending permanently closes the phase.
*/
function pausePhases(
uint256[] calldata phaseIndices,
bool pausePublic
) external onlyOwner {
uint256 numPhases = phaseIndices.length;
for (uint256 i = 0; i < numPhases; ) {
uint256 phaseIndex = phaseIndices[i];
if (phaseIndex >= saleState.numPhases) {
// phaseIndex is out of bounds
revert InvalidPhase();
}
saleState.phases[phaseIndex].isActive = false;
// numPhases has a maximum value of 2^256 - 1
unchecked {
++i;
}
}
// calling this function with pausePublic=false only indicates the public sale
// is not intended to be paused, but it does not pause it.
if (pausePublic) {
isPublicActive = false;
}
emit PhasesPaused(phaseIndices, pausePublic);
}
/**
* @notice If enabled, the token can be burned, for approved operators.
* @dev The burn method will revert unless this is enabled
*/
function toggleBurning() external onlyOwner {
allowBurning = !allowBurning;
emit BurnStatusChanged(allowBurning);
}
/**
* @notice Permanently closes a phase by capping the supply & releasing it
*/
function endPhase(uint256 phaseIndex) public onlyOwner {
PhaseSettings storage phase = saleState.phases[phaseIndex];
// if the phase never had supply, there is nothing to do
if (phase.maxSupply == 0) {
revert InvalidPhase();
}
// transfer the remaining supply into the base settings (used for public sale accounting)
baseSettings.maxSupply += phase.maxSupply - phase.amountMinted;
// remove the supply from the phase
phase.maxSupply = 0;
emit PhaseEnded(phaseIndex);
}
function endPhases(uint64[] calldata phaseIndices) external onlyOwner {
uint256 phaseIndicesLength = phaseIndices.length;
// ensure that phaseIndices argument will only ever be as large as the number of phases
if (phaseIndicesLength > saleState.numPhases) {
revert InvalidPhase();
}
for (uint256 i = 0; i < phaseIndicesLength; ) {
endPhase(phaseIndices[i]);
// phaseIndicesLength has a maximum value of 2^256 - 1
unchecked {
++i;
}
}
}
/**
* @notice Updates the minting rules for a particular phase
* @dev supply & amountMinted are not changeable
*/
function updatePhaseSettings(
uint256 phaseIndex,
PhaseSettings calldata phase
) external onlyOwner {
uint64 existingAmountMinted = saleState.phases[phaseIndex].amountMinted;
uint64 existingMaxSupply = saleState.phases[phaseIndex].maxSupply;
bool existingStatus = saleState.phases[phaseIndex].isActive;
saleState.phases[phaseIndex] = phase;
// ensure that the amountMinted, maxSupply, and status values cannot be set
saleState.phases[phaseIndex].amountMinted = existingAmountMinted;
saleState.phases[phaseIndex].maxSupply = existingMaxSupply;
saleState.phases[phaseIndex].isActive = existingStatus;
emit PhaseSettingsUpdated(phaseIndex, phase);
}
/**
* @notice Updates the the base minting settings
* The global maxPerWallet setting applies to all phases
* Pricing and other fields will apply to the public sale
*
* @dev maxSupply & amountMinted are not changeable
*/
function updateBaseSettings(
BaseSettings calldata _baseSettings
) external onlyOwner {
uint64 existingMaxSupply = baseSettings.maxSupply;
uint64 existingAmountMinted = baseSettings.amountMinted;
baseSettings = _baseSettings;
// ensure that the maxSupply & amountMinted value cannot be set
baseSettings.maxSupply = existingMaxSupply;
baseSettings.amountMinted = existingAmountMinted;
emit BaseSettingsUpdated(_baseSettings);
}
/**
* @dev Payment can be pulled via PaymentSplitter.release
* this method is provided for convenience to release all payee funds
*/
function withdraw() external onlyOwner {
uint256 numAddresses = withdrawAddresses.length;
for (uint256 i = 0; i < numAddresses; ) {
address payable withdrawAddress = payable(withdrawAddresses[i]);
if (releasable(withdrawAddress) > 0) {
release(withdrawAddress);
}
// numAddresses has a maximum value of 2^256 - 1
unchecked {
++i;
}
}
}
function setBaseURI(string memory baseURI) external onlyOwner {
_baseTokenURI = baseURI;
emit BaseURIUpdated(baseURI);
}
function setRoyaltyInfo(
address receiver,
uint96 feeBasisPoints
) external onlyOwner {
_setDefaultRoyalty(receiver, feeBasisPoints);
emit RoyaltyUpdated(receiver, feeBasisPoints);
}
// ========= VIEW METHODS =========
function _startTokenId() internal view virtual override returns (uint256) {
return 1;
}
function _checkAllowlistPhaseMintConditions(
address wallet,
uint64 quantity,
bytes32[] calldata proof,
uint256 phaseIndex,
uint256 balance
) internal view returns (uint64) {
PhaseSettings storage phase = saleState.phases[phaseIndex];
if (!phase.isActive) {
revert PhaseNotActive();
}
// there should be a valid merkle root for the phase
if (phase.merkleRoot == bytes32(0)) {
revert InvalidMintFunction();
}
if (phase.amountMinted + quantity > phase.maxSupply) {
revert SoldOut();
}
if (balance != quantity * phase.price) {
revert InvalidPrice();
}
if (
!MerkleProof.verify(
proof,
phase.merkleRoot,
keccak256(abi.encodePacked(wallet))
)
) {
revert InvalidProof();
}
uint256 amountMinted = amountMintedForPhase[wallet][phaseIndex];
uint256 updatedAmountMinted = amountMinted + quantity;
// phases can have a maxPerWallet
if (
phase.maxPerWallet > 0 && updatedAmountMinted > phase.maxPerWallet
) {
revert ExceedMaxPerWallet();
}
return uint64(updatedAmountMinted);
}
function _checkPhaseMintConditions(
address wallet,
uint256 quantity,
uint256 phaseIndex,
uint256 balance
) internal view returns (uint64) {
PhaseSettings storage phase = saleState.phases[phaseIndex];
if (!phase.isActive) {
revert PhaseNotActive();
}
// the phase should not have a merkleRoot
if (phase.merkleRoot != bytes32(0)) {
revert InvalidMintFunction();
}
if (phase.amountMinted + quantity > phase.maxSupply) {
revert SoldOut();
}
if (balance != quantity * phase.price) {
revert InvalidPrice();
}
uint256 amountMinted = amountMintedForPhase[wallet][phaseIndex];
uint256 updatedAmountMinted = amountMinted + quantity;
// phases can have a maxPerWallet
if (
phase.maxPerWallet > 0 && updatedAmountMinted > phase.maxPerWallet
) {
revert ExceedMaxPerWallet();
}
return uint64(updatedAmountMinted);
}
function _checkPublicMintConditions(
uint256 quantity,
uint256 balance
) internal view returns (uint64) {
if (!isPublicActive) {
revert PhaseNotActive();
}
uint256 updatedAmountMinted = baseSettings.amountMinted + quantity;
if (updatedAmountMinted > baseSettings.maxSupply) {
revert SoldOut();
}
if (balance != quantity * baseSettings.price) {
revert InvalidPrice();
}
return uint64(updatedAmountMinted);
}
function _checkGlobalPerWalletMax(
address wallet,
uint256 quantity
) internal view {
if (
baseSettings.maxPerWallet > 0 &&
_numberMinted(wallet) + quantity > baseSettings.maxPerWallet
) {
revert ExceedMaxPerWallet();
}
}
function getDataForPhase(
uint256 phaseIndex
) external view returns (PhaseSettings memory) {
return saleState.phases[phaseIndex];
}
function getMintBalance(address wallet) external view returns (uint256) {
return _numberMinted(wallet);
}
function getAmountMintedForPhase(
uint256 phaseIndex,
address wallet
) external view returns (uint64) {
return amountMintedForPhase[wallet][phaseIndex];
}
function getAmountMintedForOwner(
address wallet
) external view returns (uint256[] memory) {
uint256[] memory amountMintedPerPhase = new uint256[](
saleState.numPhases + 1
);
for (uint64 i = 0; i < saleState.numPhases; ) {
amountMintedPerPhase[i] = amountMintedForPhase[wallet][i];
// numPhases has a maximum value of 2^64 - 1
unchecked {
++i;
}
}
amountMintedPerPhase[saleState.numPhases] = _numberMinted(wallet);
return amountMintedPerPhase;
}
/**
* @dev See {ERC721-_baseURI}.
*/
function _baseURI() internal view virtual override returns (string memory) {
return _baseTokenURI;
}
function supportsInterface(
bytes4 interfaceId
)
public
view
virtual
override(IERC721AUpgradeable, ERC721AUpgradeable, ERC2981Upgradeable)
returns (bool)
{
return
ERC721AUpgradeable.supportsInterface(interfaceId) ||
ERC2981Upgradeable.supportsInterface(interfaceId);
}
// ========= OPERATOR FILTERER OVERRIDES =========
function setApprovalForAll(
address operator,
bool approved
)
public
override(ERC721AUpgradeable, IERC721AUpgradeable)
onlyAllowedOperatorApproval(operator)
{
super.setApprovalForAll(operator, approved);
}
function approve(
address operator,
uint256 tokenId
)
public
payable
override(ERC721AUpgradeable, IERC721AUpgradeable)
onlyAllowedOperatorApproval(operator)
{
super.approve(operator, tokenId);
}
function transferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
)
public
payable
override(ERC721AUpgradeable, IERC721AUpgradeable)
onlyAllowedOperator(from)
{
super.transferFrom(from, to, tokenId);
}
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
)
public
payable
override(ERC721AUpgradeable, IERC721AUpgradeable)
onlyAllowedOperator(from)
{
super.safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId);
}
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes memory data
)
public
payable
override(ERC721AUpgradeable, IERC721AUpgradeable)
onlyAllowedOperator(from)
{
super.safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, data);
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev This is a base contract to aid in writing upgradeable diamond facet contracts, or any kind of contract that will be deployed
* behind a proxy. Since proxied contracts do not make use of a constructor, it's common to move constructor logic to an
* external initializer function, usually called `initialize`. It then becomes necessary to protect this initializer
* function so it can only be called once. The {initializer} modifier provided by this contract will have this effect.
*
* TIP: To avoid leaving the proxy in an uninitialized state, the initializer function should be called as early as
* possible by providing the encoded function call as the `_data` argument to {ERC1967Proxy-constructor}.
*
* CAUTION: When used with inheritance, manual care must be taken to not invoke a parent initializer twice, or to ensure
* that all initializers are idempotent. This is not verified automatically as constructors are by Solidity.
*/
import {ERC721A__InitializableStorage} from './ERC721A__InitializableStorage.sol';
abstract contract ERC721A__Initializable {
using ERC721A__InitializableStorage for ERC721A__InitializableStorage.Layout;
/**
* @dev Modifier to protect an initializer function from being invoked twice.
*/
modifier initializerERC721A() {
// If the contract is initializing we ignore whether _initialized is set in order to support multiple
// inheritance patterns, but we only do this in the context of a constructor, because in other contexts the
// contract may have been reentered.
require(
ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initializing
? _isConstructor()
: !ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initialized,
'ERC721A__Initializable: contract is already initialized'
);
bool isTopLevelCall = !ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initializing;
if (isTopLevelCall) {
ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initializing = true;
ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initialized = true;
}
_;
if (isTopLevelCall) {
ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initializing = false;
}
}
/**
* @dev Modifier to protect an initialization function so that it can only be invoked by functions with the
* {initializer} modifier, directly or indirectly.
*/
modifier onlyInitializingERC721A() {
require(
ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initializing,
'ERC721A__Initializable: contract is not initializing'
);
_;
}
/// @dev Returns true if and only if the function is running in the constructor
function _isConstructor() private view returns (bool) {
// extcodesize checks the size of the code stored in an address, and
// address returns the current address. Since the code is still not
// deployed when running a constructor, any checks on its code size will
// yield zero, making it an effective way to detect if a contract is
// under construction or not.
address self = address(this);
uint256 cs;
assembly {
cs := extcodesize(self)
}
return cs == 0;
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev This is a base storage for the initialization function for upgradeable diamond facet contracts
**/
library ERC721A__InitializableStorage {
struct Layout {
/*
* Indicates that the contract has been initialized.
*/
bool _initialized;
/*
* Indicates that the contract is in the process of being initialized.
*/
bool _initializing;
}
bytes32 internal constant STORAGE_SLOT = keccak256('ERC721A.contracts.storage.initializable.facet');
function layout() internal pure returns (Layout storage l) {
bytes32 slot = STORAGE_SLOT;
assembly {
l.slot := slot
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
library ERC721AStorage {
// Bypass for a `--via-ir` bug (https://github.com/chiru-labs/ERC721A/pull/364).
struct TokenApprovalRef {
address value;
}
struct Layout {
// =============================================================
// STORAGE
// =============================================================
// The next token ID to be minted.
uint256 _currentIndex;
// The number of tokens burned.
uint256 _burnCounter;
// Token name
string _name;
// Token symbol
string _symbol;
// Mapping from token ID to ownership details
// An empty struct value does not necessarily mean the token is unowned.
// See {_packedOwnershipOf} implementation for details.
//
// Bits Layout:
// - [0..159] `addr`
// - [160..223] `startTimestamp`
// - [224] `burned`
// - [225] `nextInitialized`
// - [232..255] `extraData`
mapping(uint256 => uint256) _packedOwnerships;
// Mapping owner address to address data.
//
// Bits Layout:
// - [0..63] `balance`
// - [64..127] `numberMinted`
// - [128..191] `numberBurned`
// - [192..255] `aux`
mapping(address => uint256) _packedAddressData;
// Mapping from token ID to approved address.
mapping(uint256 => ERC721AStorage.TokenApprovalRef) _tokenApprovals;
// Mapping from owner to operator approvals
mapping(address => mapping(address => bool)) _operatorApprovals;
}
bytes32 internal constant STORAGE_SLOT = keccak256('ERC721A.contracts.storage.ERC721A');
function layout() internal pure returns (Layout storage l) {
bytes32 slot = STORAGE_SLOT;
assembly {
l.slot := slot
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// ERC721A Contracts v4.2.3
// Creator: Chiru Labs
pragma solidity ^0.8.4;
import './IERC721AUpgradeable.sol';
import {ERC721AStorage} from './ERC721AStorage.sol';
import './ERC721A__Initializable.sol';
/**
* @dev Interface of ERC721 token receiver.
*/
interface ERC721A__IERC721ReceiverUpgradeable {
function onERC721Received(
address operator,
address from,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes calldata data
) external returns (bytes4);
}
/**
* @title ERC721A
*
* @dev Implementation of the [ERC721](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-721)
* Non-Fungible Token Standard, including the Metadata extension.
* Optimized for lower gas during batch mints.
*
* Token IDs are minted in sequential order (e.g. 0, 1, 2, 3, ...)
* starting from `_startTokenId()`.
*
* Assumptions:
*
* - An owner cannot have more than 2**64 - 1 (max value of uint64) of supply.
* - The maximum token ID cannot exceed 2**256 - 1 (max value of uint256).
*/
contract ERC721AUpgradeable is ERC721A__Initializable, IERC721AUpgradeable {
using ERC721AStorage for ERC721AStorage.Layout;
// =============================================================
// CONSTANTS
// =============================================================
// Mask of an entry in packed address data.
uint256 private constant _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY = (1 << 64) - 1;
// The bit position of `numberMinted` in packed address data.
uint256 private constant _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED = 64;
// The bit position of `numberBurned` in packed address data.
uint256 private constant _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED = 128;
// The bit position of `aux` in packed address data.
uint256 private constant _BITPOS_AUX = 192;
// Mask of all 256 bits in packed address data except the 64 bits for `aux`.
uint256 private constant _BITMASK_AUX_COMPLEMENT = (1 << 192) - 1;
// The bit position of `startTimestamp` in packed ownership.
uint256 private constant _BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP = 160;
// The bit mask of the `burned` bit in packed ownership.
uint256 private constant _BITMASK_BURNED = 1 << 224;
// The bit position of the `nextInitialized` bit in packed ownership.
uint256 private constant _BITPOS_NEXT_INITIALIZED = 225;
// The bit mask of the `nextInitialized` bit in packed ownership.
uint256 private constant _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED = 1 << 225;
// The bit position of `extraData` in packed ownership.
uint256 private constant _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA = 232;
// Mask of all 256 bits in a packed ownership except the 24 bits for `extraData`.
uint256 private constant _BITMASK_EXTRA_DATA_COMPLEMENT = (1 << 232) - 1;
// The mask of the lower 160 bits for addresses.
uint256 private constant _BITMASK_ADDRESS = (1 << 160) - 1;
// The maximum `quantity` that can be minted with {_mintERC2309}.
// This limit is to prevent overflows on the address data entries.
// For a limit of 5000, a total of 3.689e15 calls to {_mintERC2309}
// is required to cause an overflow, which is unrealistic.
uint256 private constant _MAX_MINT_ERC2309_QUANTITY_LIMIT = 5000;
// The `Transfer` event signature is given by:
// `keccak256(bytes("Transfer(address,address,uint256)"))`.
bytes32 private constant _TRANSFER_EVENT_SIGNATURE =
0xddf252ad1be2c89b69c2b068fc378daa952ba7f163c4a11628f55a4df523b3ef;
// =============================================================
// CONSTRUCTOR
// =============================================================
function __ERC721A_init(string memory name_, string memory symbol_) internal onlyInitializingERC721A {
__ERC721A_init_unchained(name_, symbol_);
}
function __ERC721A_init_unchained(string memory name_, string memory symbol_) internal onlyInitializingERC721A {
ERC721AStorage.layout()._name = name_;
ERC721AStorage.layout()._symbol = symbol_;
ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex = _startTokenId();
}
// =============================================================
// TOKEN COUNTING OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns the starting token ID.
* To change the starting token ID, please override this function.
*/
function _startTokenId() internal view virtual returns (uint256) {
return 0;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the next token ID to be minted.
*/
function _nextTokenId() internal view virtual returns (uint256) {
return ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the total number of tokens in existence.
* Burned tokens will reduce the count.
* To get the total number of tokens minted, please see {_totalMinted}.
*/
function totalSupply() public view virtual override returns (uint256) {
// Counter underflow is impossible as _burnCounter cannot be incremented
// more than `_currentIndex - _startTokenId()` times.
unchecked {
return ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex - ERC721AStorage.layout()._burnCounter - _startTokenId();
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns the total amount of tokens minted in the contract.
*/
function _totalMinted() internal view virtual returns (uint256) {
// Counter underflow is impossible as `_currentIndex` does not decrement,
// and it is initialized to `_startTokenId()`.
unchecked {
return ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex - _startTokenId();
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns the total number of tokens burned.
*/
function _totalBurned() internal view virtual returns (uint256) {
return ERC721AStorage.layout()._burnCounter;
}
// =============================================================
// ADDRESS DATA OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns the number of tokens in `owner`'s account.
*/
function balanceOf(address owner) public view virtual override returns (uint256) {
if (owner == address(0)) revert BalanceQueryForZeroAddress();
return ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[owner] & _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY;
}
/**
* Returns the number of tokens minted by `owner`.
*/
function _numberMinted(address owner) internal view returns (uint256) {
return
(ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[owner] >> _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED) & _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY;
}
/**
* Returns the number of tokens burned by or on behalf of `owner`.
*/
function _numberBurned(address owner) internal view returns (uint256) {
return
(ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[owner] >> _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED) & _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY;
}
/**
* Returns the auxiliary data for `owner`. (e.g. number of whitelist mint slots used).
*/
function _getAux(address owner) internal view returns (uint64) {
return uint64(ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[owner] >> _BITPOS_AUX);
}
/**
* Sets the auxiliary data for `owner`. (e.g. number of whitelist mint slots used).
* If there are multiple variables, please pack them into a uint64.
*/
function _setAux(address owner, uint64 aux) internal virtual {
uint256 packed = ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[owner];
uint256 auxCasted;
// Cast `aux` with assembly to avoid redundant masking.
assembly {
auxCasted := aux
}
packed = (packed & _BITMASK_AUX_COMPLEMENT) | (auxCasted << _BITPOS_AUX);
ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[owner] = packed;
}
// =============================================================
// IERC165
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by
* `interfaceId`. See the corresponding
* [EIP section](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified)
* to learn more about how these ids are created.
*
* This function call must use less than 30000 gas.
*/
function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
// The interface IDs are constants representing the first 4 bytes
// of the XOR of all function selectors in the interface.
// See: [ERC165](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165)
// (e.g. `bytes4(i.functionA.selector ^ i.functionB.selector ^ ...)`)
return
interfaceId == 0x01ffc9a7 || // ERC165 interface ID for ERC165.
interfaceId == 0x80ac58cd || // ERC165 interface ID for ERC721.
interfaceId == 0x5b5e139f; // ERC165 interface ID for ERC721Metadata.
}
// =============================================================
// IERC721Metadata
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns the token collection name.
*/
function name() public view virtual override returns (string memory) {
return ERC721AStorage.layout()._name;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the token collection symbol.
*/
function symbol() public view virtual override returns (string memory) {
return ERC721AStorage.layout()._symbol;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the Uniform Resource Identifier (URI) for `tokenId` token.
*/
function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (string memory) {
if (!_exists(tokenId)) revert URIQueryForNonexistentToken();
string memory baseURI = _baseURI();
return bytes(baseURI).length != 0 ? string(abi.encodePacked(baseURI, _toString(tokenId))) : '';
}
/**
* @dev Base URI for computing {tokenURI}. If set, the resulting URI for each
* token will be the concatenation of the `baseURI` and the `tokenId`. Empty
* by default, it can be overridden in child contracts.
*/
function _baseURI() internal view virtual returns (string memory) {
return '';
}
// =============================================================
// OWNERSHIPS OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns the owner of the `tokenId` token.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*/
function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (address) {
return address(uint160(_packedOwnershipOf(tokenId)));
}
/**
* @dev Gas spent here starts off proportional to the maximum mint batch size.
* It gradually moves to O(1) as tokens get transferred around over time.
*/
function _ownershipOf(uint256 tokenId) internal view virtual returns (TokenOwnership memory) {
return _unpackedOwnership(_packedOwnershipOf(tokenId));
}
/**
* @dev Returns the unpacked `TokenOwnership` struct at `index`.
*/
function _ownershipAt(uint256 index) internal view virtual returns (TokenOwnership memory) {
return _unpackedOwnership(ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[index]);
}
/**
* @dev Initializes the ownership slot minted at `index` for efficiency purposes.
*/
function _initializeOwnershipAt(uint256 index) internal virtual {
if (ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[index] == 0) {
ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[index] = _packedOwnershipOf(index);
}
}
/**
* Returns the packed ownership data of `tokenId`.
*/
function _packedOwnershipOf(uint256 tokenId) private view returns (uint256 packed) {
if (_startTokenId() <= tokenId) {
packed = ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[tokenId];
// If not burned.
if (packed & _BITMASK_BURNED == 0) {
// If the data at the starting slot does not exist, start the scan.
if (packed == 0) {
if (tokenId >= ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex) revert OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken();
// Invariant:
// There will always be an initialized ownership slot
// (i.e. `ownership.addr != address(0) && ownership.burned == false`)
// before an unintialized ownership slot
// (i.e. `ownership.addr == address(0) && ownership.burned == false`)
// Hence, `tokenId` will not underflow.
//
// We can directly compare the packed value.
// If the address is zero, packed will be zero.
for (;;) {
unchecked {
packed = ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[--tokenId];
}
if (packed == 0) continue;
return packed;
}
}
// Otherwise, the data exists and is not burned. We can skip the scan.
// This is possible because we have already achieved the target condition.
// This saves 2143 gas on transfers of initialized tokens.
return packed;
}
}
revert OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken();
}
/**
* @dev Returns the unpacked `TokenOwnership` struct from `packed`.
*/
function _unpackedOwnership(uint256 packed) private pure returns (TokenOwnership memory ownership) {
ownership.addr = address(uint160(packed));
ownership.startTimestamp = uint64(packed >> _BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP);
ownership.burned = packed & _BITMASK_BURNED != 0;
ownership.extraData = uint24(packed >> _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA);
}
/**
* @dev Packs ownership data into a single uint256.
*/
function _packOwnershipData(address owner, uint256 flags) private view returns (uint256 result) {
assembly {
// Mask `owner` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
owner := and(owner, _BITMASK_ADDRESS)
// `owner | (block.timestamp << _BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP) | flags`.
result := or(owner, or(shl(_BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP, timestamp()), flags))
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns the `nextInitialized` flag set if `quantity` equals 1.
*/
function _nextInitializedFlag(uint256 quantity) private pure returns (uint256 result) {
// For branchless setting of the `nextInitialized` flag.
assembly {
// `(quantity == 1) << _BITPOS_NEXT_INITIALIZED`.
result := shl(_BITPOS_NEXT_INITIALIZED, eq(quantity, 1))
}
}
// =============================================================
// APPROVAL OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account. See {ERC721A-_approve}.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
*/
function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) public payable virtual override {
_approve(to, tokenId, true);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the account approved for `tokenId` token.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*/
function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (address) {
if (!_exists(tokenId)) revert ApprovalQueryForNonexistentToken();
return ERC721AStorage.layout()._tokenApprovals[tokenId].value;
}
/**
* @dev Approve or remove `operator` as an operator for the caller.
* Operators can call {transferFrom} or {safeTransferFrom}
* for any token owned by the caller.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The `operator` cannot be the caller.
*
* Emits an {ApprovalForAll} event.
*/
function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool approved) public virtual override {
ERC721AStorage.layout()._operatorApprovals[_msgSenderERC721A()][operator] = approved;
emit ApprovalForAll(_msgSenderERC721A(), operator, approved);
}
/**
* @dev Returns if the `operator` is allowed to manage all of the assets of `owner`.
*
* See {setApprovalForAll}.
*/
function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
return ERC721AStorage.layout()._operatorApprovals[owner][operator];
}
/**
* @dev Returns whether `tokenId` exists.
*
* Tokens can be managed by their owner or approved accounts via {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
*
* Tokens start existing when they are minted. See {_mint}.
*/
function _exists(uint256 tokenId) internal view virtual returns (bool) {
return
_startTokenId() <= tokenId &&
tokenId < ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex && // If within bounds,
ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[tokenId] & _BITMASK_BURNED == 0; // and not burned.
}
/**
* @dev Returns whether `msgSender` is equal to `approvedAddress` or `owner`.
*/
function _isSenderApprovedOrOwner(
address approvedAddress,
address owner,
address msgSender
) private pure returns (bool result) {
assembly {
// Mask `owner` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
owner := and(owner, _BITMASK_ADDRESS)
// Mask `msgSender` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
msgSender := and(msgSender, _BITMASK_ADDRESS)
// `msgSender == owner || msgSender == approvedAddress`.
result := or(eq(msgSender, owner), eq(msgSender, approvedAddress))
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns the storage slot and value for the approved address of `tokenId`.
*/
function _getApprovedSlotAndAddress(uint256 tokenId)
private
view
returns (uint256 approvedAddressSlot, address approvedAddress)
{
ERC721AStorage.TokenApprovalRef storage tokenApproval = ERC721AStorage.layout()._tokenApprovals[tokenId];
// The following is equivalent to `approvedAddress = _tokenApprovals[tokenId].value`.
assembly {
approvedAddressSlot := tokenApproval.slot
approvedAddress := sload(approvedAddressSlot)
}
}
// =============================================================
// TRANSFER OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Transfers `tokenId` from `from` to `to`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `from` cannot be the zero address.
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`.
* - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token
* by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function transferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) public payable virtual override {
uint256 prevOwnershipPacked = _packedOwnershipOf(tokenId);
if (address(uint160(prevOwnershipPacked)) != from) revert TransferFromIncorrectOwner();
(uint256 approvedAddressSlot, address approvedAddress) = _getApprovedSlotAndAddress(tokenId);
// The nested ifs save around 20+ gas over a compound boolean condition.
if (!_isSenderApprovedOrOwner(approvedAddress, from, _msgSenderERC721A()))
if (!isApprovedForAll(from, _msgSenderERC721A())) revert TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
if (to == address(0)) revert TransferToZeroAddress();
_beforeTokenTransfers(from, to, tokenId, 1);
// Clear approvals from the previous owner.
assembly {
if approvedAddress {
// This is equivalent to `delete _tokenApprovals[tokenId]`.
sstore(approvedAddressSlot, 0)
}
}
// Underflow of the sender's balance is impossible because we check for
// ownership above and the recipient's balance can't realistically overflow.
// Counter overflow is incredibly unrealistic as `tokenId` would have to be 2**256.
unchecked {
// We can directly increment and decrement the balances.
--ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[from]; // Updates: `balance -= 1`.
++ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[to]; // Updates: `balance += 1`.
// Updates:
// - `address` to the next owner.
// - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of transfering.
// - `burned` to `false`.
// - `nextInitialized` to `true`.
ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[tokenId] = _packOwnershipData(
to,
_BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED | _nextExtraData(from, to, prevOwnershipPacked)
);
// If the next slot may not have been initialized (i.e. `nextInitialized == false`) .
if (prevOwnershipPacked & _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED == 0) {
uint256 nextTokenId = tokenId + 1;
// If the next slot's address is zero and not burned (i.e. packed value is zero).
if (ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] == 0) {
// If the next slot is within bounds.
if (nextTokenId != ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex) {
// Initialize the next slot to maintain correctness for `ownerOf(tokenId + 1)`.
ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] = prevOwnershipPacked;
}
}
}
}
emit Transfer(from, to, tokenId);
_afterTokenTransfers(from, to, tokenId, 1);
}
/**
* @dev Equivalent to `safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, '')`.
*/
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) public payable virtual override {
safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, '');
}
/**
* @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `from` cannot be the zero address.
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`.
* - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token
* by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
* - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement
* {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes memory _data
) public payable virtual override {
transferFrom(from, to, tokenId);
if (to.code.length != 0)
if (!_checkContractOnERC721Received(from, to, tokenId, _data)) {
revert TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer();
}
}
/**
* @dev Hook that is called before a set of serially-ordered token IDs
* are about to be transferred. This includes minting.
* And also called before burning one token.
*
* `startTokenId` - the first token ID to be transferred.
* `quantity` - the amount to be transferred.
*
* Calling conditions:
*
* - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` will be
* transferred to `to`.
* - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` will be minted for `to`.
* - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` will be burned by `from`.
* - `from` and `to` are never both zero.
*/
function _beforeTokenTransfers(
address from,
address to,
uint256 startTokenId,
uint256 quantity
) internal virtual {}
/**
* @dev Hook that is called after a set of serially-ordered token IDs
* have been transferred. This includes minting.
* And also called after one token has been burned.
*
* `startTokenId` - the first token ID to be transferred.
* `quantity` - the amount to be transferred.
*
* Calling conditions:
*
* - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` has been
* transferred to `to`.
* - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` has been minted for `to`.
* - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` has been burned by `from`.
* - `from` and `to` are never both zero.
*/
function _afterTokenTransfers(
address from,
address to,
uint256 startTokenId,
uint256 quantity
) internal virtual {}
/**
* @dev Private function to invoke {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received} on a target contract.
*
* `from` - Previous owner of the given token ID.
* `to` - Target address that will receive the token.
* `tokenId` - Token ID to be transferred.
* `_data` - Optional data to send along with the call.
*
* Returns whether the call correctly returned the expected magic value.
*/
function _checkContractOnERC721Received(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes memory _data
) private returns (bool) {
try
ERC721A__IERC721ReceiverUpgradeable(to).onERC721Received(_msgSenderERC721A(), from, tokenId, _data)
returns (bytes4 retval) {
return retval == ERC721A__IERC721ReceiverUpgradeable(to).onERC721Received.selector;
} catch (bytes memory reason) {
if (reason.length == 0) {
revert TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer();
} else {
assembly {
revert(add(32, reason), mload(reason))
}
}
}
}
// =============================================================
// MINT OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `quantity` must be greater than 0.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event for each mint.
*/
function _mint(address to, uint256 quantity) internal virtual {
uint256 startTokenId = ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex;
if (quantity == 0) revert MintZeroQuantity();
_beforeTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
// Overflows are incredibly unrealistic.
// `balance` and `numberMinted` have a maximum limit of 2**64.
// `tokenId` has a maximum limit of 2**256.
unchecked {
// Updates:
// - `balance += quantity`.
// - `numberMinted += quantity`.
//
// We can directly add to the `balance` and `numberMinted`.
ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[to] += quantity * ((1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED) | 1);
// Updates:
// - `address` to the owner.
// - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of minting.
// - `burned` to `false`.
// - `nextInitialized` to `quantity == 1`.
ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[startTokenId] = _packOwnershipData(
to,
_nextInitializedFlag(quantity) | _nextExtraData(address(0), to, 0)
);
uint256 toMasked;
uint256 end = startTokenId + quantity;
// Use assembly to loop and emit the `Transfer` event for gas savings.
// The duplicated `log4` removes an extra check and reduces stack juggling.
// The assembly, together with the surrounding Solidity code, have been
// delicately arranged to nudge the compiler into producing optimized opcodes.
assembly {
// Mask `to` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
toMasked := and(to, _BITMASK_ADDRESS)
// Emit the `Transfer` event.
log4(
0, // Start of data (0, since no data).
0, // End of data (0, since no data).
_TRANSFER_EVENT_SIGNATURE, // Signature.
0, // `address(0)`.
toMasked, // `to`.
startTokenId // `tokenId`.
)
// The `iszero(eq(,))` check ensures that large values of `quantity`
// that overflows uint256 will make the loop run out of gas.
// The compiler will optimize the `iszero` away for performance.
for {
let tokenId := add(startTokenId, 1)
} iszero(eq(tokenId, end)) {
tokenId := add(tokenId, 1)
} {
// Emit the `Transfer` event. Similar to above.
log4(0, 0, _TRANSFER_EVENT_SIGNATURE, 0, toMasked, tokenId)
}
}
if (toMasked == 0) revert MintToZeroAddress();
ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex = end;
}
_afterTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
}
/**
* @dev Mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`.
*
* This function is intended for efficient minting only during contract creation.
*
* It emits only one {ConsecutiveTransfer} as defined in
* [ERC2309](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2309),
* instead of a sequence of {Transfer} event(s).
*
* Calling this function outside of contract creation WILL make your contract
* non-compliant with the ERC721 standard.
* For full ERC721 compliance, substituting ERC721 {Transfer} event(s) with the ERC2309
* {ConsecutiveTransfer} event is only permissible during contract creation.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `quantity` must be greater than 0.
*
* Emits a {ConsecutiveTransfer} event.
*/
function _mintERC2309(address to, uint256 quantity) internal virtual {
uint256 startTokenId = ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex;
if (to == address(0)) revert MintToZeroAddress();
if (quantity == 0) revert MintZeroQuantity();
if (quantity > _MAX_MINT_ERC2309_QUANTITY_LIMIT) revert MintERC2309QuantityExceedsLimit();
_beforeTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
// Overflows are unrealistic due to the above check for `quantity` to be below the limit.
unchecked {
// Updates:
// - `balance += quantity`.
// - `numberMinted += quantity`.
//
// We can directly add to the `balance` and `numberMinted`.
ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[to] += quantity * ((1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED) | 1);
// Updates:
// - `address` to the owner.
// - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of minting.
// - `burned` to `false`.
// - `nextInitialized` to `quantity == 1`.
ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[startTokenId] = _packOwnershipData(
to,
_nextInitializedFlag(quantity) | _nextExtraData(address(0), to, 0)
);
emit ConsecutiveTransfer(startTokenId, startTokenId + quantity - 1, address(0), to);
ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex = startTokenId + quantity;
}
_afterTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
}
/**
* @dev Safely mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement
* {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called for each safe transfer.
* - `quantity` must be greater than 0.
*
* See {_mint}.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event for each mint.
*/
function _safeMint(
address to,
uint256 quantity,
bytes memory _data
) internal virtual {
_mint(to, quantity);
unchecked {
if (to.code.length != 0) {
uint256 end = ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex;
uint256 index = end - quantity;
do {
if (!_checkContractOnERC721Received(address(0), to, index++, _data)) {
revert TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer();
}
} while (index < end);
// Reentrancy protection.
if (ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex != end) revert();
}
}
}
/**
* @dev Equivalent to `_safeMint(to, quantity, '')`.
*/
function _safeMint(address to, uint256 quantity) internal virtual {
_safeMint(to, quantity, '');
}
// =============================================================
// APPROVAL OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Equivalent to `_approve(to, tokenId, false)`.
*/
function _approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) internal virtual {
_approve(to, tokenId, false);
}
/**
* @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account.
* The approval is cleared when the token is transferred.
*
* Only a single account can be approved at a time, so approving the
* zero address clears previous approvals.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*
* Emits an {Approval} event.
*/
function _approve(
address to,
uint256 tokenId,
bool approvalCheck
) internal virtual {
address owner = ownerOf(tokenId);
if (approvalCheck)
if (_msgSenderERC721A() != owner)
if (!isApprovedForAll(owner, _msgSenderERC721A())) {
revert ApprovalCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
}
ERC721AStorage.layout()._tokenApprovals[tokenId].value = to;
emit Approval(owner, to, tokenId);
}
// =============================================================
// BURN OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Equivalent to `_burn(tokenId, false)`.
*/
function _burn(uint256 tokenId) internal virtual {
_burn(tokenId, false);
}
/**
* @dev Destroys `tokenId`.
* The approval is cleared when the token is burned.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function _burn(uint256 tokenId, bool approvalCheck) internal virtual {
uint256 prevOwnershipPacked = _packedOwnershipOf(tokenId);
address from = address(uint160(prevOwnershipPacked));
(uint256 approvedAddressSlot, address approvedAddress) = _getApprovedSlotAndAddress(tokenId);
if (approvalCheck) {
// The nested ifs save around 20+ gas over a compound boolean condition.
if (!_isSenderApprovedOrOwner(approvedAddress, from, _msgSenderERC721A()))
if (!isApprovedForAll(from, _msgSenderERC721A())) revert TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
}
_beforeTokenTransfers(from, address(0), tokenId, 1);
// Clear approvals from the previous owner.
assembly {
if approvedAddress {
// This is equivalent to `delete _tokenApprovals[tokenId]`.
sstore(approvedAddressSlot, 0)
}
}
// Underflow of the sender's balance is impossible because we check for
// ownership above and the recipient's balance can't realistically overflow.
// Counter overflow is incredibly unrealistic as `tokenId` would have to be 2**256.
unchecked {
// Updates:
// - `balance -= 1`.
// - `numberBurned += 1`.
//
// We can directly decrement the balance, and increment the number burned.
// This is equivalent to `packed -= 1; packed += 1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED;`.
ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[from] += (1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED) - 1;
// Updates:
// - `address` to the last owner.
// - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of burning.
// - `burned` to `true`.
// - `nextInitialized` to `true`.
ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[tokenId] = _packOwnershipData(
from,
(_BITMASK_BURNED | _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED) | _nextExtraData(from, address(0), prevOwnershipPacked)
);
// If the next slot may not have been initialized (i.e. `nextInitialized == false`) .
if (prevOwnershipPacked & _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED == 0) {
uint256 nextTokenId = tokenId + 1;
// If the next slot's address is zero and not burned (i.e. packed value is zero).
if (ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] == 0) {
// If the next slot is within bounds.
if (nextTokenId != ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex) {
// Initialize the next slot to maintain correctness for `ownerOf(tokenId + 1)`.
ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] = prevOwnershipPacked;
}
}
}
}
emit Transfer(from, address(0), tokenId);
_afterTokenTransfers(from, address(0), tokenId, 1);
// Overflow not possible, as _burnCounter cannot be exceed _currentIndex times.
unchecked {
ERC721AStorage.layout()._burnCounter++;
}
}
// =============================================================
// EXTRA DATA OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Directly sets the extra data for the ownership data `index`.
*/
function _setExtraDataAt(uint256 index, uint24 extraData) internal virtual {
uint256 packed = ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[index];
if (packed == 0) revert OwnershipNotInitializedForExtraData();
uint256 extraDataCasted;
// Cast `extraData` with assembly to avoid redundant masking.
assembly {
extraDataCasted := extraData
}
packed = (packed & _BITMASK_EXTRA_DATA_COMPLEMENT) | (extraDataCasted << _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA);
ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[index] = packed;
}
/**
* @dev Called during each token transfer to set the 24bit `extraData` field.
* Intended to be overridden by the cosumer contract.
*
* `previousExtraData` - the value of `extraData` before transfer.
*
* Calling conditions:
*
* - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` will be
* transferred to `to`.
* - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` will be minted for `to`.
* - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` will be burned by `from`.
* - `from` and `to` are never both zero.
*/
function _extraData(
address from,
address to,
uint24 previousExtraData
) internal view virtual returns (uint24) {}
/**
* @dev Returns the next extra data for the packed ownership data.
* The returned result is shifted into position.
*/
function _nextExtraData(
address from,
address to,
uint256 prevOwnershipPacked
) private view returns (uint256) {
uint24 extraData = uint24(prevOwnershipPacked >> _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA);
return uint256(_extraData(from, to, extraData)) << _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA;
}
// =============================================================
// OTHER OPERATIONS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns the message sender (defaults to `msg.sender`).
*
* If you are writing GSN compatible contracts, you need to override this function.
*/
function _msgSenderERC721A() internal view virtual returns (address) {
return msg.sender;
}
/**
* @dev Converts a uint256 to its ASCII string decimal representation.
*/
function _toString(uint256 value) internal pure virtual returns (string memory str) {
assembly {
// The maximum value of a uint256 contains 78 digits (1 byte per digit), but
// we allocate 0xa0 bytes to keep the free memory pointer 32-byte word aligned.
// We will need 1 word for the trailing zeros padding, 1 word for the length,
// and 3 words for a maximum of 78 digits. Total: 5 * 0x20 = 0xa0.
let m := add(mload(0x40), 0xa0)
// Update the free memory pointer to allocate.
mstore(0x40, m)
// Assign the `str` to the end.
str := sub(m, 0x20)
// Zeroize the slot after the string.
mstore(str, 0)
// Cache the end of the memory to calculate the length later.
let end := str
// We write the string from rightmost digit to leftmost digit.
// The following is essentially a do-while loop that also handles the zero case.
// prettier-ignore
for { let temp := value } 1 {} {
str := sub(str, 1)
// Write the character to the pointer.
// The ASCII index of the '0' character is 48.
mstore8(str, add(48, mod(temp, 10)))
// Keep dividing `temp` until zero.
temp := div(temp, 10)
// prettier-ignore
if iszero(temp) { break }
}
let length := sub(end, str)
// Move the pointer 32 bytes leftwards to make room for the length.
str := sub(str, 0x20)
// Store the length.
mstore(str, length)
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// ERC721A Contracts v4.2.3
// Creator: Chiru Labs
pragma solidity ^0.8.4;
import './IERC721AQueryableUpgradeable.sol';
import '../ERC721AUpgradeable.sol';
import '../ERC721A__Initializable.sol';
/**
* @title ERC721AQueryable.
*
* @dev ERC721A subclass with convenience query functions.
*/
abstract contract ERC721AQueryableUpgradeable is
ERC721A__Initializable,
ERC721AUpgradeable,
IERC721AQueryableUpgradeable
{
function __ERC721AQueryable_init() internal onlyInitializingERC721A {
__ERC721AQueryable_init_unchained();
}
function __ERC721AQueryable_init_unchained() internal onlyInitializingERC721A {}
/**
* @dev Returns the `TokenOwnership` struct at `tokenId` without reverting.
*
* If the `tokenId` is out of bounds:
*
* - `addr = address(0)`
* - `startTimestamp = 0`
* - `burned = false`
* - `extraData = 0`
*
* If the `tokenId` is burned:
*
* - `addr = <Address of owner before token was burned>`
* - `startTimestamp = <Timestamp when token was burned>`
* - `burned = true`
* - `extraData = <Extra data when token was burned>`
*
* Otherwise:
*
* - `addr = <Address of owner>`
* - `startTimestamp = <Timestamp of start of ownership>`
* - `burned = false`
* - `extraData = <Extra data at start of ownership>`
*/
function explicitOwnershipOf(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (TokenOwnership memory) {
TokenOwnership memory ownership;
if (tokenId < _startTokenId() || tokenId >= _nextTokenId()) {
return ownership;
}
ownership = _ownershipAt(tokenId);
if (ownership.burned) {
return ownership;
}
return _ownershipOf(tokenId);
}
/**
* @dev Returns an array of `TokenOwnership` structs at `tokenIds` in order.
* See {ERC721AQueryable-explicitOwnershipOf}
*/
function explicitOwnershipsOf(uint256[] calldata tokenIds)
external
view
virtual
override
returns (TokenOwnership[] memory)
{
unchecked {
uint256 tokenIdsLength = tokenIds.length;
TokenOwnership[] memory ownerships = new TokenOwnership[](tokenIdsLength);
for (uint256 i; i != tokenIdsLength; ++i) {
ownerships[i] = explicitOwnershipOf(tokenIds[i]);
}
return ownerships;
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns an array of token IDs owned by `owner`,
* in the range [`start`, `stop`)
* (i.e. `start <= tokenId < stop`).
*
* This function allows for tokens to be queried if the collection
* grows too big for a single call of {ERC721AQueryable-tokensOfOwner}.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `start < stop`
*/
function tokensOfOwnerIn(
address owner,
uint256 start,
uint256 stop
) external view virtual override returns (uint256[] memory) {
unchecked {
if (start >= stop) revert InvalidQueryRange();
uint256 tokenIdsIdx;
uint256 stopLimit = _nextTokenId();
// Set `start = max(start, _startTokenId())`.
if (start < _startTokenId()) {
start = _startTokenId();
}
// Set `stop = min(stop, stopLimit)`.
if (stop > stopLimit) {
stop = stopLimit;
}
uint256 tokenIdsMaxLength = balanceOf(owner);
// Set `tokenIdsMaxLength = min(balanceOf(owner), stop - start)`,
// to cater for cases where `balanceOf(owner)` is too big.
if (start < stop) {
uint256 rangeLength = stop - start;
if (rangeLength < tokenIdsMaxLength) {
tokenIdsMaxLength = rangeLength;
}
} else {
tokenIdsMaxLength = 0;
}
uint256[] memory tokenIds = new uint256[](tokenIdsMaxLength);
if (tokenIdsMaxLength == 0) {
return tokenIds;
}
// We need to call `explicitOwnershipOf(start)`,
// because the slot at `start` may not be initialized.
TokenOwnership memory ownership = explicitOwnershipOf(start);
address currOwnershipAddr;
// If the starting slot exists (i.e. not burned), initialize `currOwnershipAddr`.
// `ownership.address` will not be zero, as `start` is clamped to the valid token ID range.
if (!ownership.burned) {
currOwnershipAddr = ownership.addr;
}
for (uint256 i = start; i != stop && tokenIdsIdx != tokenIdsMaxLength; ++i) {
ownership = _ownershipAt(i);
if (ownership.burned) {
continue;
}
if (ownership.addr != address(0)) {
currOwnershipAddr = ownership.addr;
}
if (currOwnershipAddr == owner) {
tokenIds[tokenIdsIdx++] = i;
}
}
// Downsize the array to fit.
assembly {
mstore(tokenIds, tokenIdsIdx)
}
return tokenIds;
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns an array of token IDs owned by `owner`.
*
* This function scans the ownership mapping and is O(`totalSupply`) in complexity.
* It is meant to be called off-chain.
*
* See {ERC721AQueryable-tokensOfOwnerIn} for splitting the scan into
* multiple smaller scans if the collection is large enough to cause
* an out-of-gas error (10K collections should be fine).
*/
function tokensOfOwner(address owner) external view virtual override returns (uint256[] memory) {
unchecked {
uint256 tokenIdsIdx;
address currOwnershipAddr;
uint256 tokenIdsLength = balanceOf(owner);
uint256[] memory tokenIds = new uint256[](tokenIdsLength);
TokenOwnership memory ownership;
for (uint256 i = _startTokenId(); tokenIdsIdx != tokenIdsLength; ++i) {
ownership = _ownershipAt(i);
if (ownership.burned) {
continue;
}
if (ownership.addr != address(0)) {
currOwnershipAddr = ownership.addr;
}
if (currOwnershipAddr == owner) {
tokenIds[tokenIdsIdx++] = i;
}
}
return tokenIds;
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// ERC721A Contracts v4.2.3
// Creator: Chiru Labs
pragma solidity ^0.8.4;
import '../IERC721AUpgradeable.sol';
/**
* @dev Interface of ERC721AQueryable.
*/
interface IERC721AQueryableUpgradeable is IERC721AUpgradeable {
/**
* Invalid query range (`start` >= `stop`).
*/
error InvalidQueryRange();
/**
* @dev Returns the `TokenOwnership` struct at `tokenId` without reverting.
*
* If the `tokenId` is out of bounds:
*
* - `addr = address(0)`
* - `startTimestamp = 0`
* - `burned = false`
* - `extraData = 0`
*
* If the `tokenId` is burned:
*
* - `addr = <Address of owner before token was burned>`
* - `startTimestamp = <Timestamp when token was burned>`
* - `burned = true`
* - `extraData = <Extra data when token was burned>`
*
* Otherwise:
*
* - `addr = <Address of owner>`
* - `startTimestamp = <Timestamp of start of ownership>`
* - `burned = false`
* - `extraData = <Extra data at start of ownership>`
*/
function explicitOwnershipOf(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (TokenOwnership memory);
/**
* @dev Returns an array of `TokenOwnership` structs at `tokenIds` in order.
* See {ERC721AQueryable-explicitOwnershipOf}
*/
function explicitOwnershipsOf(uint256[] memory tokenIds) external view returns (TokenOwnership[] memory);
/**
* @dev Returns an array of token IDs owned by `owner`,
* in the range [`start`, `stop`)
* (i.e. `start <= tokenId < stop`).
*
* This function allows for tokens to be queried if the collection
* grows too big for a single call of {ERC721AQueryable-tokensOfOwner}.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `start < stop`
*/
function tokensOfOwnerIn(
address owner,
uint256 start,
uint256 stop
) external view returns (uint256[] memory);
/**
* @dev Returns an array of token IDs owned by `owner`.
*
* This function scans the ownership mapping and is O(`totalSupply`) in complexity.
* It is meant to be called off-chain.
*
* See {ERC721AQueryable-tokensOfOwnerIn} for splitting the scan into
* multiple smaller scans if the collection is large enough to cause
* an out-of-gas error (10K collections should be fine).
*/
function tokensOfOwner(address owner) external view returns (uint256[] memory);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// ERC721A Contracts v4.2.3
// Creator: Chiru Labs
pragma solidity ^0.8.4;
/**
* @dev Interface of ERC721A.
*/
interface IERC721AUpgradeable {
/**
* The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
*/
error ApprovalCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
/**
* The token does not exist.
*/
error ApprovalQueryForNonexistentToken();
/**
* Cannot query the balance for the zero address.
*/
error BalanceQueryForZeroAddress();
/**
* Cannot mint to the zero address.
*/
error MintToZeroAddress();
/**
* The quantity of tokens minted must be more than zero.
*/
error MintZeroQuantity();
/**
* The token does not exist.
*/
error OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken();
/**
* The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
*/
error TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
/**
* The token must be owned by `from`.
*/
error TransferFromIncorrectOwner();
/**
* Cannot safely transfer to a contract that does not implement the
* ERC721Receiver interface.
*/
error TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer();
/**
* Cannot transfer to the zero address.
*/
error TransferToZeroAddress();
/**
* The token does not exist.
*/
error URIQueryForNonexistentToken();
/**
* The `quantity` minted with ERC2309 exceeds the safety limit.
*/
error MintERC2309QuantityExceedsLimit();
/**
* The `extraData` cannot be set on an unintialized ownership slot.
*/
error OwnershipNotInitializedForExtraData();
// =============================================================
// STRUCTS
// =============================================================
struct TokenOwnership {
// The address of the owner.
address addr;
// Stores the start time of ownership with minimal overhead for tokenomics.
uint64 startTimestamp;
// Whether the token has been burned.
bool burned;
// Arbitrary data similar to `startTimestamp` that can be set via {_extraData}.
uint24 extraData;
}
// =============================================================
// TOKEN COUNTERS
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns the total number of tokens in existence.
* Burned tokens will reduce the count.
* To get the total number of tokens minted, please see {_totalMinted}.
*/
function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256);
// =============================================================
// IERC165
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by
* `interfaceId`. See the corresponding
* [EIP section](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified)
* to learn more about how these ids are created.
*
* This function call must use less than 30000 gas.
*/
function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) external view returns (bool);
// =============================================================
// IERC721
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Emitted when `tokenId` token is transferred from `from` to `to`.
*/
event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 indexed tokenId);
/**
* @dev Emitted when `owner` enables `approved` to manage the `tokenId` token.
*/
event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed approved, uint256 indexed tokenId);
/**
* @dev Emitted when `owner` enables or disables
* (`approved`) `operator` to manage all of its assets.
*/
event ApprovalForAll(address indexed owner, address indexed operator, bool approved);
/**
* @dev Returns the number of tokens in `owner`'s account.
*/
function balanceOf(address owner) external view returns (uint256 balance);
/**
* @dev Returns the owner of the `tokenId` token.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*/
function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address owner);
/**
* @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`,
* checking first that contract recipients are aware of the ERC721 protocol
* to prevent tokens from being forever locked.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `from` cannot be the zero address.
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`.
* - If the caller is not `from`, it must be have been allowed to move
* this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
* - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement
* {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId,
bytes calldata data
) external payable;
/**
* @dev Equivalent to `safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, '')`.
*/
function safeTransferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) external payable;
/**
* @dev Transfers `tokenId` from `from` to `to`.
*
* WARNING: Usage of this method is discouraged, use {safeTransferFrom}
* whenever possible.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `from` cannot be the zero address.
* - `to` cannot be the zero address.
* - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`.
* - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token
* by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function transferFrom(
address from,
address to,
uint256 tokenId
) external payable;
/**
* @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account.
* The approval is cleared when the token is transferred.
*
* Only a single account can be approved at a time, so approving the
* zero address clears previous approvals.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*
* Emits an {Approval} event.
*/
function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) external payable;
/**
* @dev Approve or remove `operator` as an operator for the caller.
* Operators can call {transferFrom} or {safeTransferFrom}
* for any token owned by the caller.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The `operator` cannot be the caller.
*
* Emits an {ApprovalForAll} event.
*/
function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool _approved) external;
/**
* @dev Returns the account approved for `tokenId` token.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `tokenId` must exist.
*/
function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address operator);
/**
* @dev Returns if the `operator` is allowed to manage all of the assets of `owner`.
*
* See {setApprovalForAll}.
*/
function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) external view returns (bool);
// =============================================================
// IERC721Metadata
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Returns the token collection name.
*/
function name() external view returns (string memory);
/**
* @dev Returns the token collection symbol.
*/
function symbol() external view returns (string memory);
/**
* @dev Returns the Uniform Resource Identifier (URI) for `tokenId` token.
*/
function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (string memory);
// =============================================================
// IERC2309
// =============================================================
/**
* @dev Emitted when tokens in `fromTokenId` to `toTokenId`
* (inclusive) is transferred from `from` to `to`, as defined in the
* [ERC2309](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2309) standard.
*
* See {_mintERC2309} for more details.
*/
event ConsecutiveTransfer(uint256 indexed fromTokenId, uint256 toTokenId, address indexed from, address indexed to);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.13;
interface IOperatorFilterRegistry {
function isOperatorAllowed(address registrant, address operator) external view returns (bool);
function register(address registrant) external;
function registerAndSubscribe(address registrant, address subscription) external;
function registerAndCopyEntries(address registrant, address registrantToCopy) external;
function unregister(address addr) external;
function updateOperator(address registrant, address operator, bool filtered) external;
function updateOperators(address registrant, address[] calldata operators, bool filtered) external;
function updateCodeHash(address registrant, bytes32 codehash, bool filtered) external;
function updateCodeHashes(address registrant, bytes32[] calldata codeHashes, bool filtered) external;
function subscribe(address registrant, address registrantToSubscribe) external;
function unsubscribe(address registrant, bool copyExistingEntries) external;
function subscriptionOf(address addr) external returns (address registrant);
function subscribers(address registrant) external returns (address[] memory);
function subscriberAt(address registrant, uint256 index) external returns (address);
function copyEntriesOf(address registrant, address registrantToCopy) external;
function isOperatorFiltered(address registrant, address operator) external returns (bool);
function isCodeHashOfFiltered(address registrant, address operatorWithCode) external returns (bool);
function isCodeHashFiltered(address registrant, bytes32 codeHash) external returns (bool);
function filteredOperators(address addr) external returns (address[] memory);
function filteredCodeHashes(address addr) external returns (bytes32[] memory);
function filteredOperatorAt(address registrant, uint256 index) external returns (address);
function filteredCodeHashAt(address registrant, uint256 index) external returns (bytes32);
function isRegistered(address addr) external returns (bool);
function codeHashOf(address addr) external returns (bytes32);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.13;
import {IOperatorFilterRegistry} from "../IOperatorFilterRegistry.sol";
import {Initializable} from "@openzeppelin/contracts-upgradeable/proxy/utils/Initializable.sol";
abstract contract OperatorFiltererUpgradeable is Initializable {
error OperatorNotAllowed(address operator);
IOperatorFilterRegistry constant operatorFilterRegistry =
IOperatorFilterRegistry(0x000000000000AAeB6D7670E522A718067333cd4E);
function __OperatorFilterer_init(address subscriptionOrRegistrantToCopy, bool subscribe)
internal
onlyInitializing
{
// If an inheriting token contract is deployed to a network without the registry deployed, the modifier
// will not revert, but the contract will need to be registered with the registry once it is deployed in
// order for the modifier to filter addresses.
if (address(operatorFilterRegistry).code.length > 0) {
if (!operatorFilterRegistry.isRegistered(address(this))) {
if (subscribe) {
operatorFilterRegistry.registerAndSubscribe(address(this), subscriptionOrRegistrantToCopy);
} else {
if (subscriptionOrRegistrantToCopy != address(0)) {
operatorFilterRegistry.registerAndCopyEntries(address(this), subscriptionOrRegistrantToCopy);
} else {
operatorFilterRegistry.register(address(this));
}
}
}
}
}
modifier onlyAllowedOperator(address from) virtual {
// Check registry code length to facilitate testing in environments without a deployed registry.
if (address(operatorFilterRegistry).code.length > 0) {
// Allow spending tokens from addresses with balance
// Note that this still allows listings and marketplaces with escrow to transfer tokens if transferred
// from an EOA.
if (from == msg.sender) {
_;
return;
}
if (!operatorFilterRegistry.isOperatorAllowed(address(this), msg.sender)) {
revert OperatorNotAllowed(msg.sender);
}
}
_;
}
modifier onlyAllowedOperatorApproval(address operator) virtual {
// Check registry code length to facilitate testing in environments without a deployed registry.
if (address(operatorFilterRegistry).code.length > 0) {
if (!operatorFilterRegistry.isOperatorAllowed(address(this), operator)) {
revert OperatorNotAllowed(operator);
}
}
_;
}
}
File 6 of 7: OperatorFilterRegistry
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (access/Ownable.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "../utils/Context.sol";
/**
* @dev Contract module which provides a basic access control mechanism, where
* there is an account (an owner) that can be granted exclusive access to
* specific functions.
*
* By default, the owner account will be the one that deploys the contract. This
* can later be changed with {transferOwnership}.
*
* This module is used through inheritance. It will make available the modifier
* `onlyOwner`, which can be applied to your functions to restrict their use to
* the owner.
*/
abstract contract Ownable is Context {
address private _owner;
event OwnershipTransferred(address indexed previousOwner, address indexed newOwner);
/**
* @dev Initializes the contract setting the deployer as the initial owner.
*/
constructor() {
_transferOwnership(_msgSender());
}
/**
* @dev Throws if called by any account other than the owner.
*/
modifier onlyOwner() {
_checkOwner();
_;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the address of the current owner.
*/
function owner() public view virtual returns (address) {
return _owner;
}
/**
* @dev Throws if the sender is not the owner.
*/
function _checkOwner() internal view virtual {
require(owner() == _msgSender(), "Ownable: caller is not the owner");
}
/**
* @dev Leaves the contract without owner. It will not be possible to call
* `onlyOwner` functions anymore. Can only be called by the current owner.
*
* NOTE: Renouncing ownership will leave the contract without an owner,
* thereby removing any functionality that is only available to the owner.
*/
function renounceOwnership() public virtual onlyOwner {
_transferOwnership(address(0));
}
/**
* @dev Transfers ownership of the contract to a new account (`newOwner`).
* Can only be called by the current owner.
*/
function transferOwnership(address newOwner) public virtual onlyOwner {
require(newOwner != address(0), "Ownable: new owner is the zero address");
_transferOwnership(newOwner);
}
/**
* @dev Transfers ownership of the contract to a new account (`newOwner`).
* Internal function without access restriction.
*/
function _transferOwnership(address newOwner) internal virtual {
address oldOwner = _owner;
_owner = newOwner;
emit OwnershipTransferred(oldOwner, newOwner);
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/Context.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev Provides information about the current execution context, including the
* sender of the transaction and its data. While these are generally available
* via msg.sender and msg.data, they should not be accessed in such a direct
* manner, since when dealing with meta-transactions the account sending and
* paying for execution may not be the actual sender (as far as an application
* is concerned).
*
* This contract is only required for intermediate, library-like contracts.
*/
abstract contract Context {
function _msgSender() internal view virtual returns (address) {
return msg.sender;
}
function _msgData() internal view virtual returns (bytes calldata) {
return msg.data;
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (utils/structs/EnumerableSet.sol)
// This file was procedurally generated from scripts/generate/templates/EnumerableSet.js.
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev Library for managing
* https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Set_(abstract_data_type)[sets] of primitive
* types.
*
* Sets have the following properties:
*
* - Elements are added, removed, and checked for existence in constant time
* (O(1)).
* - Elements are enumerated in O(n). No guarantees are made on the ordering.
*
* ```
* contract Example {
* // Add the library methods
* using EnumerableSet for EnumerableSet.AddressSet;
*
* // Declare a set state variable
* EnumerableSet.AddressSet private mySet;
* }
* ```
*
* As of v3.3.0, sets of type `bytes32` (`Bytes32Set`), `address` (`AddressSet`)
* and `uint256` (`UintSet`) are supported.
*
* [WARNING]
* ====
* Trying to delete such a structure from storage will likely result in data corruption, rendering the structure
* unusable.
* See https://github.com/ethereum/solidity/pull/11843[ethereum/solidity#11843] for more info.
*
* In order to clean an EnumerableSet, you can either remove all elements one by one or create a fresh instance using an
* array of EnumerableSet.
* ====
*/
library EnumerableSet {
// To implement this library for multiple types with as little code
// repetition as possible, we write it in terms of a generic Set type with
// bytes32 values.
// The Set implementation uses private functions, and user-facing
// implementations (such as AddressSet) are just wrappers around the
// underlying Set.
// This means that we can only create new EnumerableSets for types that fit
// in bytes32.
struct Set {
// Storage of set values
bytes32[] _values;
// Position of the value in the `values` array, plus 1 because index 0
// means a value is not in the set.
mapping(bytes32 => uint256) _indexes;
}
/**
* @dev Add a value to a set. O(1).
*
* Returns true if the value was added to the set, that is if it was not
* already present.
*/
function _add(Set storage set, bytes32 value) private returns (bool) {
if (!_contains(set, value)) {
set._values.push(value);
// The value is stored at length-1, but we add 1 to all indexes
// and use 0 as a sentinel value
set._indexes[value] = set._values.length;
return true;
} else {
return false;
}
}
/**
* @dev Removes a value from a set. O(1).
*
* Returns true if the value was removed from the set, that is if it was
* present.
*/
function _remove(Set storage set, bytes32 value) private returns (bool) {
// We read and store the value's index to prevent multiple reads from the same storage slot
uint256 valueIndex = set._indexes[value];
if (valueIndex != 0) {
// Equivalent to contains(set, value)
// To delete an element from the _values array in O(1), we swap the element to delete with the last one in
// the array, and then remove the last element (sometimes called as 'swap and pop').
// This modifies the order of the array, as noted in {at}.
uint256 toDeleteIndex = valueIndex - 1;
uint256 lastIndex = set._values.length - 1;
if (lastIndex != toDeleteIndex) {
bytes32 lastValue = set._values[lastIndex];
// Move the last value to the index where the value to delete is
set._values[toDeleteIndex] = lastValue;
// Update the index for the moved value
set._indexes[lastValue] = valueIndex; // Replace lastValue's index to valueIndex
}
// Delete the slot where the moved value was stored
set._values.pop();
// Delete the index for the deleted slot
delete set._indexes[value];
return true;
} else {
return false;
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns true if the value is in the set. O(1).
*/
function _contains(Set storage set, bytes32 value) private view returns (bool) {
return set._indexes[value] != 0;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the number of values on the set. O(1).
*/
function _length(Set storage set) private view returns (uint256) {
return set._values.length;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the value stored at position `index` in the set. O(1).
*
* Note that there are no guarantees on the ordering of values inside the
* array, and it may change when more values are added or removed.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `index` must be strictly less than {length}.
*/
function _at(Set storage set, uint256 index) private view returns (bytes32) {
return set._values[index];
}
/**
* @dev Return the entire set in an array
*
* WARNING: This operation will copy the entire storage to memory, which can be quite expensive. This is designed
* to mostly be used by view accessors that are queried without any gas fees. Developers should keep in mind that
* this function has an unbounded cost, and using it as part of a state-changing function may render the function
* uncallable if the set grows to a point where copying to memory consumes too much gas to fit in a block.
*/
function _values(Set storage set) private view returns (bytes32[] memory) {
return set._values;
}
// Bytes32Set
struct Bytes32Set {
Set _inner;
}
/**
* @dev Add a value to a set. O(1).
*
* Returns true if the value was added to the set, that is if it was not
* already present.
*/
function add(Bytes32Set storage set, bytes32 value) internal returns (bool) {
return _add(set._inner, value);
}
/**
* @dev Removes a value from a set. O(1).
*
* Returns true if the value was removed from the set, that is if it was
* present.
*/
function remove(Bytes32Set storage set, bytes32 value) internal returns (bool) {
return _remove(set._inner, value);
}
/**
* @dev Returns true if the value is in the set. O(1).
*/
function contains(Bytes32Set storage set, bytes32 value) internal view returns (bool) {
return _contains(set._inner, value);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the number of values in the set. O(1).
*/
function length(Bytes32Set storage set) internal view returns (uint256) {
return _length(set._inner);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the value stored at position `index` in the set. O(1).
*
* Note that there are no guarantees on the ordering of values inside the
* array, and it may change when more values are added or removed.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `index` must be strictly less than {length}.
*/
function at(Bytes32Set storage set, uint256 index) internal view returns (bytes32) {
return _at(set._inner, index);
}
/**
* @dev Return the entire set in an array
*
* WARNING: This operation will copy the entire storage to memory, which can be quite expensive. This is designed
* to mostly be used by view accessors that are queried without any gas fees. Developers should keep in mind that
* this function has an unbounded cost, and using it as part of a state-changing function may render the function
* uncallable if the set grows to a point where copying to memory consumes too much gas to fit in a block.
*/
function values(Bytes32Set storage set) internal view returns (bytes32[] memory) {
bytes32[] memory store = _values(set._inner);
bytes32[] memory result;
/// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
assembly {
result := store
}
return result;
}
// AddressSet
struct AddressSet {
Set _inner;
}
/**
* @dev Add a value to a set. O(1).
*
* Returns true if the value was added to the set, that is if it was not
* already present.
*/
function add(AddressSet storage set, address value) internal returns (bool) {
return _add(set._inner, bytes32(uint256(uint160(value))));
}
/**
* @dev Removes a value from a set. O(1).
*
* Returns true if the value was removed from the set, that is if it was
* present.
*/
function remove(AddressSet storage set, address value) internal returns (bool) {
return _remove(set._inner, bytes32(uint256(uint160(value))));
}
/**
* @dev Returns true if the value is in the set. O(1).
*/
function contains(AddressSet storage set, address value) internal view returns (bool) {
return _contains(set._inner, bytes32(uint256(uint160(value))));
}
/**
* @dev Returns the number of values in the set. O(1).
*/
function length(AddressSet storage set) internal view returns (uint256) {
return _length(set._inner);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the value stored at position `index` in the set. O(1).
*
* Note that there are no guarantees on the ordering of values inside the
* array, and it may change when more values are added or removed.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `index` must be strictly less than {length}.
*/
function at(AddressSet storage set, uint256 index) internal view returns (address) {
return address(uint160(uint256(_at(set._inner, index))));
}
/**
* @dev Return the entire set in an array
*
* WARNING: This operation will copy the entire storage to memory, which can be quite expensive. This is designed
* to mostly be used by view accessors that are queried without any gas fees. Developers should keep in mind that
* this function has an unbounded cost, and using it as part of a state-changing function may render the function
* uncallable if the set grows to a point where copying to memory consumes too much gas to fit in a block.
*/
function values(AddressSet storage set) internal view returns (address[] memory) {
bytes32[] memory store = _values(set._inner);
address[] memory result;
/// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
assembly {
result := store
}
return result;
}
// UintSet
struct UintSet {
Set _inner;
}
/**
* @dev Add a value to a set. O(1).
*
* Returns true if the value was added to the set, that is if it was not
* already present.
*/
function add(UintSet storage set, uint256 value) internal returns (bool) {
return _add(set._inner, bytes32(value));
}
/**
* @dev Removes a value from a set. O(1).
*
* Returns true if the value was removed from the set, that is if it was
* present.
*/
function remove(UintSet storage set, uint256 value) internal returns (bool) {
return _remove(set._inner, bytes32(value));
}
/**
* @dev Returns true if the value is in the set. O(1).
*/
function contains(UintSet storage set, uint256 value) internal view returns (bool) {
return _contains(set._inner, bytes32(value));
}
/**
* @dev Returns the number of values in the set. O(1).
*/
function length(UintSet storage set) internal view returns (uint256) {
return _length(set._inner);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the value stored at position `index` in the set. O(1).
*
* Note that there are no guarantees on the ordering of values inside the
* array, and it may change when more values are added or removed.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `index` must be strictly less than {length}.
*/
function at(UintSet storage set, uint256 index) internal view returns (uint256) {
return uint256(_at(set._inner, index));
}
/**
* @dev Return the entire set in an array
*
* WARNING: This operation will copy the entire storage to memory, which can be quite expensive. This is designed
* to mostly be used by view accessors that are queried without any gas fees. Developers should keep in mind that
* this function has an unbounded cost, and using it as part of a state-changing function may render the function
* uncallable if the set grows to a point where copying to memory consumes too much gas to fit in a block.
*/
function values(UintSet storage set) internal view returns (uint256[] memory) {
bytes32[] memory store = _values(set._inner);
uint256[] memory result;
/// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
assembly {
result := store
}
return result;
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.13;
import {EnumerableSet} from "openzeppelin-contracts/utils/structs/EnumerableSet.sol";
interface IOperatorFilterRegistry {
function isOperatorAllowed(address registrant, address operator) external returns (bool);
function register(address registrant) external;
function registerAndSubscribe(address registrant, address subscription) external;
function registerAndCopyEntries(address registrant, address registrantToCopy) external;
function updateOperator(address registrant, address operator, bool filtered) external;
function updateOperators(address registrant, address[] calldata operators, bool filtered) external;
function updateCodeHash(address registrant, bytes32 codehash, bool filtered) external;
function updateCodeHashes(address registrant, bytes32[] calldata codeHashes, bool filtered) external;
function subscribe(address registrant, address registrantToSubscribe) external;
function unsubscribe(address registrant, bool copyExistingEntries) external;
function subscriptionOf(address addr) external returns (address registrant);
function subscribers(address registrant) external returns (address[] memory);
function subscriberAt(address registrant, uint256 index) external returns (address);
function copyEntriesOf(address registrant, address registrantToCopy) external;
function isOperatorFiltered(address registrant, address operator) external returns (bool);
function isCodeHashOfFiltered(address registrant, address operatorWithCode) external returns (bool);
function isCodeHashFiltered(address registrant, bytes32 codeHash) external returns (bool);
function filteredOperators(address addr) external returns (address[] memory);
function filteredCodeHashes(address addr) external returns (bytes32[] memory);
function filteredOperatorAt(address registrant, uint256 index) external returns (address);
function filteredCodeHashAt(address registrant, uint256 index) external returns (bytes32);
function isRegistered(address addr) external returns (bool);
function codeHashOf(address addr) external returns (bytes32);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.13;
import {IOperatorFilterRegistry} from "./IOperatorFilterRegistry.sol";
import {Ownable} from "openzeppelin-contracts/access/Ownable.sol";
import {EnumerableSet} from "openzeppelin-contracts/utils/structs/EnumerableSet.sol";
import {OperatorFilterRegistryErrorsAndEvents} from "./OperatorFilterRegistryErrorsAndEvents.sol";
/**
* @title OperatorFilterRegistry
* @notice Borrows heavily from the QQL BlacklistOperatorFilter contract:
* https://github.com/qql-art/contracts/blob/main/contracts/BlacklistOperatorFilter.sol
* @notice This contracts allows tokens or token owners to register specific addresses or codeHashes that may be
* * restricted according to the isOperatorAllowed function.
*/
contract OperatorFilterRegistry is IOperatorFilterRegistry, OperatorFilterRegistryErrorsAndEvents {
using EnumerableSet for EnumerableSet.AddressSet;
using EnumerableSet for EnumerableSet.Bytes32Set;
/// @dev initialized accounts have a nonzero codehash (see https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1052)
/// Note that this will also be a smart contract's codehash when making calls from its constructor.
bytes32 constant EOA_CODEHASH = keccak256("");
mapping(address => EnumerableSet.AddressSet) private _filteredOperators;
mapping(address => EnumerableSet.Bytes32Set) private _filteredCodeHashes;
mapping(address => address) private _registrations;
mapping(address => EnumerableSet.AddressSet) private _subscribers;
/**
* @notice restricts method caller to the address or EIP-173 "owner()"
*/
modifier onlyAddressOrOwner(address addr) {
if (msg.sender != addr) {
try Ownable(addr).owner() returns (address owner) {
if (msg.sender != owner) {
revert OnlyAddressOrOwner();
}
} catch (bytes memory reason) {
if (reason.length == 0) {
revert NotOwnable();
} else {
/// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
assembly {
revert(add(32, reason), mload(reason))
}
}
}
}
_;
}
/**
* @notice Returns true if operator is not filtered for a given token, either by address or codeHash. Also returns
* true if supplied registrant address is not registered.
*/
function isOperatorAllowed(address registrant, address operator) external view returns (bool) {
address registration = _registrations[registrant];
if (registration != address(0)) {
EnumerableSet.AddressSet storage filteredOperatorsRef;
EnumerableSet.Bytes32Set storage filteredCodeHashesRef;
filteredOperatorsRef = _filteredOperators[registration];
filteredCodeHashesRef = _filteredCodeHashes[registration];
if (filteredOperatorsRef.contains(operator)) {
revert AddressFiltered(operator);
}
if (operator.code.length > 0) {
bytes32 codeHash = operator.codehash;
if (filteredCodeHashesRef.contains(codeHash)) {
revert CodeHashFiltered(operator, codeHash);
}
}
}
return true;
}
//////////////////
// AUTH METHODS //
//////////////////
/**
* @notice Registers an address with the registry. May be called by address itself or by EIP-173 owner.
*/
function register(address registrant) external onlyAddressOrOwner(registrant) {
if (_registrations[registrant] != address(0)) {
revert AlreadyRegistered();
}
_registrations[registrant] = registrant;
emit RegistrationUpdated(registrant, true);
}
/**
* @notice Unregisters an address with the registry and removes its subscription. May be called by address itself or by EIP-173 owner.
* Note that this does not remove any filtered addresses or codeHashes.
* Also note that any subscriptions to this registrant will still be active and follow the existing filtered addresses and codehashes.
*/
function unregister(address registrant) external onlyAddressOrOwner(registrant) {
address registration = _registrations[registrant];
if (registration == address(0)) {
revert NotRegistered(registrant);
}
if (registration != registrant) {
_subscribers[registration].remove(registrant);
emit SubscriptionUpdated(registrant, registration, false);
}
_registrations[registrant] = address(0);
emit RegistrationUpdated(registrant, false);
}
/**
* @notice Registers an address with the registry and "subscribes" to another address's filtered operators and codeHashes.
*/
function registerAndSubscribe(address registrant, address subscription) external onlyAddressOrOwner(registrant) {
address registration = _registrations[registrant];
if (registration != address(0)) {
revert AlreadyRegistered();
}
if (registrant == subscription) {
revert CannotSubscribeToSelf();
}
address subscriptionRegistration = _registrations[subscription];
if (subscriptionRegistration == address(0)) {
revert NotRegistered(subscription);
}
if (subscriptionRegistration != subscription) {
revert CannotSubscribeToRegistrantWithSubscription(subscription);
}
_registrations[registrant] = subscription;
_subscribers[subscription].add(registrant);
emit RegistrationUpdated(registrant, true);
emit SubscriptionUpdated(registrant, subscription, true);
}
/**
* @notice Registers an address with the registry and copies the filtered operators and codeHashes from another
* address without subscribing.
*/
function registerAndCopyEntries(address registrant, address registrantToCopy)
external
onlyAddressOrOwner(registrant)
{
if (registrantToCopy == registrant) {
revert CannotCopyFromSelf();
}
address registration = _registrations[registrant];
if (registration != address(0)) {
revert AlreadyRegistered();
}
address registrantRegistration = _registrations[registrantToCopy];
if (registrantRegistration == address(0)) {
revert NotRegistered(registrantToCopy);
}
_registrations[registrant] = registrant;
emit RegistrationUpdated(registrant, true);
_copyEntries(registrant, registrantToCopy);
}
/**
* @notice Update an operator address for a registered address - when filtered is true, the operator is filtered.
*/
function updateOperator(address registrant, address operator, bool filtered)
external
onlyAddressOrOwner(registrant)
{
address registration = _registrations[registrant];
if (registration == address(0)) {
revert NotRegistered(registrant);
}
if (registration != registrant) {
revert CannotUpdateWhileSubscribed(registration);
}
EnumerableSet.AddressSet storage filteredOperatorsRef = _filteredOperators[registrant];
if (!filtered) {
bool removed = filteredOperatorsRef.remove(operator);
if (!removed) {
revert AddressNotFiltered(operator);
}
} else {
bool added = filteredOperatorsRef.add(operator);
if (!added) {
revert AddressAlreadyFiltered(operator);
}
}
emit OperatorUpdated(registrant, operator, filtered);
}
/**
* @notice Update a codeHash for a registered address - when filtered is true, the codeHash is filtered.
*/
function updateCodeHash(address registrant, bytes32 codeHash, bool filtered)
external
onlyAddressOrOwner(registrant)
{
if (codeHash == EOA_CODEHASH) {
revert CannotFilterEOAs();
}
address registration = _registrations[registrant];
if (registration == address(0)) {
revert NotRegistered(registrant);
}
if (registration != registrant) {
revert CannotUpdateWhileSubscribed(registration);
}
EnumerableSet.Bytes32Set storage filteredCodeHashesRef = _filteredCodeHashes[registrant];
if (!filtered) {
bool removed = filteredCodeHashesRef.remove(codeHash);
if (!removed) {
revert CodeHashNotFiltered(codeHash);
}
} else {
bool added = filteredCodeHashesRef.add(codeHash);
if (!added) {
revert CodeHashAlreadyFiltered(codeHash);
}
}
emit CodeHashUpdated(registrant, codeHash, filtered);
}
/**
* @notice Update multiple operators for a registered address - when filtered is true, the operators will be filtered. Reverts on duplicates.
*/
function updateOperators(address registrant, address[] calldata operators, bool filtered)
external
onlyAddressOrOwner(registrant)
{
address registration = _registrations[registrant];
if (registration == address(0)) {
revert NotRegistered(registrant);
}
if (registration != registrant) {
revert CannotUpdateWhileSubscribed(registration);
}
EnumerableSet.AddressSet storage filteredOperatorsRef = _filteredOperators[registrant];
uint256 operatorsLength = operators.length;
unchecked {
if (!filtered) {
for (uint256 i = 0; i < operatorsLength; ++i) {
address operator = operators[i];
bool removed = filteredOperatorsRef.remove(operator);
if (!removed) {
revert AddressNotFiltered(operator);
}
}
} else {
for (uint256 i = 0; i < operatorsLength; ++i) {
address operator = operators[i];
bool added = filteredOperatorsRef.add(operator);
if (!added) {
revert AddressAlreadyFiltered(operator);
}
}
}
}
emit OperatorsUpdated(registrant, operators, filtered);
}
/**
* @notice Update multiple codeHashes for a registered address - when filtered is true, the codeHashes will be filtered. Reverts on duplicates.
*/
function updateCodeHashes(address registrant, bytes32[] calldata codeHashes, bool filtered)
external
onlyAddressOrOwner(registrant)
{
address registration = _registrations[registrant];
if (registration == address(0)) {
revert NotRegistered(registrant);
}
if (registration != registrant) {
revert CannotUpdateWhileSubscribed(registration);
}
EnumerableSet.Bytes32Set storage filteredCodeHashesRef = _filteredCodeHashes[registrant];
uint256 codeHashesLength = codeHashes.length;
unchecked {
if (!filtered) {
for (uint256 i = 0; i < codeHashesLength; ++i) {
bytes32 codeHash = codeHashes[i];
bool removed = filteredCodeHashesRef.remove(codeHash);
if (!removed) {
revert CodeHashNotFiltered(codeHash);
}
}
} else {
for (uint256 i = 0; i < codeHashesLength; ++i) {
bytes32 codeHash = codeHashes[i];
if (codeHash == EOA_CODEHASH) {
revert CannotFilterEOAs();
}
bool added = filteredCodeHashesRef.add(codeHash);
if (!added) {
revert CodeHashAlreadyFiltered(codeHash);
}
}
}
}
emit CodeHashesUpdated(registrant, codeHashes, filtered);
}
/**
* @notice Subscribe an address to another registrant's filtered operators and codeHashes. Will remove previous
* subscription if present.
* Note that accounts with subscriptions may go on to subscribe to other accounts - in this case,
* subscriptions will not be forwarded. Instead the former subscription's existing entries will still be
* used.
*/
function subscribe(address registrant, address newSubscription) external onlyAddressOrOwner(registrant) {
if (registrant == newSubscription) {
revert CannotSubscribeToSelf();
}
if (newSubscription == address(0)) {
revert CannotSubscribeToZeroAddress();
}
address registration = _registrations[registrant];
if (registration == address(0)) {
revert NotRegistered(registrant);
}
if (registration == newSubscription) {
revert AlreadySubscribed(newSubscription);
}
address newSubscriptionRegistration = _registrations[newSubscription];
if (newSubscriptionRegistration == address(0)) {
revert NotRegistered(newSubscription);
}
if (newSubscriptionRegistration != newSubscription) {
revert CannotSubscribeToRegistrantWithSubscription(newSubscription);
}
if (registration != registrant) {
_subscribers[registration].remove(registrant);
emit SubscriptionUpdated(registrant, registration, false);
}
_registrations[registrant] = newSubscription;
_subscribers[newSubscription].add(registrant);
emit SubscriptionUpdated(registrant, newSubscription, true);
}
/**
* @notice Unsubscribe an address from its current subscribed registrant, and optionally copy its filtered operators and codeHashes.
*/
function unsubscribe(address registrant, bool copyExistingEntries) external onlyAddressOrOwner(registrant) {
address registration = _registrations[registrant];
if (registration == address(0)) {
revert NotRegistered(registrant);
}
if (registration == registrant) {
revert NotSubscribed();
}
_subscribers[registration].remove(registrant);
_registrations[registrant] = registrant;
emit SubscriptionUpdated(registrant, registration, false);
if (copyExistingEntries) {
_copyEntries(registrant, registration);
}
}
/**
* @notice Copy filtered operators and codeHashes from a different registrantToCopy to addr.
*/
function copyEntriesOf(address registrant, address registrantToCopy) external onlyAddressOrOwner(registrant) {
if (registrant == registrantToCopy) {
revert CannotCopyFromSelf();
}
address registration = _registrations[registrant];
if (registration == address(0)) {
revert NotRegistered(registrant);
}
if (registration != registrant) {
revert CannotUpdateWhileSubscribed(registration);
}
address registrantRegistration = _registrations[registrantToCopy];
if (registrantRegistration == address(0)) {
revert NotRegistered(registrantToCopy);
}
_copyEntries(registrant, registrantToCopy);
}
/// @dev helper to copy entries from registrantToCopy to registrant and emit events
function _copyEntries(address registrant, address registrantToCopy) private {
EnumerableSet.AddressSet storage filteredOperatorsRef = _filteredOperators[registrantToCopy];
EnumerableSet.Bytes32Set storage filteredCodeHashesRef = _filteredCodeHashes[registrantToCopy];
uint256 filteredOperatorsLength = filteredOperatorsRef.length();
uint256 filteredCodeHashesLength = filteredCodeHashesRef.length();
unchecked {
for (uint256 i = 0; i < filteredOperatorsLength; ++i) {
address operator = filteredOperatorsRef.at(i);
bool added = _filteredOperators[registrant].add(operator);
if (added) {
emit OperatorUpdated(registrant, operator, true);
}
}
for (uint256 i = 0; i < filteredCodeHashesLength; ++i) {
bytes32 codehash = filteredCodeHashesRef.at(i);
bool added = _filteredCodeHashes[registrant].add(codehash);
if (added) {
emit CodeHashUpdated(registrant, codehash, true);
}
}
}
}
//////////////////
// VIEW METHODS //
//////////////////
/**
* @notice Get the subscription address of a given registrant, if any.
*/
function subscriptionOf(address registrant) external view returns (address subscription) {
subscription = _registrations[registrant];
if (subscription == address(0)) {
revert NotRegistered(registrant);
} else if (subscription == registrant) {
subscription = address(0);
}
}
/**
* @notice Get the set of addresses subscribed to a given registrant.
* Note that order is not guaranteed as updates are made.
*/
function subscribers(address registrant) external view returns (address[] memory) {
return _subscribers[registrant].values();
}
/**
* @notice Get the subscriber at a given index in the set of addresses subscribed to a given registrant.
* Note that order is not guaranteed as updates are made.
*/
function subscriberAt(address registrant, uint256 index) external view returns (address) {
return _subscribers[registrant].at(index);
}
/**
* @notice Returns true if operator is filtered by a given address or its subscription.
*/
function isOperatorFiltered(address registrant, address operator) external view returns (bool) {
address registration = _registrations[registrant];
if (registration != registrant) {
return _filteredOperators[registration].contains(operator);
}
return _filteredOperators[registrant].contains(operator);
}
/**
* @notice Returns true if a codeHash is filtered by a given address or its subscription.
*/
function isCodeHashFiltered(address registrant, bytes32 codeHash) external view returns (bool) {
address registration = _registrations[registrant];
if (registration != registrant) {
return _filteredCodeHashes[registration].contains(codeHash);
}
return _filteredCodeHashes[registrant].contains(codeHash);
}
/**
* @notice Returns true if the hash of an address's code is filtered by a given address or its subscription.
*/
function isCodeHashOfFiltered(address registrant, address operatorWithCode) external view returns (bool) {
bytes32 codeHash = operatorWithCode.codehash;
address registration = _registrations[registrant];
if (registration != registrant) {
return _filteredCodeHashes[registration].contains(codeHash);
}
return _filteredCodeHashes[registrant].contains(codeHash);
}
/**
* @notice Returns true if an address has registered
*/
function isRegistered(address registrant) external view returns (bool) {
return _registrations[registrant] != address(0);
}
/**
* @notice Returns a list of filtered operators for a given address or its subscription.
*/
function filteredOperators(address registrant) external view returns (address[] memory) {
address registration = _registrations[registrant];
if (registration != registrant) {
return _filteredOperators[registration].values();
}
return _filteredOperators[registrant].values();
}
/**
* @notice Returns the set of filtered codeHashes for a given address or its subscription.
* Note that order is not guaranteed as updates are made.
*/
function filteredCodeHashes(address registrant) external view returns (bytes32[] memory) {
address registration = _registrations[registrant];
if (registration != registrant) {
return _filteredCodeHashes[registration].values();
}
return _filteredCodeHashes[registrant].values();
}
/**
* @notice Returns the filtered operator at the given index of the set of filtered operators for a given address or
* its subscription.
* Note that order is not guaranteed as updates are made.
*/
function filteredOperatorAt(address registrant, uint256 index) external view returns (address) {
address registration = _registrations[registrant];
if (registration != registrant) {
return _filteredOperators[registration].at(index);
}
return _filteredOperators[registrant].at(index);
}
/**
* @notice Returns the filtered codeHash at the given index of the list of filtered codeHashes for a given address or
* its subscription.
* Note that order is not guaranteed as updates are made.
*/
function filteredCodeHashAt(address registrant, uint256 index) external view returns (bytes32) {
address registration = _registrations[registrant];
if (registration != registrant) {
return _filteredCodeHashes[registration].at(index);
}
return _filteredCodeHashes[registrant].at(index);
}
/// @dev Convenience method to compute the code hash of an arbitrary contract
function codeHashOf(address a) external view returns (bytes32) {
return a.codehash;
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.13;
contract OperatorFilterRegistryErrorsAndEvents {
error CannotFilterEOAs();
error AddressAlreadyFiltered(address operator);
error AddressNotFiltered(address operator);
error CodeHashAlreadyFiltered(bytes32 codeHash);
error CodeHashNotFiltered(bytes32 codeHash);
error OnlyAddressOrOwner();
error NotRegistered(address registrant);
error AlreadyRegistered();
error AlreadySubscribed(address subscription);
error NotSubscribed();
error CannotUpdateWhileSubscribed(address subscription);
error CannotSubscribeToSelf();
error CannotSubscribeToZeroAddress();
error NotOwnable();
error AddressFiltered(address filtered);
error CodeHashFiltered(address account, bytes32 codeHash);
error CannotSubscribeToRegistrantWithSubscription(address registrant);
error CannotCopyFromSelf();
event RegistrationUpdated(address indexed registrant, bool indexed registered);
event OperatorUpdated(address indexed registrant, address indexed operator, bool indexed filtered);
event OperatorsUpdated(address indexed registrant, address[] operators, bool indexed filtered);
event CodeHashUpdated(address indexed registrant, bytes32 indexed codeHash, bool indexed filtered);
event CodeHashesUpdated(address indexed registrant, bytes32[] codeHashes, bool indexed filtered);
event SubscriptionUpdated(address indexed registrant, address indexed subscription, bool indexed subscribed);
}
File 7 of 7: FeeManagement
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import './TokenSplitter.sol';
import './FeeSharingSetter.sol';
import './IWETH.sol';
import '@openzeppelin/contracts/access/AccessControl.sol';
import '@openzeppelin/contracts/access/Ownable.sol';
import '@openzeppelin/contracts/security/Pausable.sol';
import '@openzeppelin/contracts/security/ReentrancyGuard.sol';
import '@openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC20/utils/SafeERC20.sol';
import '@openzeppelin/contracts/utils/Address.sol';
contract FeeManagement is AccessControl, Pausable, ReentrancyGuard {
using SafeERC20 for IERC20;
using SafeERC20 for IWETH;
bytes32 public constant OPERATOR_ROLE = keccak256('OPERATOR_ROLE');
TokenSplitter public immutable tokenSplitter;
FeeSharingSetter public immutable feeSetter;
IWETH public immutable weth;
constructor(
TokenSplitter tokenSplitter_,
FeeSharingSetter feeSetter_,
IWETH weth_,
address operator_,
address admin_
) {
tokenSplitter = tokenSplitter_;
feeSetter = feeSetter_;
weth = weth_;
if (admin_ == address(0)) {
admin_ = msg.sender;
}
_grantRole(DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE, admin_);
_grantRole(OPERATOR_ROLE, admin_);
if (operator_ != address(0)) {
_grantRole(OPERATOR_ROLE, operator_);
}
}
receive() external payable {}
function pause() external onlyRole(DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE) {
_pause();
}
function unpause() external onlyRole(DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE) {
_unpause();
}
// withdraw tokens
function withdraw(address to, IERC20[] calldata tokens)
external
nonReentrant
whenNotPaused
onlyRole(DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE)
{
require(to != address(0), 'Withdraw: address(0) cannot be recipient');
for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; i++) {
IERC20 currency = tokens[i];
if (address(currency) == address(0)) {
uint256 balance = address(this).balance;
if (balance > 0) {
Address.sendValue(payable(to), balance);
}
} else {
uint256 balance = currency.balanceOf(address(this));
if (balance > 0) {
currency.safeTransfer(to, balance);
}
}
}
}
function canRelease() external view returns (bool) {
return
block.number >
feeSetter.rewardDurationInBlocks() + feeSetter.lastRewardDistributionBlock();
}
function releaseAndUpdateReward(IERC20[] memory tokens, address[] memory accounts)
external
nonReentrant
whenNotPaused
onlyRole(OPERATOR_ROLE)
{
_release(tokens);
// release x2y2 to pools, skipped when the balance is less than 1 token (the release can be called by anyone)
if (tokenSplitter.x2y2Token().balanceOf(address(tokenSplitter)) >= 1 ether) {
for (uint256 i = 0; i < accounts.length; i++) {
tokenSplitter.releaseTokens(accounts[i]);
}
}
feeSetter.updateRewards();
}
function release(IERC20[] memory tokens)
external
nonReentrant
whenNotPaused
onlyRole(OPERATOR_ROLE)
{
_release(tokens);
}
function _release(IERC20[] memory tokens) internal {
uint256 balance = address(this).balance;
if (balance > 0) {
weth.deposit{value: balance}();
}
balance = weth.balanceOf(address(this));
if (balance > 0) {
weth.safeTransfer(address(feeSetter), balance);
}
for (uint256 i = 0; i < tokens.length; i++) {
IERC20 currency = tokens[i];
balance = currency.balanceOf(address(this));
if (balance > 0) {
currency.safeTransfer(address(feeSetter), balance);
}
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import {Ownable} from '@openzeppelin/contracts/access/Ownable.sol';
import {ReentrancyGuard} from '@openzeppelin/contracts/security/ReentrancyGuard.sol';
import {IERC20, SafeERC20} from '@openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC20/utils/SafeERC20.sol';
/**
* @title TokenSplitter
* @notice It splits X2Y2 to team/treasury/trading volume reward accounts based on shares.
*/
contract TokenSplitter is Ownable, ReentrancyGuard {
using SafeERC20 for IERC20;
struct AccountInfo {
uint256 shares;
uint256 tokensDistributedToAccount;
}
uint256 public immutable TOTAL_SHARES;
IERC20 public immutable x2y2Token;
// Total tokens distributed across all accounts
uint256 public totalTokensDistributed;
mapping(address => AccountInfo) public accountInfo;
event NewSharesOwner(address indexed oldRecipient, address indexed newRecipient);
event TokensTransferred(address indexed account, uint256 amount);
/**
* @notice Constructor
* @param _accounts array of accounts addresses
* @param _shares array of shares per account
* @param _x2y2Token address of the X2Y2 token
*/
constructor(
address[] memory _accounts,
uint256[] memory _shares,
address _x2y2Token
) {
require(_accounts.length == _shares.length, 'Splitter: Length differ');
require(_accounts.length > 0, 'Splitter: Length must be > 0');
uint256 currentShares;
for (uint256 i = 0; i < _accounts.length; i++) {
require(_shares[i] > 0, 'Splitter: Shares are 0');
currentShares += _shares[i];
accountInfo[_accounts[i]].shares = _shares[i];
}
TOTAL_SHARES = currentShares;
x2y2Token = IERC20(_x2y2Token);
}
/**
* @notice Release X2Y2 tokens to the account
* @param account address of the account
*/
function releaseTokens(address account) external nonReentrant {
require(accountInfo[account].shares > 0, 'Splitter: Account has no share');
// Calculate amount to transfer to the account
uint256 totalTokensReceived = x2y2Token.balanceOf(address(this)) + totalTokensDistributed;
uint256 pendingRewards = ((totalTokensReceived * accountInfo[account].shares) /
TOTAL_SHARES) - accountInfo[account].tokensDistributedToAccount;
// Revert if equal to 0
require(pendingRewards != 0, 'Splitter: Nothing to transfer');
accountInfo[account].tokensDistributedToAccount += pendingRewards;
totalTokensDistributed += pendingRewards;
// Transfer funds to account
x2y2Token.safeTransfer(account, pendingRewards);
emit TokensTransferred(account, pendingRewards);
}
/**
* @notice Update share recipient
* @param _newRecipient address of the new recipient
* @param _currentRecipient address of the current recipient
*/
function updateSharesOwner(address _newRecipient, address _currentRecipient)
external
onlyOwner
{
require(
accountInfo[_currentRecipient].shares > 0,
'Owner: Current recipient has no shares'
);
require(accountInfo[_newRecipient].shares == 0, 'Owner: New recipient has existing shares');
// Copy shares to new recipient
accountInfo[_newRecipient].shares = accountInfo[_currentRecipient].shares;
accountInfo[_newRecipient].tokensDistributedToAccount = accountInfo[_currentRecipient]
.tokensDistributedToAccount;
// Reset existing shares
accountInfo[_currentRecipient].shares = 0;
accountInfo[_currentRecipient].tokensDistributedToAccount = 0;
emit NewSharesOwner(_currentRecipient, _newRecipient);
}
/**
* @notice Retrieve amount of X2Y2 tokens that can be transferred
* @param account address of the account
*/
function calculatePendingRewards(address account) external view returns (uint256) {
if (accountInfo[account].shares == 0) {
return 0;
}
uint256 totalTokensReceived = x2y2Token.balanceOf(address(this)) + totalTokensDistributed;
uint256 pendingRewards = ((totalTokensReceived * accountInfo[account].shares) /
TOTAL_SHARES) - accountInfo[account].tokensDistributedToAccount;
return pendingRewards;
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import {AccessControl} from '@openzeppelin/contracts/access/AccessControl.sol';
import {ReentrancyGuard} from '@openzeppelin/contracts/security/ReentrancyGuard.sol';
import {IERC20, SafeERC20} from '@openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC20/utils/SafeERC20.sol';
import {EnumerableSet} from '@openzeppelin/contracts/utils/structs/EnumerableSet.sol';
import {FeeSharingSystem} from './FeeSharingSystem.sol';
import {TokenDistributor} from './TokenDistributor.sol';
import {IRewardConvertor} from './IRewardConvertor.sol';
import {IMintableERC20} from './IMintableERC20.sol';
import {ITokenStaked} from './ITokenStaked.sol';
/**
* @title FeeSharingSetter
* @notice It receives exchange fees and owns the FeeSharingSystem contract.
* It can plug to AMMs for converting all received currencies to WETH.
*/
contract FeeSharingSetter is ReentrancyGuard, AccessControl {
using EnumerableSet for EnumerableSet.AddressSet;
using SafeERC20 for IERC20;
// Operator role
bytes32 public constant OPERATOR_ROLE = keccak256('OPERATOR_ROLE');
// Min duration for each fee-sharing period (in blocks)
uint256 public immutable MIN_REWARD_DURATION_IN_BLOCKS;
// Max duration for each fee-sharing period (in blocks)
uint256 public immutable MAX_REWARD_DURATION_IN_BLOCKS;
IERC20 public immutable x2y2Token;
IERC20 public immutable rewardToken;
FeeSharingSystem public feeSharingSystem;
TokenDistributor public immutable tokenDistributor;
// Reward convertor (tool to convert other currencies to rewardToken)
IRewardConvertor public rewardConvertor;
// Last reward block of distribution
uint256 public lastRewardDistributionBlock;
// Next reward duration in blocks
uint256 public nextRewardDurationInBlocks;
// Reward duration in blocks
uint256 public rewardDurationInBlocks;
// Set of addresses that are staking only the fee sharing
EnumerableSet.AddressSet private _feeStakingAddresses;
mapping(address => bool) public feeStakingAddressIStaked;
event ConversionToRewardToken(
address indexed token,
uint256 amountConverted,
uint256 amountReceived
);
event FeeStakingAddressesAdded(address[] feeStakingAddresses);
event FeeStakingAddressesRemoved(address[] feeStakingAddresses);
event NewRewardDurationInBlocks(uint256 rewardDurationInBlocks);
event NewRewardConvertor(address rewardConvertor);
/**
* @notice Constructor
* @param _feeSharingSystem address of the fee sharing system
* @param _minRewardDurationInBlocks minimum reward duration in blocks
* @param _maxRewardDurationInBlocks maximum reward duration in blocks
* @param _rewardDurationInBlocks reward duration between two updates in blocks
*/
constructor(
address _feeSharingSystem,
uint256 _minRewardDurationInBlocks,
uint256 _maxRewardDurationInBlocks,
uint256 _rewardDurationInBlocks
) {
require(
(_rewardDurationInBlocks <= _maxRewardDurationInBlocks) &&
(_rewardDurationInBlocks >= _minRewardDurationInBlocks),
'Owner: Reward duration in blocks outside of range'
);
MIN_REWARD_DURATION_IN_BLOCKS = _minRewardDurationInBlocks;
MAX_REWARD_DURATION_IN_BLOCKS = _maxRewardDurationInBlocks;
feeSharingSystem = FeeSharingSystem(_feeSharingSystem);
rewardToken = feeSharingSystem.rewardToken();
x2y2Token = feeSharingSystem.x2y2Token();
tokenDistributor = feeSharingSystem.tokenDistributor();
rewardDurationInBlocks = _rewardDurationInBlocks;
nextRewardDurationInBlocks = _rewardDurationInBlocks;
_setupRole(DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE, msg.sender);
}
/**
* @notice Update the reward per block (in rewardToken)
* @dev It automatically retrieves the number of pending WETH and adjusts
* based on the balance of X2Y2 in fee-staking addresses that exist in the set.
*/
function updateRewards() external onlyRole(OPERATOR_ROLE) {
if (lastRewardDistributionBlock > 0) {
require(
block.number > (rewardDurationInBlocks + lastRewardDistributionBlock),
'Reward: Too early to add'
);
}
// Adjust for this period
if (rewardDurationInBlocks != nextRewardDurationInBlocks) {
rewardDurationInBlocks = nextRewardDurationInBlocks;
}
lastRewardDistributionBlock = block.number;
// Calculate the reward to distribute as the balance held by this address
uint256 reward = rewardToken.balanceOf(address(this));
require(reward != 0, 'Reward: Nothing to distribute');
// Check if there is any address eligible for fee-sharing only
uint256 numberAddressesForFeeStaking = _feeStakingAddresses.length();
// If there are eligible addresses for fee-sharing only, calculate their shares
if (numberAddressesForFeeStaking > 0) {
uint256[] memory x2y2Balances = new uint256[](numberAddressesForFeeStaking);
(uint256 totalAmountStaked, ) = tokenDistributor.userInfo(address(feeSharingSystem));
for (uint256 i = 0; i < numberAddressesForFeeStaking; i++) {
address a = _feeStakingAddresses.at(i);
uint256 balance = x2y2Token.balanceOf(a);
if (feeStakingAddressIStaked[a]) {
balance = ITokenStaked(a).getTotalStaked();
}
totalAmountStaked += balance;
x2y2Balances[i] = balance;
}
// Only apply the logic if the totalAmountStaked > 0 (to prevent division by 0)
if (totalAmountStaked > 0) {
uint256 adjustedReward = reward;
for (uint256 i = 0; i < numberAddressesForFeeStaking; i++) {
uint256 amountToTransfer = (x2y2Balances[i] * reward) / totalAmountStaked;
if (amountToTransfer > 0) {
adjustedReward -= amountToTransfer;
rewardToken.safeTransfer(_feeStakingAddresses.at(i), amountToTransfer);
}
}
// Adjust reward accordingly
reward = adjustedReward;
}
}
// Transfer tokens to fee sharing system
rewardToken.safeTransfer(address(feeSharingSystem), reward);
// Update rewards
feeSharingSystem.updateRewards(reward, rewardDurationInBlocks);
}
/**
* @notice Convert currencies to reward token
* @dev Function only usable only for whitelisted currencies (where no potential side effect)
* @param token address of the token to sell
* @param additionalData additional data (e.g., slippage)
*/
function convertCurrencyToRewardToken(address token, bytes calldata additionalData)
external
nonReentrant
onlyRole(OPERATOR_ROLE)
{
require(address(rewardConvertor) != address(0), 'Convert: RewardConvertor not set');
require(token != address(rewardToken), 'Convert: Cannot be reward token');
uint256 amountToConvert = IERC20(token).balanceOf(address(this));
require(amountToConvert != 0, 'Convert: Amount to convert must be > 0');
// Adjust allowance for this transaction only
IERC20(token).safeIncreaseAllowance(address(rewardConvertor), amountToConvert);
// Exchange token to reward token
uint256 amountReceived = rewardConvertor.convert(
token,
address(rewardToken),
amountToConvert,
additionalData
);
emit ConversionToRewardToken(token, amountToConvert, amountReceived);
}
/**
* @notice Add staking addresses
* @param _stakingAddresses array of addresses eligible for fee-sharing only
*/
function addFeeStakingAddresses(
address[] calldata _stakingAddresses,
bool[] calldata _addressIStaked
) external onlyRole(DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE) {
require(_stakingAddresses.length == _addressIStaked.length, 'Owner: param length error');
for (uint256 i = 0; i < _stakingAddresses.length; i++) {
require(
!_feeStakingAddresses.contains(_stakingAddresses[i]),
'Owner: Address already registered'
);
_feeStakingAddresses.add(_stakingAddresses[i]);
if (_addressIStaked[i]) {
feeStakingAddressIStaked[_stakingAddresses[i]] = true;
}
}
emit FeeStakingAddressesAdded(_stakingAddresses);
}
/**
* @notice Remove staking addresses
* @param _stakingAddresses array of addresses eligible for fee-sharing only
*/
function removeFeeStakingAddresses(address[] calldata _stakingAddresses)
external
onlyRole(DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE)
{
for (uint256 i = 0; i < _stakingAddresses.length; i++) {
require(
_feeStakingAddresses.contains(_stakingAddresses[i]),
'Owner: Address not registered'
);
_feeStakingAddresses.remove(_stakingAddresses[i]);
if (feeStakingAddressIStaked[_stakingAddresses[i]]) {
delete feeStakingAddressIStaked[_stakingAddresses[i]];
}
}
emit FeeStakingAddressesRemoved(_stakingAddresses);
}
/**
* @notice Set new reward duration in blocks for next update
* @param _newRewardDurationInBlocks number of blocks for new reward period
*/
function setNewRewardDurationInBlocks(uint256 _newRewardDurationInBlocks)
external
onlyRole(DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE)
{
require(
(_newRewardDurationInBlocks <= MAX_REWARD_DURATION_IN_BLOCKS) &&
(_newRewardDurationInBlocks >= MIN_REWARD_DURATION_IN_BLOCKS),
'Owner: New reward duration in blocks outside of range'
);
nextRewardDurationInBlocks = _newRewardDurationInBlocks;
emit NewRewardDurationInBlocks(_newRewardDurationInBlocks);
}
/**
* @notice Set reward convertor contract
* @param _rewardConvertor address of the reward convertor (set to null to deactivate)
*/
function setRewardConvertor(address _rewardConvertor) external onlyRole(DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE) {
rewardConvertor = IRewardConvertor(_rewardConvertor);
emit NewRewardConvertor(_rewardConvertor);
}
/**
* @notice See addresses eligible for fee-staking
*/
function viewFeeStakingAddresses() external view returns (address[] memory) {
uint256 length = _feeStakingAddresses.length();
address[] memory feeStakingAddresses = new address[](length);
for (uint256 i = 0; i < length; i++) {
feeStakingAddresses[i] = _feeStakingAddresses.at(i);
}
return (feeStakingAddresses);
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: Unlicensed
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
pragma abicoder v2;
import '@openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC20/IERC20.sol';
interface IWETH is IERC20 {
function deposit() external payable;
function withdraw(uint256 wad) external;
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (access/AccessControl.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "./IAccessControl.sol";
import "../utils/Context.sol";
import "../utils/Strings.sol";
import "../utils/introspection/ERC165.sol";
/**
* @dev Contract module that allows children to implement role-based access
* control mechanisms. This is a lightweight version that doesn't allow enumerating role
* members except through off-chain means by accessing the contract event logs. Some
* applications may benefit from on-chain enumerability, for those cases see
* {AccessControlEnumerable}.
*
* Roles are referred to by their `bytes32` identifier. These should be exposed
* in the external API and be unique. The best way to achieve this is by
* using `public constant` hash digests:
*
* ```
* bytes32 public constant MY_ROLE = keccak256("MY_ROLE");
* ```
*
* Roles can be used to represent a set of permissions. To restrict access to a
* function call, use {hasRole}:
*
* ```
* function foo() public {
* require(hasRole(MY_ROLE, msg.sender));
* ...
* }
* ```
*
* Roles can be granted and revoked dynamically via the {grantRole} and
* {revokeRole} functions. Each role has an associated admin role, and only
* accounts that have a role's admin role can call {grantRole} and {revokeRole}.
*
* By default, the admin role for all roles is `DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE`, which means
* that only accounts with this role will be able to grant or revoke other
* roles. More complex role relationships can be created by using
* {_setRoleAdmin}.
*
* WARNING: The `DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE` is also its own admin: it has permission to
* grant and revoke this role. Extra precautions should be taken to secure
* accounts that have been granted it.
*/
abstract contract AccessControl is Context, IAccessControl, ERC165 {
struct RoleData {
mapping(address => bool) members;
bytes32 adminRole;
}
mapping(bytes32 => RoleData) private _roles;
bytes32 public constant DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE = 0x00;
/**
* @dev Modifier that checks that an account has a specific role. Reverts
* with a standardized message including the required role.
*
* The format of the revert reason is given by the following regular expression:
*
* /^AccessControl: account (0x[0-9a-f]{40}) is missing role (0x[0-9a-f]{64})$/
*
* _Available since v4.1._
*/
modifier onlyRole(bytes32 role) {
_checkRole(role, _msgSender());
_;
}
/**
* @dev See {IERC165-supportsInterface}.
*/
function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
return interfaceId == type(IAccessControl).interfaceId || super.supportsInterface(interfaceId);
}
/**
* @dev Returns `true` if `account` has been granted `role`.
*/
function hasRole(bytes32 role, address account) public view override returns (bool) {
return _roles[role].members[account];
}
/**
* @dev Revert with a standard message if `account` is missing `role`.
*
* The format of the revert reason is given by the following regular expression:
*
* /^AccessControl: account (0x[0-9a-f]{40}) is missing role (0x[0-9a-f]{64})$/
*/
function _checkRole(bytes32 role, address account) internal view {
if (!hasRole(role, account)) {
revert(
string(
abi.encodePacked(
"AccessControl: account ",
Strings.toHexString(uint160(account), 20),
" is missing role ",
Strings.toHexString(uint256(role), 32)
)
)
);
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns the admin role that controls `role`. See {grantRole} and
* {revokeRole}.
*
* To change a role's admin, use {_setRoleAdmin}.
*/
function getRoleAdmin(bytes32 role) public view override returns (bytes32) {
return _roles[role].adminRole;
}
/**
* @dev Grants `role` to `account`.
*
* If `account` had not been already granted `role`, emits a {RoleGranted}
* event.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - the caller must have ``role``'s admin role.
*/
function grantRole(bytes32 role, address account) public virtual override onlyRole(getRoleAdmin(role)) {
_grantRole(role, account);
}
/**
* @dev Revokes `role` from `account`.
*
* If `account` had been granted `role`, emits a {RoleRevoked} event.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - the caller must have ``role``'s admin role.
*/
function revokeRole(bytes32 role, address account) public virtual override onlyRole(getRoleAdmin(role)) {
_revokeRole(role, account);
}
/**
* @dev Revokes `role` from the calling account.
*
* Roles are often managed via {grantRole} and {revokeRole}: this function's
* purpose is to provide a mechanism for accounts to lose their privileges
* if they are compromised (such as when a trusted device is misplaced).
*
* If the calling account had been revoked `role`, emits a {RoleRevoked}
* event.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - the caller must be `account`.
*/
function renounceRole(bytes32 role, address account) public virtual override {
require(account == _msgSender(), "AccessControl: can only renounce roles for self");
_revokeRole(role, account);
}
/**
* @dev Grants `role` to `account`.
*
* If `account` had not been already granted `role`, emits a {RoleGranted}
* event. Note that unlike {grantRole}, this function doesn't perform any
* checks on the calling account.
*
* [WARNING]
* ====
* This function should only be called from the constructor when setting
* up the initial roles for the system.
*
* Using this function in any other way is effectively circumventing the admin
* system imposed by {AccessControl}.
* ====
*
* NOTE: This function is deprecated in favor of {_grantRole}.
*/
function _setupRole(bytes32 role, address account) internal virtual {
_grantRole(role, account);
}
/**
* @dev Sets `adminRole` as ``role``'s admin role.
*
* Emits a {RoleAdminChanged} event.
*/
function _setRoleAdmin(bytes32 role, bytes32 adminRole) internal virtual {
bytes32 previousAdminRole = getRoleAdmin(role);
_roles[role].adminRole = adminRole;
emit RoleAdminChanged(role, previousAdminRole, adminRole);
}
/**
* @dev Grants `role` to `account`.
*
* Internal function without access restriction.
*/
function _grantRole(bytes32 role, address account) internal virtual {
if (!hasRole(role, account)) {
_roles[role].members[account] = true;
emit RoleGranted(role, account, _msgSender());
}
}
/**
* @dev Revokes `role` from `account`.
*
* Internal function without access restriction.
*/
function _revokeRole(bytes32 role, address account) internal virtual {
if (hasRole(role, account)) {
_roles[role].members[account] = false;
emit RoleRevoked(role, account, _msgSender());
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (access/Ownable.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "../utils/Context.sol";
/**
* @dev Contract module which provides a basic access control mechanism, where
* there is an account (an owner) that can be granted exclusive access to
* specific functions.
*
* By default, the owner account will be the one that deploys the contract. This
* can later be changed with {transferOwnership}.
*
* This module is used through inheritance. It will make available the modifier
* `onlyOwner`, which can be applied to your functions to restrict their use to
* the owner.
*/
abstract contract Ownable is Context {
address private _owner;
event OwnershipTransferred(address indexed previousOwner, address indexed newOwner);
/**
* @dev Initializes the contract setting the deployer as the initial owner.
*/
constructor() {
_transferOwnership(_msgSender());
}
/**
* @dev Returns the address of the current owner.
*/
function owner() public view virtual returns (address) {
return _owner;
}
/**
* @dev Throws if called by any account other than the owner.
*/
modifier onlyOwner() {
require(owner() == _msgSender(), "Ownable: caller is not the owner");
_;
}
/**
* @dev Leaves the contract without owner. It will not be possible to call
* `onlyOwner` functions anymore. Can only be called by the current owner.
*
* NOTE: Renouncing ownership will leave the contract without an owner,
* thereby removing any functionality that is only available to the owner.
*/
function renounceOwnership() public virtual onlyOwner {
_transferOwnership(address(0));
}
/**
* @dev Transfers ownership of the contract to a new account (`newOwner`).
* Can only be called by the current owner.
*/
function transferOwnership(address newOwner) public virtual onlyOwner {
require(newOwner != address(0), "Ownable: new owner is the zero address");
_transferOwnership(newOwner);
}
/**
* @dev Transfers ownership of the contract to a new account (`newOwner`).
* Internal function without access restriction.
*/
function _transferOwnership(address newOwner) internal virtual {
address oldOwner = _owner;
_owner = newOwner;
emit OwnershipTransferred(oldOwner, newOwner);
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (security/Pausable.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "../utils/Context.sol";
/**
* @dev Contract module which allows children to implement an emergency stop
* mechanism that can be triggered by an authorized account.
*
* This module is used through inheritance. It will make available the
* modifiers `whenNotPaused` and `whenPaused`, which can be applied to
* the functions of your contract. Note that they will not be pausable by
* simply including this module, only once the modifiers are put in place.
*/
abstract contract Pausable is Context {
/**
* @dev Emitted when the pause is triggered by `account`.
*/
event Paused(address account);
/**
* @dev Emitted when the pause is lifted by `account`.
*/
event Unpaused(address account);
bool private _paused;
/**
* @dev Initializes the contract in unpaused state.
*/
constructor() {
_paused = false;
}
/**
* @dev Returns true if the contract is paused, and false otherwise.
*/
function paused() public view virtual returns (bool) {
return _paused;
}
/**
* @dev Modifier to make a function callable only when the contract is not paused.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The contract must not be paused.
*/
modifier whenNotPaused() {
require(!paused(), "Pausable: paused");
_;
}
/**
* @dev Modifier to make a function callable only when the contract is paused.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The contract must be paused.
*/
modifier whenPaused() {
require(paused(), "Pausable: not paused");
_;
}
/**
* @dev Triggers stopped state.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The contract must not be paused.
*/
function _pause() internal virtual whenNotPaused {
_paused = true;
emit Paused(_msgSender());
}
/**
* @dev Returns to normal state.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - The contract must be paused.
*/
function _unpause() internal virtual whenPaused {
_paused = false;
emit Unpaused(_msgSender());
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (security/ReentrancyGuard.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev Contract module that helps prevent reentrant calls to a function.
*
* Inheriting from `ReentrancyGuard` will make the {nonReentrant} modifier
* available, which can be applied to functions to make sure there are no nested
* (reentrant) calls to them.
*
* Note that because there is a single `nonReentrant` guard, functions marked as
* `nonReentrant` may not call one another. This can be worked around by making
* those functions `private`, and then adding `external` `nonReentrant` entry
* points to them.
*
* TIP: If you would like to learn more about reentrancy and alternative ways
* to protect against it, check out our blog post
* https://blog.openzeppelin.com/reentrancy-after-istanbul/[Reentrancy After Istanbul].
*/
abstract contract ReentrancyGuard {
// Booleans are more expensive than uint256 or any type that takes up a full
// word because each write operation emits an extra SLOAD to first read the
// slot's contents, replace the bits taken up by the boolean, and then write
// back. This is the compiler's defense against contract upgrades and
// pointer aliasing, and it cannot be disabled.
// The values being non-zero value makes deployment a bit more expensive,
// but in exchange the refund on every call to nonReentrant will be lower in
// amount. Since refunds are capped to a percentage of the total
// transaction's gas, it is best to keep them low in cases like this one, to
// increase the likelihood of the full refund coming into effect.
uint256 private constant _NOT_ENTERED = 1;
uint256 private constant _ENTERED = 2;
uint256 private _status;
constructor() {
_status = _NOT_ENTERED;
}
/**
* @dev Prevents a contract from calling itself, directly or indirectly.
* Calling a `nonReentrant` function from another `nonReentrant`
* function is not supported. It is possible to prevent this from happening
* by making the `nonReentrant` function external, and making it call a
* `private` function that does the actual work.
*/
modifier nonReentrant() {
// On the first call to nonReentrant, _notEntered will be true
require(_status != _ENTERED, "ReentrancyGuard: reentrant call");
// Any calls to nonReentrant after this point will fail
_status = _ENTERED;
_;
// By storing the original value once again, a refund is triggered (see
// https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2200)
_status = _NOT_ENTERED;
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (token/ERC20/utils/SafeERC20.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "../IERC20.sol";
import "../../../utils/Address.sol";
/**
* @title SafeERC20
* @dev Wrappers around ERC20 operations that throw on failure (when the token
* contract returns false). Tokens that return no value (and instead revert or
* throw on failure) are also supported, non-reverting calls are assumed to be
* successful.
* To use this library you can add a `using SafeERC20 for IERC20;` statement to your contract,
* which allows you to call the safe operations as `token.safeTransfer(...)`, etc.
*/
library SafeERC20 {
using Address for address;
function safeTransfer(
IERC20 token,
address to,
uint256 value
) internal {
_callOptionalReturn(token, abi.encodeWithSelector(token.transfer.selector, to, value));
}
function safeTransferFrom(
IERC20 token,
address from,
address to,
uint256 value
) internal {
_callOptionalReturn(token, abi.encodeWithSelector(token.transferFrom.selector, from, to, value));
}
/**
* @dev Deprecated. This function has issues similar to the ones found in
* {IERC20-approve}, and its usage is discouraged.
*
* Whenever possible, use {safeIncreaseAllowance} and
* {safeDecreaseAllowance} instead.
*/
function safeApprove(
IERC20 token,
address spender,
uint256 value
) internal {
// safeApprove should only be called when setting an initial allowance,
// or when resetting it to zero. To increase and decrease it, use
// 'safeIncreaseAllowance' and 'safeDecreaseAllowance'
require(
(value == 0) || (token.allowance(address(this), spender) == 0),
"SafeERC20: approve from non-zero to non-zero allowance"
);
_callOptionalReturn(token, abi.encodeWithSelector(token.approve.selector, spender, value));
}
function safeIncreaseAllowance(
IERC20 token,
address spender,
uint256 value
) internal {
uint256 newAllowance = token.allowance(address(this), spender) + value;
_callOptionalReturn(token, abi.encodeWithSelector(token.approve.selector, spender, newAllowance));
}
function safeDecreaseAllowance(
IERC20 token,
address spender,
uint256 value
) internal {
unchecked {
uint256 oldAllowance = token.allowance(address(this), spender);
require(oldAllowance >= value, "SafeERC20: decreased allowance below zero");
uint256 newAllowance = oldAllowance - value;
_callOptionalReturn(token, abi.encodeWithSelector(token.approve.selector, spender, newAllowance));
}
}
/**
* @dev Imitates a Solidity high-level call (i.e. a regular function call to a contract), relaxing the requirement
* on the return value: the return value is optional (but if data is returned, it must not be false).
* @param token The token targeted by the call.
* @param data The call data (encoded using abi.encode or one of its variants).
*/
function _callOptionalReturn(IERC20 token, bytes memory data) private {
// We need to perform a low level call here, to bypass Solidity's return data size checking mechanism, since
// we're implementing it ourselves. We use {Address.functionCall} to perform this call, which verifies that
// the target address contains contract code and also asserts for success in the low-level call.
bytes memory returndata = address(token).functionCall(data, "SafeERC20: low-level call failed");
if (returndata.length > 0) {
// Return data is optional
require(abi.decode(returndata, (bool)), "SafeERC20: ERC20 operation did not succeed");
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/Address.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev Collection of functions related to the address type
*/
library Address {
/**
* @dev Returns true if `account` is a contract.
*
* [IMPORTANT]
* ====
* It is unsafe to assume that an address for which this function returns
* false is an externally-owned account (EOA) and not a contract.
*
* Among others, `isContract` will return false for the following
* types of addresses:
*
* - an externally-owned account
* - a contract in construction
* - an address where a contract will be created
* - an address where a contract lived, but was destroyed
* ====
*/
function isContract(address account) internal view returns (bool) {
// This method relies on extcodesize, which returns 0 for contracts in
// construction, since the code is only stored at the end of the
// constructor execution.
uint256 size;
assembly {
size := extcodesize(account)
}
return size > 0;
}
/**
* @dev Replacement for Solidity's `transfer`: sends `amount` wei to
* `recipient`, forwarding all available gas and reverting on errors.
*
* https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1884[EIP1884] increases the gas cost
* of certain opcodes, possibly making contracts go over the 2300 gas limit
* imposed by `transfer`, making them unable to receive funds via
* `transfer`. {sendValue} removes this limitation.
*
* https://diligence.consensys.net/posts/2019/09/stop-using-soliditys-transfer-now/[Learn more].
*
* IMPORTANT: because control is transferred to `recipient`, care must be
* taken to not create reentrancy vulnerabilities. Consider using
* {ReentrancyGuard} or the
* https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/v0.5.11/security-considerations.html#use-the-checks-effects-interactions-pattern[checks-effects-interactions pattern].
*/
function sendValue(address payable recipient, uint256 amount) internal {
require(address(this).balance >= amount, "Address: insufficient balance");
(bool success, ) = recipient.call{value: amount}("");
require(success, "Address: unable to send value, recipient may have reverted");
}
/**
* @dev Performs a Solidity function call using a low level `call`. A
* plain `call` is an unsafe replacement for a function call: use this
* function instead.
*
* If `target` reverts with a revert reason, it is bubbled up by this
* function (like regular Solidity function calls).
*
* Returns the raw returned data. To convert to the expected return value,
* use https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/latest/units-and-global-variables.html?highlight=abi.decode#abi-encoding-and-decoding-functions[`abi.decode`].
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `target` must be a contract.
* - calling `target` with `data` must not revert.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) {
return functionCall(target, data, "Address: low-level call failed");
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], but with
* `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCall(
address target,
bytes memory data,
string memory errorMessage
) internal returns (bytes memory) {
return functionCallWithValue(target, data, 0, errorMessage);
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
* but also transferring `value` wei to `target`.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - the calling contract must have an ETH balance of at least `value`.
* - the called Solidity function must be `payable`.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCallWithValue(
address target,
bytes memory data,
uint256 value
) internal returns (bytes memory) {
return functionCallWithValue(target, data, value, "Address: low-level call with value failed");
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCallWithValue-address-bytes-uint256-}[`functionCallWithValue`], but
* with `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
function functionCallWithValue(
address target,
bytes memory data,
uint256 value,
string memory errorMessage
) internal returns (bytes memory) {
require(address(this).balance >= value, "Address: insufficient balance for call");
require(isContract(target), "Address: call to non-contract");
(bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.call{value: value}(data);
return verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage);
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
* but performing a static call.
*
* _Available since v3.3._
*/
function functionStaticCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
return functionStaticCall(target, data, "Address: low-level static call failed");
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`],
* but performing a static call.
*
* _Available since v3.3._
*/
function functionStaticCall(
address target,
bytes memory data,
string memory errorMessage
) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
require(isContract(target), "Address: static call to non-contract");
(bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.staticcall(data);
return verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage);
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
* but performing a delegate call.
*
* _Available since v3.4._
*/
function functionDelegateCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) {
return functionDelegateCall(target, data, "Address: low-level delegate call failed");
}
/**
* @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`],
* but performing a delegate call.
*
* _Available since v3.4._
*/
function functionDelegateCall(
address target,
bytes memory data,
string memory errorMessage
) internal returns (bytes memory) {
require(isContract(target), "Address: delegate call to non-contract");
(bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.delegatecall(data);
return verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage);
}
/**
* @dev Tool to verifies that a low level call was successful, and revert if it wasn't, either by bubbling the
* revert reason using the provided one.
*
* _Available since v4.3._
*/
function verifyCallResult(
bool success,
bytes memory returndata,
string memory errorMessage
) internal pure returns (bytes memory) {
if (success) {
return returndata;
} else {
// Look for revert reason and bubble it up if present
if (returndata.length > 0) {
// The easiest way to bubble the revert reason is using memory via assembly
assembly {
let returndata_size := mload(returndata)
revert(add(32, returndata), returndata_size)
}
} else {
revert(errorMessage);
}
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/Context.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev Provides information about the current execution context, including the
* sender of the transaction and its data. While these are generally available
* via msg.sender and msg.data, they should not be accessed in such a direct
* manner, since when dealing with meta-transactions the account sending and
* paying for execution may not be the actual sender (as far as an application
* is concerned).
*
* This contract is only required for intermediate, library-like contracts.
*/
abstract contract Context {
function _msgSender() internal view virtual returns (address) {
return msg.sender;
}
function _msgData() internal view virtual returns (bytes calldata) {
return msg.data;
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (token/ERC20/IERC20.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev Interface of the ERC20 standard as defined in the EIP.
*/
interface IERC20 {
/**
* @dev Returns the amount of tokens in existence.
*/
function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256);
/**
* @dev Returns the amount of tokens owned by `account`.
*/
function balanceOf(address account) external view returns (uint256);
/**
* @dev Moves `amount` tokens from the caller's account to `recipient`.
*
* Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function transfer(address recipient, uint256 amount) external returns (bool);
/**
* @dev Returns the remaining number of tokens that `spender` will be
* allowed to spend on behalf of `owner` through {transferFrom}. This is
* zero by default.
*
* This value changes when {approve} or {transferFrom} are called.
*/
function allowance(address owner, address spender) external view returns (uint256);
/**
* @dev Sets `amount` as the allowance of `spender` over the caller's tokens.
*
* Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded.
*
* IMPORTANT: Beware that changing an allowance with this method brings the risk
* that someone may use both the old and the new allowance by unfortunate
* transaction ordering. One possible solution to mitigate this race
* condition is to first reduce the spender's allowance to 0 and set the
* desired value afterwards:
* https://github.com/ethereum/EIPs/issues/20#issuecomment-263524729
*
* Emits an {Approval} event.
*/
function approve(address spender, uint256 amount) external returns (bool);
/**
* @dev Moves `amount` tokens from `sender` to `recipient` using the
* allowance mechanism. `amount` is then deducted from the caller's
* allowance.
*
* Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded.
*
* Emits a {Transfer} event.
*/
function transferFrom(
address sender,
address recipient,
uint256 amount
) external returns (bool);
/**
* @dev Emitted when `value` tokens are moved from one account (`from`) to
* another (`to`).
*
* Note that `value` may be zero.
*/
event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 value);
/**
* @dev Emitted when the allowance of a `spender` for an `owner` is set by
* a call to {approve}. `value` is the new allowance.
*/
event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed spender, uint256 value);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/structs/EnumerableSet.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev Library for managing
* https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Set_(abstract_data_type)[sets] of primitive
* types.
*
* Sets have the following properties:
*
* - Elements are added, removed, and checked for existence in constant time
* (O(1)).
* - Elements are enumerated in O(n). No guarantees are made on the ordering.
*
* ```
* contract Example {
* // Add the library methods
* using EnumerableSet for EnumerableSet.AddressSet;
*
* // Declare a set state variable
* EnumerableSet.AddressSet private mySet;
* }
* ```
*
* As of v3.3.0, sets of type `bytes32` (`Bytes32Set`), `address` (`AddressSet`)
* and `uint256` (`UintSet`) are supported.
*/
library EnumerableSet {
// To implement this library for multiple types with as little code
// repetition as possible, we write it in terms of a generic Set type with
// bytes32 values.
// The Set implementation uses private functions, and user-facing
// implementations (such as AddressSet) are just wrappers around the
// underlying Set.
// This means that we can only create new EnumerableSets for types that fit
// in bytes32.
struct Set {
// Storage of set values
bytes32[] _values;
// Position of the value in the `values` array, plus 1 because index 0
// means a value is not in the set.
mapping(bytes32 => uint256) _indexes;
}
/**
* @dev Add a value to a set. O(1).
*
* Returns true if the value was added to the set, that is if it was not
* already present.
*/
function _add(Set storage set, bytes32 value) private returns (bool) {
if (!_contains(set, value)) {
set._values.push(value);
// The value is stored at length-1, but we add 1 to all indexes
// and use 0 as a sentinel value
set._indexes[value] = set._values.length;
return true;
} else {
return false;
}
}
/**
* @dev Removes a value from a set. O(1).
*
* Returns true if the value was removed from the set, that is if it was
* present.
*/
function _remove(Set storage set, bytes32 value) private returns (bool) {
// We read and store the value's index to prevent multiple reads from the same storage slot
uint256 valueIndex = set._indexes[value];
if (valueIndex != 0) {
// Equivalent to contains(set, value)
// To delete an element from the _values array in O(1), we swap the element to delete with the last one in
// the array, and then remove the last element (sometimes called as 'swap and pop').
// This modifies the order of the array, as noted in {at}.
uint256 toDeleteIndex = valueIndex - 1;
uint256 lastIndex = set._values.length - 1;
if (lastIndex != toDeleteIndex) {
bytes32 lastvalue = set._values[lastIndex];
// Move the last value to the index where the value to delete is
set._values[toDeleteIndex] = lastvalue;
// Update the index for the moved value
set._indexes[lastvalue] = valueIndex; // Replace lastvalue's index to valueIndex
}
// Delete the slot where the moved value was stored
set._values.pop();
// Delete the index for the deleted slot
delete set._indexes[value];
return true;
} else {
return false;
}
}
/**
* @dev Returns true if the value is in the set. O(1).
*/
function _contains(Set storage set, bytes32 value) private view returns (bool) {
return set._indexes[value] != 0;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the number of values on the set. O(1).
*/
function _length(Set storage set) private view returns (uint256) {
return set._values.length;
}
/**
* @dev Returns the value stored at position `index` in the set. O(1).
*
* Note that there are no guarantees on the ordering of values inside the
* array, and it may change when more values are added or removed.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `index` must be strictly less than {length}.
*/
function _at(Set storage set, uint256 index) private view returns (bytes32) {
return set._values[index];
}
/**
* @dev Return the entire set in an array
*
* WARNING: This operation will copy the entire storage to memory, which can be quite expensive. This is designed
* to mostly be used by view accessors that are queried without any gas fees. Developers should keep in mind that
* this function has an unbounded cost, and using it as part of a state-changing function may render the function
* uncallable if the set grows to a point where copying to memory consumes too much gas to fit in a block.
*/
function _values(Set storage set) private view returns (bytes32[] memory) {
return set._values;
}
// Bytes32Set
struct Bytes32Set {
Set _inner;
}
/**
* @dev Add a value to a set. O(1).
*
* Returns true if the value was added to the set, that is if it was not
* already present.
*/
function add(Bytes32Set storage set, bytes32 value) internal returns (bool) {
return _add(set._inner, value);
}
/**
* @dev Removes a value from a set. O(1).
*
* Returns true if the value was removed from the set, that is if it was
* present.
*/
function remove(Bytes32Set storage set, bytes32 value) internal returns (bool) {
return _remove(set._inner, value);
}
/**
* @dev Returns true if the value is in the set. O(1).
*/
function contains(Bytes32Set storage set, bytes32 value) internal view returns (bool) {
return _contains(set._inner, value);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the number of values in the set. O(1).
*/
function length(Bytes32Set storage set) internal view returns (uint256) {
return _length(set._inner);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the value stored at position `index` in the set. O(1).
*
* Note that there are no guarantees on the ordering of values inside the
* array, and it may change when more values are added or removed.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `index` must be strictly less than {length}.
*/
function at(Bytes32Set storage set, uint256 index) internal view returns (bytes32) {
return _at(set._inner, index);
}
/**
* @dev Return the entire set in an array
*
* WARNING: This operation will copy the entire storage to memory, which can be quite expensive. This is designed
* to mostly be used by view accessors that are queried without any gas fees. Developers should keep in mind that
* this function has an unbounded cost, and using it as part of a state-changing function may render the function
* uncallable if the set grows to a point where copying to memory consumes too much gas to fit in a block.
*/
function values(Bytes32Set storage set) internal view returns (bytes32[] memory) {
return _values(set._inner);
}
// AddressSet
struct AddressSet {
Set _inner;
}
/**
* @dev Add a value to a set. O(1).
*
* Returns true if the value was added to the set, that is if it was not
* already present.
*/
function add(AddressSet storage set, address value) internal returns (bool) {
return _add(set._inner, bytes32(uint256(uint160(value))));
}
/**
* @dev Removes a value from a set. O(1).
*
* Returns true if the value was removed from the set, that is if it was
* present.
*/
function remove(AddressSet storage set, address value) internal returns (bool) {
return _remove(set._inner, bytes32(uint256(uint160(value))));
}
/**
* @dev Returns true if the value is in the set. O(1).
*/
function contains(AddressSet storage set, address value) internal view returns (bool) {
return _contains(set._inner, bytes32(uint256(uint160(value))));
}
/**
* @dev Returns the number of values in the set. O(1).
*/
function length(AddressSet storage set) internal view returns (uint256) {
return _length(set._inner);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the value stored at position `index` in the set. O(1).
*
* Note that there are no guarantees on the ordering of values inside the
* array, and it may change when more values are added or removed.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `index` must be strictly less than {length}.
*/
function at(AddressSet storage set, uint256 index) internal view returns (address) {
return address(uint160(uint256(_at(set._inner, index))));
}
/**
* @dev Return the entire set in an array
*
* WARNING: This operation will copy the entire storage to memory, which can be quite expensive. This is designed
* to mostly be used by view accessors that are queried without any gas fees. Developers should keep in mind that
* this function has an unbounded cost, and using it as part of a state-changing function may render the function
* uncallable if the set grows to a point where copying to memory consumes too much gas to fit in a block.
*/
function values(AddressSet storage set) internal view returns (address[] memory) {
bytes32[] memory store = _values(set._inner);
address[] memory result;
assembly {
result := store
}
return result;
}
// UintSet
struct UintSet {
Set _inner;
}
/**
* @dev Add a value to a set. O(1).
*
* Returns true if the value was added to the set, that is if it was not
* already present.
*/
function add(UintSet storage set, uint256 value) internal returns (bool) {
return _add(set._inner, bytes32(value));
}
/**
* @dev Removes a value from a set. O(1).
*
* Returns true if the value was removed from the set, that is if it was
* present.
*/
function remove(UintSet storage set, uint256 value) internal returns (bool) {
return _remove(set._inner, bytes32(value));
}
/**
* @dev Returns true if the value is in the set. O(1).
*/
function contains(UintSet storage set, uint256 value) internal view returns (bool) {
return _contains(set._inner, bytes32(value));
}
/**
* @dev Returns the number of values on the set. O(1).
*/
function length(UintSet storage set) internal view returns (uint256) {
return _length(set._inner);
}
/**
* @dev Returns the value stored at position `index` in the set. O(1).
*
* Note that there are no guarantees on the ordering of values inside the
* array, and it may change when more values are added or removed.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - `index` must be strictly less than {length}.
*/
function at(UintSet storage set, uint256 index) internal view returns (uint256) {
return uint256(_at(set._inner, index));
}
/**
* @dev Return the entire set in an array
*
* WARNING: This operation will copy the entire storage to memory, which can be quite expensive. This is designed
* to mostly be used by view accessors that are queried without any gas fees. Developers should keep in mind that
* this function has an unbounded cost, and using it as part of a state-changing function may render the function
* uncallable if the set grows to a point where copying to memory consumes too much gas to fit in a block.
*/
function values(UintSet storage set) internal view returns (uint256[] memory) {
bytes32[] memory store = _values(set._inner);
uint256[] memory result;
assembly {
result := store
}
return result;
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import {AccessControl} from '@openzeppelin/contracts/access/AccessControl.sol';
import {IERC20, SafeERC20} from '@openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC20/utils/SafeERC20.sol';
import {ReentrancyGuard} from '@openzeppelin/contracts/security/ReentrancyGuard.sol';
import {TokenDistributor} from './TokenDistributor.sol';
import {IStakeFor} from './IStakeFor.sol';
/**
* @title FeeSharingSystem
* @notice It handles the distribution of fees using
* WETH along with the auto-compounding of X2Y2.
*/
contract FeeSharingSystem is ReentrancyGuard, AccessControl, IStakeFor {
using SafeERC20 for IERC20;
// for `depositFor` call
bytes32 public constant DEPOSIT_ROLE = keccak256('DEPOSIT_ROLE');
// for `updateRewards()`
bytes32 public constant REWARD_UPDATE_ROLE = keccak256('REWARD_UPDATE_ROLE');
struct UserInfo {
uint256 shares; // shares of token staked
uint256 userRewardPerTokenPaid; // user reward per token paid
uint256 rewards; // pending rewards
}
// Precision factor for calculating rewards and exchange rate
uint256 public constant PRECISION_FACTOR = 10**18;
IERC20 public immutable x2y2Token;
IERC20 public immutable rewardToken;
TokenDistributor public immutable tokenDistributor;
// Reward rate (block)
uint256 public currentRewardPerBlock;
// Last reward adjustment block number
uint256 public lastRewardAdjustment;
// Last update block for rewards
uint256 public lastUpdateBlock;
// Current end block for the current reward period
uint256 public periodEndBlock;
// Reward per token stored
uint256 public rewardPerTokenStored;
// Total existing shares
uint256 public totalShares;
mapping(address => UserInfo) public userInfo;
event Deposit(address indexed user, uint256 amount, uint256 harvestedAmount);
event Harvest(address indexed user, uint256 harvestedAmount);
event NewRewardPeriod(uint256 numberBlocks, uint256 rewardPerBlock, uint256 reward);
event Withdraw(address indexed user, uint256 amount, uint256 harvestedAmount);
/**
* @notice Constructor
* @param _x2y2Token address of the token staked
* @param _rewardToken address of the reward token
* @param _tokenDistributor address of the token distributor contract
*/
constructor(
address _x2y2Token,
address _rewardToken,
address _tokenDistributor
) {
rewardToken = IERC20(_rewardToken);
x2y2Token = IERC20(_x2y2Token);
tokenDistributor = TokenDistributor(_tokenDistributor);
_grantRole(DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE, msg.sender);
}
/**
* @notice deposit on behalf of `user`, must be called on fresh deposit only
* @param user deposit user
* @param amount amount to deposit
*/
function depositFor(address user, uint256 amount)
external
override
nonReentrant
onlyRole(DEPOSIT_ROLE)
returns (bool)
{
require(amount >= PRECISION_FACTOR, 'Deposit: Amount must be >= 1 X2Y2');
// Auto compounds for everyone
tokenDistributor.harvestAndCompound();
// Update reward for user
_updateReward(user);
// Retrieve total amount staked by this contract
(uint256 totalAmountStaked, ) = tokenDistributor.userInfo(address(this));
// transfer stakingToken from **sender**
x2y2Token.safeTransferFrom(msg.sender, address(this), amount);
uint256 currentShares;
// Calculate the number of shares to issue for the user
if (totalShares != 0) {
currentShares = (amount * totalShares) / totalAmountStaked;
// This is a sanity check to prevent deposit for 0 shares
require(currentShares != 0, 'Deposit: Fail');
} else {
currentShares = amount;
}
// Adjust internal shares
userInfo[user].shares += currentShares;
totalShares += currentShares;
// Verify X2Y2 token allowance and adjust if necessary
_checkAndAdjustX2Y2TokenAllowanceIfRequired(amount, address(tokenDistributor));
// Deposit user amount in the token distributor contract
tokenDistributor.deposit(amount);
emit Deposit(user, amount, 0);
return true;
}
/**
* @notice Deposit staked tokens (and collect reward tokens if requested)
* @param amount amount to deposit (in X2Y2)
* @param claimRewardToken whether to claim reward tokens
* @dev There is a limit of 1 X2Y2 per deposit to prevent potential manipulation of current shares
*/
function deposit(uint256 amount, bool claimRewardToken) external nonReentrant {
require(amount >= PRECISION_FACTOR, 'Deposit: Amount must be >= 1 X2Y2');
// Auto compounds for everyone
tokenDistributor.harvestAndCompound();
// Update reward for user
_updateReward(msg.sender);
// Retrieve total amount staked by this contract
(uint256 totalAmountStaked, ) = tokenDistributor.userInfo(address(this));
// Transfer X2Y2 tokens to this address
x2y2Token.safeTransferFrom(msg.sender, address(this), amount);
uint256 currentShares;
// Calculate the number of shares to issue for the user
if (totalShares != 0) {
currentShares = (amount * totalShares) / totalAmountStaked;
// This is a sanity check to prevent deposit for 0 shares
require(currentShares != 0, 'Deposit: Fail');
} else {
currentShares = amount;
}
// Adjust internal shares
userInfo[msg.sender].shares += currentShares;
totalShares += currentShares;
uint256 pendingRewards;
if (claimRewardToken) {
// Fetch pending rewards
pendingRewards = userInfo[msg.sender].rewards;
if (pendingRewards > 0) {
userInfo[msg.sender].rewards = 0;
rewardToken.safeTransfer(msg.sender, pendingRewards);
}
}
// Verify X2Y2 token allowance and adjust if necessary
_checkAndAdjustX2Y2TokenAllowanceIfRequired(amount, address(tokenDistributor));
// Deposit user amount in the token distributor contract
tokenDistributor.deposit(amount);
emit Deposit(msg.sender, amount, pendingRewards);
}
/**
* @notice Harvest reward tokens that are pending
*/
function harvest() external nonReentrant {
// Auto compounds for everyone
tokenDistributor.harvestAndCompound();
// Update reward for user
_updateReward(msg.sender);
// Retrieve pending rewards
uint256 pendingRewards = userInfo[msg.sender].rewards;
// If pending rewards are null, revert
require(pendingRewards > 0, 'Harvest: Pending rewards must be > 0');
// Adjust user rewards and transfer
userInfo[msg.sender].rewards = 0;
// Transfer reward token to sender
rewardToken.safeTransfer(msg.sender, pendingRewards);
emit Harvest(msg.sender, pendingRewards);
}
/**
* @notice Withdraw staked tokens (and collect reward tokens if requested)
* @param shares shares to withdraw
* @param claimRewardToken whether to claim reward tokens
*/
function withdraw(uint256 shares, bool claimRewardToken) external nonReentrant {
require(
(shares > 0) && (shares <= userInfo[msg.sender].shares),
'Withdraw: Shares equal to 0 or larger than user shares'
);
_withdraw(shares, claimRewardToken);
}
/**
* @notice Withdraw all staked tokens (and collect reward tokens if requested)
* @param claimRewardToken whether to claim reward tokens
*/
function withdrawAll(bool claimRewardToken) external nonReentrant {
_withdraw(userInfo[msg.sender].shares, claimRewardToken);
}
/**
* @notice Update the reward per block (in rewardToken)
* @dev Only callable by owner. Owner is meant to be another smart contract.
*/
function updateRewards(uint256 reward, uint256 rewardDurationInBlocks)
external
onlyRole(REWARD_UPDATE_ROLE)
{
// Adjust the current reward per block
if (block.number >= periodEndBlock) {
currentRewardPerBlock = reward / rewardDurationInBlocks;
} else {
currentRewardPerBlock =
(reward + ((periodEndBlock - block.number) * currentRewardPerBlock)) /
rewardDurationInBlocks;
}
lastUpdateBlock = block.number;
periodEndBlock = block.number + rewardDurationInBlocks;
emit NewRewardPeriod(rewardDurationInBlocks, currentRewardPerBlock, reward);
}
/**
* @notice Calculate pending rewards (WETH) for a user
* @param user address of the user
*/
function calculatePendingRewards(address user) external view returns (uint256) {
return _calculatePendingRewards(user);
}
/**
* @notice Calculate value of X2Y2 for a user given a number of shares owned
* @param user address of the user
*/
function calculateSharesValueInX2Y2(address user) external view returns (uint256) {
// Retrieve amount staked
(uint256 totalAmountStaked, ) = tokenDistributor.userInfo(address(this));
// Adjust for pending rewards
totalAmountStaked += tokenDistributor.calculatePendingRewards(address(this));
// Return user pro-rata of total shares
return
userInfo[user].shares == 0
? 0
: (totalAmountStaked * userInfo[user].shares) / totalShares;
}
/**
* @notice Calculate price of one share (in X2Y2 token)
* Share price is expressed times 1e18
*/
function calculateSharePriceInX2Y2() external view returns (uint256) {
(uint256 totalAmountStaked, ) = tokenDistributor.userInfo(address(this));
// Adjust for pending rewards
totalAmountStaked += tokenDistributor.calculatePendingRewards(address(this));
return
totalShares == 0
? PRECISION_FACTOR
: (totalAmountStaked * PRECISION_FACTOR) / (totalShares);
}
/**
* @notice Return last block where trading rewards were distributed
*/
function lastRewardBlock() external view returns (uint256) {
return _lastRewardBlock();
}
/**
* @notice Calculate pending rewards for a user
* @param user address of the user
*/
function _calculatePendingRewards(address user) internal view returns (uint256) {
return
((userInfo[user].shares *
(_rewardPerToken() - (userInfo[user].userRewardPerTokenPaid))) / PRECISION_FACTOR) +
userInfo[user].rewards;
}
/**
* @notice Check current allowance and adjust if necessary
* @param _amount amount to transfer
* @param _to token to transfer
*/
function _checkAndAdjustX2Y2TokenAllowanceIfRequired(uint256 _amount, address _to) internal {
if (x2y2Token.allowance(address(this), _to) < _amount) {
x2y2Token.approve(_to, type(uint256).max);
}
}
/**
* @notice Return last block where rewards must be distributed
*/
function _lastRewardBlock() internal view returns (uint256) {
return block.number < periodEndBlock ? block.number : periodEndBlock;
}
/**
* @notice Return reward per token
*/
function _rewardPerToken() internal view returns (uint256) {
if (totalShares == 0) {
return rewardPerTokenStored;
}
return
rewardPerTokenStored +
((_lastRewardBlock() - lastUpdateBlock) * (currentRewardPerBlock * PRECISION_FACTOR)) /
totalShares;
}
/**
* @notice Update reward for a user account
* @param _user address of the user
*/
function _updateReward(address _user) internal {
if (block.number != lastUpdateBlock) {
rewardPerTokenStored = _rewardPerToken();
lastUpdateBlock = _lastRewardBlock();
}
userInfo[_user].rewards = _calculatePendingRewards(_user);
userInfo[_user].userRewardPerTokenPaid = rewardPerTokenStored;
}
/**
* @notice Withdraw staked tokens (and collect reward tokens if requested)
* @param shares shares to withdraw
* @param claimRewardToken whether to claim reward tokens
*/
function _withdraw(uint256 shares, bool claimRewardToken) internal {
// Auto compounds for everyone
tokenDistributor.harvestAndCompound();
// Update reward for user
_updateReward(msg.sender);
// Retrieve total amount staked and calculated current amount (in X2Y2)
(uint256 totalAmountStaked, ) = tokenDistributor.userInfo(address(this));
uint256 currentAmount = (totalAmountStaked * shares) / totalShares;
userInfo[msg.sender].shares -= shares;
totalShares -= shares;
// Withdraw amount equivalent in shares
tokenDistributor.withdraw(currentAmount);
uint256 pendingRewards;
if (claimRewardToken) {
// Fetch pending rewards
pendingRewards = userInfo[msg.sender].rewards;
if (pendingRewards > 0) {
userInfo[msg.sender].rewards = 0;
rewardToken.safeTransfer(msg.sender, pendingRewards);
}
}
// Transfer X2Y2 tokens to sender
x2y2Token.safeTransfer(msg.sender, currentAmount);
emit Withdraw(msg.sender, currentAmount, pendingRewards);
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import {ReentrancyGuard} from '@openzeppelin/contracts/security/ReentrancyGuard.sol';
import {IERC20, SafeERC20} from '@openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC20/utils/SafeERC20.sol';
import {IMintableERC20} from './IMintableERC20.sol';
/**
* @title TokenDistributor
* @notice It handles the distribution of X2Y2 token.
* It auto-adjusts block rewards over a set number of periods.
*/
contract TokenDistributor is ReentrancyGuard {
using SafeERC20 for IERC20;
using SafeERC20 for IMintableERC20;
struct StakingPeriod {
uint256 rewardPerBlockForStaking;
uint256 rewardPerBlockForOthers;
uint256 periodLengthInBlock;
}
struct UserInfo {
uint256 amount; // Amount of staked tokens provided by user
uint256 rewardDebt; // Reward debt
}
// Precision factor for calculating rewards
uint256 public constant PRECISION_FACTOR = 10**12;
IMintableERC20 public immutable x2y2Token;
address public immutable tokenSplitter;
// Number of reward periods
uint256 public immutable NUMBER_PERIODS;
// Block number when rewards start
uint256 public immutable START_BLOCK;
// Accumulated tokens per share
uint256 public accTokenPerShare;
// Current phase for rewards
uint256 public currentPhase;
// Block number when rewards end
uint256 public endBlock;
// Block number of the last update
uint256 public lastRewardBlock;
// Tokens distributed per block for other purposes (team + treasury + trading rewards)
uint256 public rewardPerBlockForOthers;
// Tokens distributed per block for staking
uint256 public rewardPerBlockForStaking;
// Total amount staked
uint256 public totalAmountStaked;
mapping(uint256 => StakingPeriod) public stakingPeriod;
mapping(address => UserInfo) public userInfo;
event Compound(address indexed user, uint256 harvestedAmount);
event Deposit(address indexed user, uint256 amount, uint256 harvestedAmount);
event NewRewardsPerBlock(
uint256 indexed currentPhase,
uint256 startBlock,
uint256 rewardPerBlockForStaking,
uint256 rewardPerBlockForOthers
);
event Withdraw(address indexed user, uint256 amount, uint256 harvestedAmount);
/**
* @notice Constructor
* @param _x2y2Token token address
* @param _tokenSplitter token splitter contract address (for team and trading rewards)
* @param _startBlock start block for reward program
* @param _rewardsPerBlockForStaking array of rewards per block for staking
* @param _rewardsPerBlockForOthers array of rewards per block for other purposes (team + treasury + trading rewards)
* @param _periodLengthesInBlocks array of period lengthes
* @param _numberPeriods number of periods with different rewards/lengthes (e.g., if 3 changes --> 4 periods)
*/
constructor(
address _x2y2Token,
address _tokenSplitter,
uint256 _startBlock,
uint256[] memory _rewardsPerBlockForStaking,
uint256[] memory _rewardsPerBlockForOthers,
uint256[] memory _periodLengthesInBlocks,
uint256 _numberPeriods
) {
require(
(_periodLengthesInBlocks.length == _numberPeriods) &&
(_rewardsPerBlockForStaking.length == _numberPeriods) &&
(_rewardsPerBlockForStaking.length == _numberPeriods),
'Distributor: Lengthes must match numberPeriods'
);
// 1. Operational checks for supply
uint256 nonCirculatingSupply = IMintableERC20(_x2y2Token).SUPPLY_CAP() -
IMintableERC20(_x2y2Token).totalSupply();
uint256 amountTokensToBeMinted;
for (uint256 i = 0; i < _numberPeriods; i++) {
amountTokensToBeMinted +=
(_rewardsPerBlockForStaking[i] * _periodLengthesInBlocks[i]) +
(_rewardsPerBlockForOthers[i] * _periodLengthesInBlocks[i]);
stakingPeriod[i] = StakingPeriod({
rewardPerBlockForStaking: _rewardsPerBlockForStaking[i],
rewardPerBlockForOthers: _rewardsPerBlockForOthers[i],
periodLengthInBlock: _periodLengthesInBlocks[i]
});
}
require(
amountTokensToBeMinted == nonCirculatingSupply,
'Distributor: Wrong reward parameters'
);
// 2. Store values
x2y2Token = IMintableERC20(_x2y2Token);
tokenSplitter = _tokenSplitter;
rewardPerBlockForStaking = _rewardsPerBlockForStaking[0];
rewardPerBlockForOthers = _rewardsPerBlockForOthers[0];
START_BLOCK = _startBlock;
endBlock = _startBlock + _periodLengthesInBlocks[0];
NUMBER_PERIODS = _numberPeriods;
// Set the lastRewardBlock as the startBlock
lastRewardBlock = _startBlock;
}
/**
* @notice Deposit staked tokens and compounds pending rewards
* @param amount amount to deposit (in X2Y2)
*/
function deposit(uint256 amount) external nonReentrant {
require(amount > 0, 'Deposit: Amount must be > 0');
require(block.number >= START_BLOCK, 'Deposit: Not started yet');
// Update pool information
_updatePool();
// Transfer X2Y2 tokens to this contract
x2y2Token.safeTransferFrom(msg.sender, address(this), amount);
uint256 pendingRewards;
// If not new deposit, calculate pending rewards (for auto-compounding)
if (userInfo[msg.sender].amount > 0) {
pendingRewards =
((userInfo[msg.sender].amount * accTokenPerShare) / PRECISION_FACTOR) -
userInfo[msg.sender].rewardDebt;
}
// Adjust user information
userInfo[msg.sender].amount += (amount + pendingRewards);
userInfo[msg.sender].rewardDebt =
(userInfo[msg.sender].amount * accTokenPerShare) /
PRECISION_FACTOR;
// Increase totalAmountStaked
totalAmountStaked += (amount + pendingRewards);
emit Deposit(msg.sender, amount, pendingRewards);
}
/**
* @notice Compound based on pending rewards
*/
function harvestAndCompound() external nonReentrant {
// Update pool information
_updatePool();
// Calculate pending rewards
uint256 pendingRewards = ((userInfo[msg.sender].amount * accTokenPerShare) /
PRECISION_FACTOR) - userInfo[msg.sender].rewardDebt;
// Return if no pending rewards
if (pendingRewards == 0) {
// It doesn't throw revertion (to help with the fee-sharing auto-compounding contract)
return;
}
// Adjust user amount for pending rewards
userInfo[msg.sender].amount += pendingRewards;
// Adjust totalAmountStaked
totalAmountStaked += pendingRewards;
// Recalculate reward debt based on new user amount
userInfo[msg.sender].rewardDebt =
(userInfo[msg.sender].amount * accTokenPerShare) /
PRECISION_FACTOR;
emit Compound(msg.sender, pendingRewards);
}
/**
* @notice Update pool rewards
*/
function updatePool() external nonReentrant {
_updatePool();
}
/**
* @notice Withdraw staked tokens and compound pending rewards
* @param amount amount to withdraw
*/
function withdraw(uint256 amount) external nonReentrant {
require(
(userInfo[msg.sender].amount >= amount) && (amount > 0),
'Withdraw: Amount must be > 0 or lower than user balance'
);
// Update pool
_updatePool();
// Calculate pending rewards
uint256 pendingRewards = ((userInfo[msg.sender].amount * accTokenPerShare) /
PRECISION_FACTOR) - userInfo[msg.sender].rewardDebt;
// Adjust user information
userInfo[msg.sender].amount = userInfo[msg.sender].amount + pendingRewards - amount;
userInfo[msg.sender].rewardDebt =
(userInfo[msg.sender].amount * accTokenPerShare) /
PRECISION_FACTOR;
// Adjust total amount staked
totalAmountStaked = totalAmountStaked + pendingRewards - amount;
// Transfer X2Y2 tokens to the sender
x2y2Token.safeTransfer(msg.sender, amount);
emit Withdraw(msg.sender, amount, pendingRewards);
}
/**
* @notice Withdraw all staked tokens and collect tokens
*/
function withdrawAll() external nonReentrant {
require(userInfo[msg.sender].amount > 0, 'Withdraw: Amount must be > 0');
// Update pool
_updatePool();
// Calculate pending rewards and amount to transfer (to the sender)
uint256 pendingRewards = ((userInfo[msg.sender].amount * accTokenPerShare) /
PRECISION_FACTOR) - userInfo[msg.sender].rewardDebt;
uint256 amountToTransfer = userInfo[msg.sender].amount + pendingRewards;
// Adjust total amount staked
totalAmountStaked = totalAmountStaked - userInfo[msg.sender].amount;
// Adjust user information
userInfo[msg.sender].amount = 0;
userInfo[msg.sender].rewardDebt = 0;
// Transfer X2Y2 tokens to the sender
x2y2Token.safeTransfer(msg.sender, amountToTransfer);
emit Withdraw(msg.sender, amountToTransfer, pendingRewards);
}
/**
* @notice Calculate pending rewards for a user
* @param user address of the user
* @return Pending rewards
*/
function calculatePendingRewards(address user) external view returns (uint256) {
if ((block.number > lastRewardBlock) && (totalAmountStaked != 0)) {
uint256 multiplier = _getMultiplier(lastRewardBlock, block.number);
uint256 tokenRewardForStaking = multiplier * rewardPerBlockForStaking;
uint256 adjustedEndBlock = endBlock;
uint256 adjustedCurrentPhase = currentPhase;
// Check whether to adjust multipliers and reward per block
while (
(block.number > adjustedEndBlock) && (adjustedCurrentPhase < (NUMBER_PERIODS - 1))
) {
// Update current phase
adjustedCurrentPhase++;
// Update rewards per block
uint256 adjustedRewardPerBlockForStaking = stakingPeriod[adjustedCurrentPhase]
.rewardPerBlockForStaking;
// Calculate adjusted block number
uint256 previousEndBlock = adjustedEndBlock;
// Update end block
adjustedEndBlock =
previousEndBlock +
stakingPeriod[adjustedCurrentPhase].periodLengthInBlock;
// Calculate new multiplier
uint256 newMultiplier = (block.number <= adjustedEndBlock)
? (block.number - previousEndBlock)
: stakingPeriod[adjustedCurrentPhase].periodLengthInBlock;
// Adjust token rewards for staking
tokenRewardForStaking += (newMultiplier * adjustedRewardPerBlockForStaking);
}
uint256 adjustedTokenPerShare = accTokenPerShare +
(tokenRewardForStaking * PRECISION_FACTOR) /
totalAmountStaked;
return
(userInfo[user].amount * adjustedTokenPerShare) /
PRECISION_FACTOR -
userInfo[user].rewardDebt;
} else {
return
(userInfo[user].amount * accTokenPerShare) /
PRECISION_FACTOR -
userInfo[user].rewardDebt;
}
}
/**
* @notice Update reward variables of the pool
*/
function _updatePool() internal {
if (block.number <= lastRewardBlock) {
return;
}
if (totalAmountStaked == 0) {
lastRewardBlock = block.number;
return;
}
// Calculate multiplier
uint256 multiplier = _getMultiplier(lastRewardBlock, block.number);
// Calculate rewards for staking and others
uint256 tokenRewardForStaking = multiplier * rewardPerBlockForStaking;
uint256 tokenRewardForOthers = multiplier * rewardPerBlockForOthers;
// Check whether to adjust multipliers and reward per block
while ((block.number > endBlock) && (currentPhase < (NUMBER_PERIODS - 1))) {
// Update rewards per block
_updateRewardsPerBlock(endBlock);
uint256 previousEndBlock = endBlock;
// Adjust the end block
endBlock += stakingPeriod[currentPhase].periodLengthInBlock;
// Adjust multiplier to cover the missing periods with other lower inflation schedule
uint256 newMultiplier = _getMultiplier(previousEndBlock, block.number);
// Adjust token rewards
tokenRewardForStaking += (newMultiplier * rewardPerBlockForStaking);
tokenRewardForOthers += (newMultiplier * rewardPerBlockForOthers);
}
// Mint tokens only if token rewards for staking are not null
if (tokenRewardForStaking > 0) {
// It allows protection against potential issues to prevent funds from being locked
bool mintStatus = x2y2Token.mint(address(this), tokenRewardForStaking);
if (mintStatus) {
accTokenPerShare =
accTokenPerShare +
((tokenRewardForStaking * PRECISION_FACTOR) / totalAmountStaked);
}
x2y2Token.mint(tokenSplitter, tokenRewardForOthers);
}
// Update last reward block only if it wasn't updated after or at the end block
if (lastRewardBlock <= endBlock) {
lastRewardBlock = block.number;
}
}
/**
* @notice Update rewards per block
* @dev Rewards are halved by 2 (for staking + others)
*/
function _updateRewardsPerBlock(uint256 _newStartBlock) internal {
// Update current phase
currentPhase++;
// Update rewards per block
rewardPerBlockForStaking = stakingPeriod[currentPhase].rewardPerBlockForStaking;
rewardPerBlockForOthers = stakingPeriod[currentPhase].rewardPerBlockForOthers;
emit NewRewardsPerBlock(
currentPhase,
_newStartBlock,
rewardPerBlockForStaking,
rewardPerBlockForOthers
);
}
/**
* @notice Return reward multiplier over the given "from" to "to" block.
* @param from block to start calculating reward
* @param to block to finish calculating reward
* @return the multiplier for the period
*/
function _getMultiplier(uint256 from, uint256 to) internal view returns (uint256) {
if (to <= endBlock) {
return to - from;
} else if (from >= endBlock) {
return 0;
} else {
return endBlock - from;
}
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
interface IRewardConvertor {
function convert(
address tokenToSell,
address tokenToBuy,
uint256 amount,
bytes calldata additionalData
) external returns (uint256);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import {IERC20} from '@openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC20/IERC20.sol';
interface IMintableERC20 is IERC20 {
function SUPPLY_CAP() external view returns (uint256);
function mint(address account, uint256 amount) external returns (bool);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
interface ITokenStaked {
function getTotalStaked() external view returns (uint256);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (access/IAccessControl.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev External interface of AccessControl declared to support ERC165 detection.
*/
interface IAccessControl {
/**
* @dev Emitted when `newAdminRole` is set as ``role``'s admin role, replacing `previousAdminRole`
*
* `DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE` is the starting admin for all roles, despite
* {RoleAdminChanged} not being emitted signaling this.
*
* _Available since v3.1._
*/
event RoleAdminChanged(bytes32 indexed role, bytes32 indexed previousAdminRole, bytes32 indexed newAdminRole);
/**
* @dev Emitted when `account` is granted `role`.
*
* `sender` is the account that originated the contract call, an admin role
* bearer except when using {AccessControl-_setupRole}.
*/
event RoleGranted(bytes32 indexed role, address indexed account, address indexed sender);
/**
* @dev Emitted when `account` is revoked `role`.
*
* `sender` is the account that originated the contract call:
* - if using `revokeRole`, it is the admin role bearer
* - if using `renounceRole`, it is the role bearer (i.e. `account`)
*/
event RoleRevoked(bytes32 indexed role, address indexed account, address indexed sender);
/**
* @dev Returns `true` if `account` has been granted `role`.
*/
function hasRole(bytes32 role, address account) external view returns (bool);
/**
* @dev Returns the admin role that controls `role`. See {grantRole} and
* {revokeRole}.
*
* To change a role's admin, use {AccessControl-_setRoleAdmin}.
*/
function getRoleAdmin(bytes32 role) external view returns (bytes32);
/**
* @dev Grants `role` to `account`.
*
* If `account` had not been already granted `role`, emits a {RoleGranted}
* event.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - the caller must have ``role``'s admin role.
*/
function grantRole(bytes32 role, address account) external;
/**
* @dev Revokes `role` from `account`.
*
* If `account` had been granted `role`, emits a {RoleRevoked} event.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - the caller must have ``role``'s admin role.
*/
function revokeRole(bytes32 role, address account) external;
/**
* @dev Revokes `role` from the calling account.
*
* Roles are often managed via {grantRole} and {revokeRole}: this function's
* purpose is to provide a mechanism for accounts to lose their privileges
* if they are compromised (such as when a trusted device is misplaced).
*
* If the calling account had been granted `role`, emits a {RoleRevoked}
* event.
*
* Requirements:
*
* - the caller must be `account`.
*/
function renounceRole(bytes32 role, address account) external;
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/Strings.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev String operations.
*/
library Strings {
bytes16 private constant _HEX_SYMBOLS = "0123456789abcdef";
/**
* @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` decimal representation.
*/
function toString(uint256 value) internal pure returns (string memory) {
// Inspired by OraclizeAPI's implementation - MIT licence
// https://github.com/oraclize/ethereum-api/blob/b42146b063c7d6ee1358846c198246239e9360e8/oraclizeAPI_0.4.25.sol
if (value == 0) {
return "0";
}
uint256 temp = value;
uint256 digits;
while (temp != 0) {
digits++;
temp /= 10;
}
bytes memory buffer = new bytes(digits);
while (value != 0) {
digits -= 1;
buffer[digits] = bytes1(uint8(48 + uint256(value % 10)));
value /= 10;
}
return string(buffer);
}
/**
* @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` hexadecimal representation.
*/
function toHexString(uint256 value) internal pure returns (string memory) {
if (value == 0) {
return "0x00";
}
uint256 temp = value;
uint256 length = 0;
while (temp != 0) {
length++;
temp >>= 8;
}
return toHexString(value, length);
}
/**
* @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` hexadecimal representation with fixed length.
*/
function toHexString(uint256 value, uint256 length) internal pure returns (string memory) {
bytes memory buffer = new bytes(2 * length + 2);
buffer[0] = "0";
buffer[1] = "x";
for (uint256 i = 2 * length + 1; i > 1; --i) {
buffer[i] = _HEX_SYMBOLS[value & 0xf];
value >>= 4;
}
require(value == 0, "Strings: hex length insufficient");
return string(buffer);
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/introspection/ERC165.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
import "./IERC165.sol";
/**
* @dev Implementation of the {IERC165} interface.
*
* Contracts that want to implement ERC165 should inherit from this contract and override {supportsInterface} to check
* for the additional interface id that will be supported. For example:
*
* ```solidity
* function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
* return interfaceId == type(MyInterface).interfaceId || super.supportsInterface(interfaceId);
* }
* ```
*
* Alternatively, {ERC165Storage} provides an easier to use but more expensive implementation.
*/
abstract contract ERC165 is IERC165 {
/**
* @dev See {IERC165-supportsInterface}.
*/
function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
return interfaceId == type(IERC165).interfaceId;
}
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
// OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/introspection/IERC165.sol)
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
/**
* @dev Interface of the ERC165 standard, as defined in the
* https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165[EIP].
*
* Implementers can declare support of contract interfaces, which can then be
* queried by others ({ERC165Checker}).
*
* For an implementation, see {ERC165}.
*/
interface IERC165 {
/**
* @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by
* `interfaceId`. See the corresponding
* https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified[EIP section]
* to learn more about how these ids are created.
*
* This function call must use less than 30 000 gas.
*/
function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) external view returns (bool);
}
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
interface IStakeFor {
function depositFor(address user, uint256 amount) external returns (bool);
}